3 @setfilename coreutils.info
4 @settitle @sc{gnu} Coreutils
9 @include constants.texi
11 @c Define new indices.
15 @c Put everything in one index (arbitrarily chosen to be the concept index).
25 * Coreutils: (coreutils). Core GNU (file, text, shell) utilities.
26 * Common options: (coreutils)Common options. Common options.
27 * File permissions: (coreutils)File permissions. Access modes.
28 * Date input formats: (coreutils)Date input formats.
31 @c FIXME: the following need documentation
32 @c * [: (coreutils)[ invocation. File/string tests.
33 @c * pinky: (coreutils)pinky invocation. FIXME.
34 @c * uptime: (coreutils)uptime invocation. FIXME.
35 @c * mktemp: (coreutils)mktemp invocation. FIXME.
36 @c * chcon: (coreutils)chcon invocation. FIXME.
38 @dircategory Individual utilities
40 * arch: (coreutils)arch invocation. Print machine hardware name.
41 * base64: (coreutils)base64 invocation. Base64 encode/decode data.
42 * basename: (coreutils)basename invocation. Strip directory and suffix.
43 * cat: (coreutils)cat invocation. Concatenate and write files.
44 * chgrp: (coreutils)chgrp invocation. Change file groups.
45 * chmod: (coreutils)chmod invocation. Change file permissions.
46 * chown: (coreutils)chown invocation. Change file owners/groups.
47 * chroot: (coreutils)chroot invocation. Specify the root directory.
48 * cksum: (coreutils)cksum invocation. Print POSIX CRC checksum.
49 * comm: (coreutils)comm invocation. Compare sorted files by line.
50 * cp: (coreutils)cp invocation. Copy files.
51 * csplit: (coreutils)csplit invocation. Split by context.
52 * cut: (coreutils)cut invocation. Print selected parts of lines.
53 * date: (coreutils)date invocation. Print/set system date and time.
54 * dd: (coreutils)dd invocation. Copy and convert a file.
55 * df: (coreutils)df invocation. Report file system disk usage.
56 * dir: (coreutils)dir invocation. List directories briefly.
57 * dircolors: (coreutils)dircolors invocation. Color setup for ls.
58 * dirname: (coreutils)dirname invocation. Strip non-directory suffix.
59 * du: (coreutils)du invocation. Report on disk usage.
60 * echo: (coreutils)echo invocation. Print a line of text.
61 * env: (coreutils)env invocation. Modify the environment.
62 * expand: (coreutils)expand invocation. Convert tabs to spaces.
63 * expr: (coreutils)expr invocation. Evaluate expressions.
64 * factor: (coreutils)factor invocation. Print prime factors
65 * false: (coreutils)false invocation. Do nothing, unsuccessfully.
66 * fmt: (coreutils)fmt invocation. Reformat paragraph text.
67 * fold: (coreutils)fold invocation. Wrap long input lines.
68 * groups: (coreutils)groups invocation. Print group names a user is in.
69 * head: (coreutils)head invocation. Output the first part of files.
70 * hostid: (coreutils)hostid invocation. Print numeric host identifier.
71 * hostname: (coreutils)hostname invocation. Print or set system name.
72 * id: (coreutils)id invocation. Print user identity.
73 * install: (coreutils)install invocation. Copy and change attributes.
74 * join: (coreutils)join invocation. Join lines on a common field.
75 * kill: (coreutils)kill invocation. Send a signal to processes.
76 * link: (coreutils)link invocation. Make hard links between files.
77 * ln: (coreutils)ln invocation. Make links between files.
78 * logname: (coreutils)logname invocation. Print current login name.
79 * ls: (coreutils)ls invocation. List directory contents.
80 * md5sum: (coreutils)md5sum invocation. Print or check MD5 digests.
81 * mkdir: (coreutils)mkdir invocation. Create directories.
82 * mkfifo: (coreutils)mkfifo invocation. Create FIFOs (named pipes).
83 * mknod: (coreutils)mknod invocation. Create special files.
84 * mv: (coreutils)mv invocation. Rename files.
85 * nice: (coreutils)nice invocation. Modify niceness.
86 * nl: (coreutils)nl invocation. Number lines and write files.
87 * nohup: (coreutils)nohup invocation. Immunize to hangups.
88 * od: (coreutils)od invocation. Dump files in octal, etc.
89 * paste: (coreutils)paste invocation. Merge lines of files.
90 * pathchk: (coreutils)pathchk invocation. Check file name portability.
91 * pr: (coreutils)pr invocation. Paginate or columnate files.
92 * printenv: (coreutils)printenv invocation. Print environment variables.
93 * printf: (coreutils)printf invocation. Format and print data.
94 * ptx: (coreutils)ptx invocation. Produce permuted indexes.
95 * pwd: (coreutils)pwd invocation. Print working directory.
96 * readlink: (coreutils)readlink invocation. Print referent of a symlink.
97 * rm: (coreutils)rm invocation. Remove files.
98 * rmdir: (coreutils)rmdir invocation. Remove empty directories.
99 * seq: (coreutils)seq invocation. Print numeric sequences
100 * sha1sum: (coreutils)sha1sum invocation. Print or check SHA-1 digests.
101 * sha2: (coreutils)sha2 utilities. Print or check SHA-2 digests.
102 * shred: (coreutils)shred invocation. Remove files more securely.
103 * shuf: (coreutils)shuf invocation. Shuffling text files.
104 * sleep: (coreutils)sleep invocation. Delay for a specified time.
105 * sort: (coreutils)sort invocation. Sort text files.
106 * split: (coreutils)split invocation. Split into fixed-size pieces.
107 * stat: (coreutils)stat invocation. Report file(system) status.
108 * stty: (coreutils)stty invocation. Print/change terminal settings.
109 * su: (coreutils)su invocation. Modify user and group ID.
110 * sum: (coreutils)sum invocation. Print traditional checksum.
111 * sync: (coreutils)sync invocation. Synchronize memory and disk.
112 * tac: (coreutils)tac invocation. Reverse files.
113 * tail: (coreutils)tail invocation. Output the last part of files.
114 * tee: (coreutils)tee invocation. Redirect to multiple files.
115 * test: (coreutils)test invocation. File/string tests.
116 * timeout: (coreutils)timeout invocation. Run with time limit.
117 * touch: (coreutils)touch invocation. Change file timestamps.
118 * tr: (coreutils)tr invocation. Translate characters.
119 * true: (coreutils)true invocation. Do nothing, successfully.
120 * truncate: (coreutils)truncate invocation. Shrink/extend size of a file.
121 * tsort: (coreutils)tsort invocation. Topological sort.
122 * tty: (coreutils)tty invocation. Print terminal name.
123 * uname: (coreutils)uname invocation. Print system information.
124 * unexpand: (coreutils)unexpand invocation. Convert spaces to tabs.
125 * uniq: (coreutils)uniq invocation. Uniquify files.
126 * unlink: (coreutils)unlink invocation. Removal via unlink(2).
127 * users: (coreutils)users invocation. Print current user names.
128 * vdir: (coreutils)vdir invocation. List directories verbosely.
129 * wc: (coreutils)wc invocation. Line, word, and byte counts.
130 * who: (coreutils)who invocation. Print who is logged in.
131 * whoami: (coreutils)whoami invocation. Print effective user ID.
132 * yes: (coreutils)yes invocation. Print a string indefinitely.
136 This manual documents version @value{VERSION} of the @sc{gnu} core
137 utilities, including the standard programs for text and file manipulation.
139 Copyright @copyright{} 1994-1996, 2000-2008 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
142 Permission is granted to copy, distribute and/or modify this document
143 under the terms of the GNU Free Documentation License, Version 1.2 or
144 any later version published by the Free Software Foundation; with no
145 Invariant Sections, with no Front-Cover Texts, and with no Back-Cover
146 Texts. A copy of the license is included in the section entitled ``GNU
147 Free Documentation License''.
152 @title @sc{gnu} @code{Coreutils}
153 @subtitle Core GNU utilities
154 @subtitle for version @value{VERSION}, @value{UPDATED}
155 @author David MacKenzie et al.
158 @vskip 0pt plus 1filll
170 @cindex core utilities
171 @cindex text utilities
172 @cindex shell utilities
173 @cindex file utilities
176 * Introduction:: Caveats, overview, and authors.
177 * Common options:: Common options.
178 * Output of entire files:: cat tac nl od
179 * Formatting file contents:: fmt pr fold
180 * Output of parts of files:: head tail split csplit
181 * Summarizing files:: wc sum cksum md5sum sha1sum sha2
182 * Operating on sorted files:: sort shuf uniq comm ptx tsort
183 * Operating on fields within a line:: cut paste join
184 * Operating on characters:: tr expand unexpand
185 * Directory listing:: ls dir vdir dircolors
186 * Basic operations:: cp dd install mv rm shred
187 * Special file types:: ln mkdir rmdir mkfifo mknod
188 * Changing file attributes:: chgrp chmod chown touch
189 * Disk usage:: df du stat sync truncate
190 * Printing text:: echo printf yes
191 * Conditions:: false true test expr
193 * File name manipulation:: dirname basename pathchk
194 * Working context:: pwd stty printenv tty
195 * User information:: id logname whoami groups users who
196 * System context:: date uname hostname hostid
197 * Modified command invocation:: chroot env nice nohup su timeout
198 * Process control:: kill
200 * Numeric operations:: factor seq
201 * File permissions:: Access modes.
202 * Date input formats:: Specifying date strings.
203 * Opening the software toolbox:: The software tools philosophy.
204 * GNU Free Documentation License:: Copying and sharing this manual.
205 * Concept index:: General index.
208 --- The Detailed Node Listing ---
212 * Exit status:: Indicating program success or failure.
213 * Backup options:: Backup options
214 * Block size:: Block size
215 * Signal specifications:: Specifying signals
216 * Disambiguating names and IDs:: chgrp and chown owner and group syntax
217 * Random sources:: Sources of random data
218 * Target directory:: Target directory
219 * Trailing slashes:: Trailing slashes
220 * Traversing symlinks:: Traversing symlinks to directories
221 * Treating / specially:: Treating / specially
222 * Standards conformance:: Standards conformance
224 Output of entire files
226 * cat invocation:: Concatenate and write files.
227 * tac invocation:: Concatenate and write files in reverse.
228 * nl invocation:: Number lines and write files.
229 * od invocation:: Write files in octal or other formats.
230 * base64 invocation:: Transform data into printable data.
232 Formatting file contents
234 * fmt invocation:: Reformat paragraph text.
235 * pr invocation:: Paginate or columnate files for printing.
236 * fold invocation:: Wrap input lines to fit in specified width.
238 Output of parts of files
240 * head invocation:: Output the first part of files.
241 * tail invocation:: Output the last part of files.
242 * split invocation:: Split a file into fixed-size pieces.
243 * csplit invocation:: Split a file into context-determined pieces.
247 * wc invocation:: Print newline, word, and byte counts.
248 * sum invocation:: Print checksum and block counts.
249 * cksum invocation:: Print CRC checksum and byte counts.
250 * md5sum invocation:: Print or check MD5 digests.
251 * sha1sum invocation:: Print or check SHA-1 digests.
252 * sha2 utilities:: Print or check SHA-2 digests.
254 Operating on sorted files
256 * sort invocation:: Sort text files.
257 * shuf invocation:: Shuffle text files.
258 * uniq invocation:: Uniquify files.
259 * comm invocation:: Compare two sorted files line by line.
260 * ptx invocation:: Produce a permuted index of file contents.
261 * tsort invocation:: Topological sort.
263 @command{ptx}: Produce permuted indexes
265 * General options in ptx:: Options which affect general program behavior.
266 * Charset selection in ptx:: Underlying character set considerations.
267 * Input processing in ptx:: Input fields, contexts, and keyword selection.
268 * Output formatting in ptx:: Types of output format, and sizing the fields.
269 * Compatibility in ptx:: The @acronym{GNU} extensions to @command{ptx}
271 Operating on fields within a line
273 * cut invocation:: Print selected parts of lines.
274 * paste invocation:: Merge lines of files.
275 * join invocation:: Join lines on a common field.
277 Operating on characters
279 * tr invocation:: Translate, squeeze, and/or delete characters.
280 * expand invocation:: Convert tabs to spaces.
281 * unexpand invocation:: Convert spaces to tabs.
283 @command{tr}: Translate, squeeze, and/or delete characters
285 * Character sets:: Specifying sets of characters.
286 * Translating:: Changing one set of characters to another.
287 * Squeezing:: Squeezing repeats and deleting.
291 * ls invocation:: List directory contents
292 * dir invocation:: Briefly list directory contents
293 * vdir invocation:: Verbosely list directory contents
294 * dircolors invocation:: Color setup for @command{ls}
296 @command{ls}: List directory contents
298 * Which files are listed:: Which files are listed
299 * What information is listed:: What information is listed
300 * Sorting the output:: Sorting the output
301 * More details about version sort:: More details about version sort
302 * General output formatting:: General output formatting
303 * Formatting the file names:: Formatting the file names
307 * cp invocation:: Copy files and directories
308 * dd invocation:: Convert and copy a file
309 * install invocation:: Copy files and set attributes
310 * mv invocation:: Move (rename) files
311 * rm invocation:: Remove files or directories
312 * shred invocation:: Remove files more securely
316 * link invocation:: Make a hard link via the link syscall
317 * ln invocation:: Make links between files
318 * mkdir invocation:: Make directories
319 * mkfifo invocation:: Make FIFOs (named pipes)
320 * mknod invocation:: Make block or character special files
321 * readlink invocation:: Print the referent of a symbolic link
322 * rmdir invocation:: Remove empty directories
323 * unlink invocation:: Remove files via unlink syscall
325 Changing file attributes
327 * chown invocation:: Change file owner and group
328 * chgrp invocation:: Change group ownership
329 * chmod invocation:: Change access permissions
330 * touch invocation:: Change file timestamps
334 * df invocation:: Report file system disk space usage
335 * du invocation:: Estimate file space usage
336 * stat invocation:: Report file or file system status
337 * sync invocation:: Synchronize data on disk with memory
338 * truncate invocation:: Shrink or extend the size of a file
342 * echo invocation:: Print a line of text
343 * printf invocation:: Format and print data
344 * yes invocation:: Print a string until interrupted
348 * false invocation:: Do nothing, unsuccessfully
349 * true invocation:: Do nothing, successfully
350 * test invocation:: Check file types and compare values
351 * expr invocation:: Evaluate expressions
353 @command{test}: Check file types and compare values
355 * File type tests:: File type tests
356 * Access permission tests:: Access permission tests
357 * File characteristic tests:: File characteristic tests
358 * String tests:: String tests
359 * Numeric tests:: Numeric tests
361 @command{expr}: Evaluate expression
363 * String expressions:: + : match substr index length
364 * Numeric expressions:: + - * / %
365 * Relations for expr:: | & < <= = == != >= >
366 * Examples of expr:: Examples of using @command{expr}
370 * tee invocation:: Redirect output to multiple files or processes
372 File name manipulation
374 * basename invocation:: Strip directory and suffix from a file name
375 * dirname invocation:: Strip non-directory suffix from a file name
376 * pathchk invocation:: Check file name portability
380 * pwd invocation:: Print working directory
381 * stty invocation:: Print or change terminal characteristics
382 * printenv invocation:: Print all or some environment variables
383 * tty invocation:: Print file name of terminal on standard input
385 @command{stty}: Print or change terminal characteristics
387 * Control:: Control settings
388 * Input:: Input settings
389 * Output:: Output settings
390 * Local:: Local settings
391 * Combination:: Combination settings
392 * Characters:: Special characters
393 * Special:: Special settings
397 * id invocation:: Print user identity
398 * logname invocation:: Print current login name
399 * whoami invocation:: Print effective user ID
400 * groups invocation:: Print group names a user is in
401 * users invocation:: Print login names of users currently logged in
402 * who invocation:: Print who is currently logged in
406 * arch invocation:: Print machine hardware name
407 * date invocation:: Print or set system date and time
408 * uname invocation:: Print system information
409 * hostname invocation:: Print or set system name
410 * hostid invocation:: Print numeric host identifier.
412 @command{date}: Print or set system date and time
414 * Time conversion specifiers:: %[HIklMNpPrRsSTXzZ]
415 * Date conversion specifiers:: %[aAbBcCdDeFgGhjmuUVwWxyY]
416 * Literal conversion specifiers:: %[%nt]
417 * Padding and other flags:: Pad with zeros, spaces, etc.
418 * Setting the time:: Changing the system clock.
419 * Options for date:: Instead of the current time.
420 * Date input formats:: Specifying date strings.
421 * Examples of date:: Examples.
423 Modified command invocation
425 * chroot invocation:: Run a command with a different root directory
426 * env invocation:: Run a command in a modified environment
427 * nice invocation:: Run a command with modified niceness
428 * nohup invocation:: Run a command immune to hangups
429 * su invocation:: Run a command with substitute user and group ID
430 * timeout invocation:: Run a command with a time limit
434 * kill invocation:: Sending a signal to processes.
438 * sleep invocation:: Delay for a specified time
442 * factor invocation:: Print prime factors
443 * seq invocation:: Print numeric sequences
447 * Mode Structure:: Structure of file mode bits.
448 * Symbolic Modes:: Mnemonic representation of file mode bits.
449 * Numeric Modes:: File mode bits as octal numbers.
450 * Directory Setuid and Setgid:: Set-user-ID and set-group-ID on directories.
454 * General date syntax:: Common rules.
455 * Calendar date items:: 19 Dec 1994.
456 * Time of day items:: 9:20pm.
457 * Time zone items:: @sc{est}, @sc{pdt}, @sc{gmt}.
458 * Day of week items:: Monday and others.
459 * Relative items in date strings:: next tuesday, 2 years ago.
460 * Pure numbers in date strings:: 19931219, 1440.
461 * Seconds since the Epoch:: @@1078100502.
462 * Specifying time zone rules:: TZ="America/New_York", TZ="UTC0".
463 * Authors of get_date:: Bellovin, Eggert, Salz, Berets, et al.
465 Opening the software toolbox
467 * Toolbox introduction:: Toolbox introduction
468 * I/O redirection:: I/O redirection
469 * The who command:: The @command{who} command
470 * The cut command:: The @command{cut} command
471 * The sort command:: The @command{sort} command
472 * The uniq command:: The @command{uniq} command
473 * Putting the tools together:: Putting the tools together
477 * GNU Free Documentation License:: Copying and sharing this manual.
484 @chapter Introduction
486 This manual is a work in progress: many sections make no attempt to explain
487 basic concepts in a way suitable for novices. Thus, if you are interested,
488 please get involved in improving this manual. The entire @sc{gnu} community
491 @cindex @acronym{POSIX}
492 The @sc{gnu} utilities documented here are mostly compatible with the
493 @acronym{POSIX} standard.
494 @cindex bugs, reporting
495 Please report bugs to @email{bug-coreutils@@gnu.org}. Remember
496 to include the version number, machine architecture, input files, and
497 any other information needed to reproduce the bug: your input, what you
498 expected, what you got, and why it is wrong. Diffs are welcome, but
499 please include a description of the problem as well, since this is
500 sometimes difficult to infer. @xref{Bugs, , , gcc, Using and Porting GNU CC}.
506 @cindex MacKenzie, D.
509 This manual was originally derived from the Unix man pages in the
510 distributions, which were written by David MacKenzie and updated by Jim
511 Meyering. What you are reading now is the authoritative documentation
512 for these utilities; the man pages are no longer being maintained. The
513 original @command{fmt} man page was written by Ross Paterson. Fran@,{c}ois
514 Pinard did the initial conversion to Texinfo format. Karl Berry did the
515 indexing, some reorganization, and editing of the results. Brian
516 Youmans of the Free Software Foundation office staff combined the
517 manuals for textutils, fileutils, and sh-utils to produce the present
518 omnibus manual. Richard Stallman contributed his usual invaluable
519 insights to the overall process.
522 @chapter Common options
526 @itemx @w{@kbd{--backup}[=@var{method}]}
529 @vindex VERSION_CONTROL
530 @cindex backups, making
531 @xref{Backup options}.
532 Make a backup of each file that would otherwise be overwritten or removed.
535 @macro optBackupSuffix
536 @item -S @var{suffix}
537 @itemx --suffix=@var{suffix}
540 Append @var{suffix} to each backup file made with @option{-b}.
541 @xref{Backup options}.
544 @macro optTargetDirectory
545 @item -t @var{directory}
546 @itemx @w{@kbd{--target-directory}=@var{directory}}
548 @opindex --target-directory
549 @cindex target directory
550 @cindex destination directory
551 Specify the destination @var{directory}.
552 @xref{Target directory}.
555 @macro optNoTargetDirectory
557 @itemx --no-target-directory
559 @opindex --no-target-directory
560 @cindex target directory
561 @cindex destination directory
562 Do not treat the last operand specially when it is a directory or a
563 symbolic link to a directory. @xref{Target directory}.
570 Append an SI-style abbreviation to each size, such as @samp{M} for
571 megabytes. Powers of 1000 are used, not 1024; @samp{M} stands for
572 1,000,000 bytes. This option is equivalent to
573 @option{--block-size=si}. Use the @option{-h} or
574 @option{--human-readable} option if
575 you prefer powers of 1024.
578 @macro optHumanReadable
580 @itemx --human-readable
582 @opindex --human-readable
583 @cindex human-readable output
584 Append a size letter to each size, such as @samp{M} for mebibytes.
585 Powers of 1024 are used, not 1000; @samp{M} stands for 1,048,576 bytes.
586 This option is equivalent to @option{--block-size=human-readable}.
587 Use the @option{--si} option if you prefer powers of 1000.
590 @macro optStripTrailingSlashes
591 @itemx @w{@kbd{--strip-trailing-slashes}}
592 @opindex --strip-trailing-slashes
593 @cindex stripping trailing slashes
594 Remove any trailing slashes from each @var{source} argument.
595 @xref{Trailing slashes}.
598 @cindex common options
600 Certain options are available in all of these programs. Rather than
601 writing identical descriptions for each of the programs, they are
602 described here. (In fact, every @sc{gnu} program accepts (or should accept)
605 @vindex POSIXLY_CORRECT
606 Normally options and operands can appear in any order, and programs act
607 as if all the options appear before any operands. For example,
608 @samp{sort -r passwd -t :} acts like @samp{sort -r -t : passwd}, since
609 @samp{:} is an option-argument of @option{-t}. However, if the
610 @env{POSIXLY_CORRECT} environment variable is set, options must appear
611 before operands, unless otherwise specified for a particular command.
613 A few programs can usefully have trailing operands with leading
614 @samp{-}. With such a program, options must precede operands even if
615 @env{POSIXLY_CORRECT} is not set, and this fact is noted in the
616 program description. For example, the @command{env} command's options
617 must appear before its operands, since in some cases the operands
618 specify a command that itself contains options.
620 Some of these programs recognize the @option{--help} and @option{--version}
621 options only when one of them is the sole command line argument.
628 Print a usage message listing all available options, then exit successfully.
632 @cindex version number, finding
633 Print the version number, then exit successfully.
637 @cindex option delimiter
638 Delimit the option list. Later arguments, if any, are treated as
639 operands even if they begin with @samp{-}. For example, @samp{sort --
640 -r} reads from the file named @file{-r}.
644 @cindex standard input
645 @cindex standard output
646 A single @samp{-} operand is not really an option, though it looks like one. It
647 stands for standard input, or for standard output if that is clear from
648 the context. For example, @samp{sort -} reads from standard input,
649 and is equivalent to plain @samp{sort}, and @samp{tee -} writes an
650 extra copy of its input to standard output. Unless otherwise
651 specified, @samp{-} can appear as any operand that requires a file
655 * Exit status:: Indicating program success or failure.
656 * Backup options:: -b -S, in some programs.
657 * Block size:: BLOCK_SIZE and --block-size, in some programs.
658 * Signal specifications:: Specifying signals using the --signal option.
659 * Disambiguating names and IDs:: chgrp and chown owner and group syntax
660 * Random sources:: --random-source, in some programs.
661 * Target directory:: Specifying a target directory, in some programs.
662 * Trailing slashes:: --strip-trailing-slashes, in some programs.
663 * Traversing symlinks:: -H, -L, or -P, in some programs.
664 * Treating / specially:: --preserve-root and --no-preserve-root.
665 * Special built-in utilities:: @command{break}, @command{:}, @command{eval}, @dots{}
666 * Standards conformance:: Conformance to the @acronym{POSIX} standard.
674 An exit status of zero indicates success,
675 and a nonzero value indicates failure.
678 Nearly every command invocation yields an integral @dfn{exit status}
679 that can be used to change how other commands work.
680 For the vast majority of commands, an exit status of zero indicates
681 success. Failure is indicated by a nonzero value---typically
682 @samp{1}, though it may differ on unusual platforms as @acronym{POSIX}
683 requires only that it be nonzero.
685 However, some of the programs documented here do produce
686 other exit status values and a few associate different
687 meanings with the values @samp{0} and @samp{1}.
688 Here are some of the exceptions:
689 @command{chroot}, @command{env}, @command{expr},
690 @command{nice}, @command{nohup}, @command{printenv}, @command{sort},
691 @command{su}, @command{test}, @command{timeout}, @command{tty}.
695 @section Backup options
697 @cindex backup options
699 Some @sc{gnu} programs (at least @command{cp}, @command{install},
700 @command{ln}, and @command{mv}) optionally make backups of files
701 before writing new versions.
702 These options control the details of these backups. The options are also
703 briefly mentioned in the descriptions of the particular programs.
708 @itemx @w{@kbd{--backup}[=@var{method}]}
711 @vindex VERSION_CONTROL
712 @cindex backups, making
713 Make a backup of each file that would otherwise be overwritten or removed.
714 Without this option, the original versions are destroyed.
715 Use @var{method} to determine the type of backups to make.
716 When this option is used but @var{method} is not specified,
717 then the value of the @env{VERSION_CONTROL}
718 environment variable is used. And if @env{VERSION_CONTROL} is not set,
719 the default backup type is @samp{existing}.
721 Note that the short form of this option, @option{-b} does not accept any
722 argument. Using @option{-b} is equivalent to using @option{--backup=existing}.
724 @vindex version-control @r{Emacs variable}
725 This option corresponds to the Emacs variable @samp{version-control};
726 the values for @var{method} are the same as those used in Emacs.
727 This option also accepts more descriptive names.
728 The valid @var{method}s are (unique abbreviations are accepted):
733 @opindex none @r{backup method}
738 @opindex numbered @r{backup method}
739 Always make numbered backups.
743 @opindex existing @r{backup method}
744 Make numbered backups of files that already have them, simple backups
749 @opindex simple @r{backup method}
750 Always make simple backups. Please note @samp{never} is not to be
751 confused with @samp{none}.
755 @item -S @var{suffix}
756 @itemx --suffix=@var{suffix}
759 @cindex backup suffix
760 @vindex SIMPLE_BACKUP_SUFFIX
761 Append @var{suffix} to each backup file made with @option{-b}. If this
762 option is not specified, the value of the @env{SIMPLE_BACKUP_SUFFIX}
763 environment variable is used. And if @env{SIMPLE_BACKUP_SUFFIX} is not
764 set, the default is @samp{~}, just as in Emacs.
773 Some @sc{gnu} programs (at least @command{df}, @command{du}, and
774 @command{ls}) display sizes in ``blocks''. You can adjust the block size
775 and method of display to make sizes easier to read. The block size
776 used for display is independent of any file system block size.
777 Fractional block counts are rounded up to the nearest integer.
779 @opindex --block-size=@var{size}
782 @vindex DF_BLOCK_SIZE
783 @vindex DU_BLOCK_SIZE
784 @vindex LS_BLOCK_SIZE
785 @vindex POSIXLY_CORRECT@r{, and block size}
787 The default block size is chosen by examining the following environment
788 variables in turn; the first one that is set determines the block size.
793 This specifies the default block size for the @command{df} command.
794 Similarly, @env{DU_BLOCK_SIZE} specifies the default for @command{du} and
795 @env{LS_BLOCK_SIZE} for @command{ls}.
798 This specifies the default block size for all three commands, if the
799 above command-specific environment variables are not set.
802 This specifies the default block size for all values that are normally
803 printed as blocks, if neither @env{BLOCK_SIZE} nor the above
804 command-specific environment variables are set. Unlike the other
805 environment variables, @env{BLOCKSIZE} does not affect values that are
806 normally printed as byte counts, e.g., the file sizes contained in
809 @item POSIXLY_CORRECT
810 If neither @env{@var{command}_BLOCK_SIZE}, nor @env{BLOCK_SIZE}, nor
811 @env{BLOCKSIZE} is set, but this variable is set, the block size
816 If none of the above environment variables are set, the block size
817 currently defaults to 1024 bytes in most contexts, but this number may
818 change in the future. For @command{ls} file sizes, the block size
821 @cindex human-readable output
824 A block size specification can be a positive integer specifying the number
825 of bytes per block, or it can be @code{human-readable} or @code{si} to
826 select a human-readable format. Integers may be followed by suffixes
827 that are upward compatible with the
828 @uref{http://www.bipm.fr/enus/3_SI/si-prefixes.html, SI prefixes}
829 for decimal multiples and with the
830 @uref{http://physics.nist.gov/cuu/Units/binary.html, IEC 60027-2
831 prefixes for binary multiples}.
833 With human-readable formats, output sizes are followed by a size letter
834 such as @samp{M} for megabytes. @code{BLOCK_SIZE=human-readable} uses
835 powers of 1024; @samp{M} stands for 1,048,576 bytes.
836 @code{BLOCK_SIZE=si} is similar, but uses powers of 1000 and appends
837 @samp{B}; @samp{MB} stands for 1,000,000 bytes.
840 A block size specification preceded by @samp{'} causes output sizes to
841 be displayed with thousands separators. The @env{LC_NUMERIC} locale
842 specifies the thousands separator and grouping. For example, in an
843 American English locale, @samp{--block-size="'1kB"} would cause a size
844 of 1234000 bytes to be displayed as @samp{1,234}. In the default C
845 locale, there is no thousands separator so a leading @samp{'} has no
848 An integer block size can be followed by a suffix to specify a
849 multiple of that size. A bare size letter,
850 or one followed by @samp{iB}, specifies
851 a multiple using powers of 1024. A size letter followed by @samp{B}
852 specifies powers of 1000 instead. For example, @samp{1M} and
853 @samp{1MiB} are equivalent to @samp{1048576}, whereas @samp{1MB} is
854 equivalent to @samp{1000000}.
856 A plain suffix without a preceding integer acts as if @samp{1} were
857 prepended, except that it causes a size indication to be appended to
858 the output. For example, @samp{--block-size="kB"} displays 3000 as
861 The following suffixes are defined. Large sizes like @code{1Y}
862 may be rejected by your computer due to limitations of its arithmetic.
866 @cindex kilobyte, definition of
867 kilobyte: @math{10^3 = 1000}.
871 @cindex kibibyte, definition of
872 kibibyte: @math{2^{10} = 1024}. @samp{K} is special: the SI prefix is
873 @samp{k} and the IEC 60027-2 prefix is @samp{Ki}, but tradition and
874 @acronym{POSIX} use @samp{k} to mean @samp{KiB}.
876 @cindex megabyte, definition of
877 megabyte: @math{10^6 = 1,000,000}.
880 @cindex mebibyte, definition of
881 mebibyte: @math{2^{20} = 1,048,576}.
883 @cindex gigabyte, definition of
884 gigabyte: @math{10^9 = 1,000,000,000}.
887 @cindex gibibyte, definition of
888 gibibyte: @math{2^{30} = 1,073,741,824}.
890 @cindex terabyte, definition of
891 terabyte: @math{10^{12} = 1,000,000,000,000}.
894 @cindex tebibyte, definition of
895 tebibyte: @math{2^{40} = 1,099,511,627,776}.
897 @cindex petabyte, definition of
898 petabyte: @math{10^{15} = 1,000,000,000,000,000}.
901 @cindex pebibyte, definition of
902 pebibyte: @math{2^{50} = 1,125,899,906,842,624}.
904 @cindex exabyte, definition of
905 exabyte: @math{10^{18} = 1,000,000,000,000,000,000}.
908 @cindex exbibyte, definition of
909 exbibyte: @math{2^{60} = 1,152,921,504,606,846,976}.
911 @cindex zettabyte, definition of
912 zettabyte: @math{10^{21} = 1,000,000,000,000,000,000,000}
915 @math{2^{70} = 1,180,591,620,717,411,303,424}.
916 (@samp{Zi} is a @acronym{GNU} extension to IEC 60027-2.)
918 @cindex yottabyte, definition of
919 yottabyte: @math{10^{24} = 1,000,000,000,000,000,000,000,000}.
922 @math{2^{80} = 1,208,925,819,614,629,174,706,176}.
923 (@samp{Yi} is a @acronym{GNU} extension to IEC 60027-2.)
928 @opindex --block-size
929 @opindex --human-readable
932 Block size defaults can be overridden by an explicit
933 @option{--block-size=@var{size}} option. The @option{-k}
934 option is equivalent to @option{--block-size=1K}, which
935 is the default unless the @env{POSIXLY_CORRECT} environment variable is
936 set. The @option{-h} or @option{--human-readable} option is equivalent to
937 @option{--block-size=human-readable}. The @option{--si} option is
938 equivalent to @option{--block-size=si}.
940 @node Signal specifications
941 @section Signal specifications
942 @cindex signals, specifying
944 A @var{signal} may be a signal name like @samp{HUP}, or a signal
945 number like @samp{1}, or an exit status of a process terminated by the
946 signal. A signal name can be given in canonical form or prefixed by
947 @samp{SIG}. The case of the letters is ignored. The following signal names
948 and numbers are supported on all @acronym{POSIX} compliant systems:
954 2. Terminal interrupt.
960 9. Kill (cannot be caught or ignored).
968 Other supported signal names have system-dependent corresponding
969 numbers. All systems conforming to @acronym{POSIX} 1003.1-2001 also
970 support the following signals:
974 Access to an undefined portion of a memory object.
976 Child process terminated, stopped, or continued.
978 Continue executing, if stopped.
980 Erroneous arithmetic operation.
984 Write on a pipe with no one to read it.
986 Invalid memory reference.
988 Stop executing (cannot be caught or ignored).
992 Background process attempting read.
994 Background process attempting write.
996 High bandwidth data is available at a socket.
998 User-defined signal 1.
1000 User-defined signal 2.
1004 @acronym{POSIX} 1003.1-2001 systems that support the @acronym{XSI} extension
1005 also support the following signals:
1011 Profiling timer expired.
1015 Trace/breakpoint trap.
1017 Virtual timer expired.
1019 CPU time limit exceeded.
1021 File size limit exceeded.
1025 @acronym{POSIX} 1003.1-2001 systems that support the @acronym{XRT} extension
1026 also support at least eight real-time signals called @samp{RTMIN},
1027 @samp{RTMIN+1}, @dots{}, @samp{RTMAX-1}, @samp{RTMAX}.
1029 @node Disambiguating names and IDs
1030 @section chown and chgrp: Disambiguating user names and IDs
1031 @cindex user names, disambiguating
1032 @cindex user IDs, disambiguating
1033 @cindex group names, disambiguating
1034 @cindex group IDs, disambiguating
1035 @cindex disambiguating group names and IDs
1037 Since the @var{owner} and @var{group} arguments to @command{chown} and
1038 @command{chgrp} may be specified as names or numeric IDs, there is an
1040 What if a user or group @emph{name} is a string of digits?
1041 @footnote{Using a number as a user name is common in some environments.}
1042 Should the command interpret it as a user name or as an ID?
1043 @acronym{POSIX} requires that @command{chown} and @command{chgrp}
1044 first attempt to resolve the specified string as a name, and
1045 only once that fails, then try to interpret it as an ID.
1046 This is troublesome when you want to specify a numeric ID, say 42,
1047 and it must work even in a pathological situation where
1048 @samp{42} is a user name that maps to some other user ID, say 1000.
1049 Simply invoking @code{chown 42 F}, will set @file{F}s owner ID to
1050 1000---not what you intended.
1052 GNU @command{chown} and @command{chgrp} provide a way to work around this,
1053 that at the same time may result in a significant performance improvement
1054 by eliminating a database look-up.
1055 Simply precede each numeric user ID and/or group ID with a @samp{+},
1056 in order to force its interpretation as an integer:
1060 chgrp +$numeric_group_id another-file
1064 GNU @command{chown} and @command{chgrp}
1065 skip the name look-up process for each @samp{+}-prefixed string,
1066 because a string containing @samp{+} is never a valid user or group name.
1067 This syntax is accepted on most common Unix systems, but not on Solaris 10.
1069 @node Random sources
1070 @section Sources of random data
1072 @cindex random sources
1074 The @command{shuf}, @command{shred}, and @command{sort} commands
1075 sometimes need random data to do their work. For example, @samp{sort
1076 -R} must choose a hash function at random, and it needs random data to
1077 make this selection.
1079 Normally these commands use the device file @file{/dev/urandom} as the
1080 source of random data. Typically, this device gathers environmental
1081 noise from device drivers and other sources into an entropy pool, and
1082 uses the pool to generate random bits. If the pool is short of data,
1083 the device reuses the internal pool to produce more bits, using a
1084 cryptographically secure pseudorandom number generator.
1086 @file{/dev/urandom} suffices for most practical uses, but applications
1087 requiring high-value or long-term protection of private data may
1088 require an alternate data source like @file{/dev/random} or
1089 @file{/dev/arandom}. The set of available sources depends on your
1092 To use such a source, specify the @option{--random-source=@var{file}}
1093 option, e.g., @samp{shuf --random-source=/dev/random}. The contents
1094 of @var{file} should be as random as possible. An error is reported
1095 if @var{file} does not contain enough bytes to randomize the input
1098 To reproduce the results of an earlier invocation of a command, you
1099 can save some random data into a file and then use that file as the
1100 random source in earlier and later invocations of the command.
1102 Some old-fashioned or stripped-down operating systems lack support for
1103 @command{/dev/urandom}. On these systems commands like @command{shuf}
1104 by default fall back on an internal pseudorandom generator initialized
1105 by a small amount of entropy.
1107 @node Target directory
1108 @section Target directory
1110 @cindex target directory
1112 The @command{cp}, @command{install}, @command{ln}, and @command{mv}
1113 commands normally treat the last operand specially when it is a
1114 directory or a symbolic link to a directory. For example, @samp{cp
1115 source dest} is equivalent to @samp{cp source dest/source} if
1116 @file{dest} is a directory. Sometimes this behavior is not exactly
1117 what is wanted, so these commands support the following options to
1118 allow more fine-grained control:
1123 @itemx --no-target-directory
1124 @opindex --no-target-directory
1125 @cindex target directory
1126 @cindex destination directory
1127 Do not treat the last operand specially when it is a directory or a
1128 symbolic link to a directory. This can help avoid race conditions in
1129 programs that operate in a shared area. For example, when the command
1130 @samp{mv /tmp/source /tmp/dest} succeeds, there is no guarantee that
1131 @file{/tmp/source} was renamed to @file{/tmp/dest}: it could have been
1132 renamed to @file{/tmp/dest/source} instead, if some other process
1133 created @file{/tmp/dest} as a directory. However, if @file{mv
1134 -T /tmp/source /tmp/dest} succeeds, there is no
1135 question that @file{/tmp/source} was renamed to @file{/tmp/dest}.
1137 In the opposite situation, where you want the last operand to be
1138 treated as a directory and want a diagnostic otherwise, you can use
1139 the @option{--target-directory} (@option{-t}) option.
1141 @item -t @var{directory}
1142 @itemx @w{@kbd{--target-directory}=@var{directory}}
1143 @opindex --target-directory
1144 @cindex target directory
1145 @cindex destination directory
1146 Use @var{directory} as the directory component of each destination
1149 The interface for most programs is that after processing options and a
1150 finite (possibly zero) number of fixed-position arguments, the remaining
1151 argument list is either expected to be empty, or is a list of items
1152 (usually files) that will all be handled identically. The @command{xargs}
1153 program is designed to work well with this convention.
1155 The commands in the @command{mv}-family are unusual in that they take
1156 a variable number of arguments with a special case at the @emph{end}
1157 (namely, the target directory). This makes it nontrivial to perform some
1158 operations, e.g., ``move all files from here to ../d/'', because
1159 @code{mv * ../d/} might exhaust the argument space, and @code{ls | xargs ...}
1160 doesn't have a clean way to specify an extra final argument for each
1161 invocation of the subject command. (It can be done by going through a
1162 shell command, but that requires more human labor and brain power than
1165 The @w{@kbd{--target-directory}} (@option{-t}) option allows the @command{cp},
1166 @command{install}, @command{ln}, and @command{mv} programs to be used
1167 conveniently with @command{xargs}. For example, you can move the files
1168 from the current directory to a sibling directory, @code{d} like this:
1171 ls | xargs mv -t ../d --
1174 However, this doesn't move files whose names begin with @samp{.}.
1175 If you use the @sc{gnu} @command{find} program, you can move those
1176 files too, with this command:
1179 find . -mindepth 1 -maxdepth 1 \
1183 But both of the above approaches fail if there are no files in the
1184 current directory, or if any file has a name containing a blank or
1185 some other special characters.
1186 The following example removes those limitations and requires both
1187 @sc{gnu} @command{find} and @sc{gnu} @command{xargs}:
1190 find . -mindepth 1 -maxdepth 1 -print0 \
1191 | xargs --null --no-run-if-empty \
1198 The @option{--target-directory} (@option{-t}) and
1199 @option{--no-target-directory} (@option{-T})
1200 options cannot be combined.
1202 @node Trailing slashes
1203 @section Trailing slashes
1205 @cindex trailing slashes
1207 Some @sc{gnu} programs (at least @command{cp} and @command{mv}) allow you to
1208 remove any trailing slashes from each @var{source} argument before
1209 operating on it. The @w{@kbd{--strip-trailing-slashes}} option enables
1212 This is useful when a @var{source} argument may have a trailing slash and
1213 @c FIXME: mv's behavior in this case is system-dependent
1214 specify a symbolic link to a directory. This scenario is in fact rather
1215 common because some shells can automatically append a trailing slash when
1216 performing file name completion on such symbolic links. Without this
1217 option, @command{mv}, for example, (via the system's rename function) must
1218 interpret a trailing slash as a request to dereference the symbolic link
1219 and so must rename the indirectly referenced @emph{directory} and not
1220 the symbolic link. Although it may seem surprising that such behavior
1221 be the default, it is required by @acronym{POSIX} and is consistent with
1222 other parts of that standard.
1224 @node Traversing symlinks
1225 @section Traversing symlinks
1227 @cindex symbolic link to directory, controlling traversal of
1229 The following options modify how @command{chown} and @command{chgrp}
1230 @c FIXME: note that `du' has these options, too, but they have slightly
1231 @c different meaning.
1232 traverse a hierarchy when the @option{--recursive} (@option{-R})
1233 option is also specified.
1234 If more than one of the following options is specified, only the final
1236 These options specify whether processing a symbolic link to a directory
1237 entails operating on just the symbolic link or on all files in the
1238 hierarchy rooted at that directory.
1240 These options are independent of @option{--dereference} and
1241 @option{--no-dereference} (@option{-h}), which control whether to modify
1242 a symlink or its referent.
1249 @cindex symbolic link to directory, traverse each that is specified on the command line
1250 If @option{--recursive} (@option{-R}) is specified and
1251 a command line argument is a symbolic link to a directory, traverse it.
1258 @cindex symbolic link to directory, traverse each that is encountered
1259 In a recursive traversal, traverse every symbolic link to a directory
1260 that is encountered.
1267 @cindex symbolic link to directory, never traverse
1268 Do not traverse any symbolic links.
1269 This is the default if none of @option{-H}, @option{-L},
1270 or @option{-P} is specified.
1277 @node Treating / specially
1278 @section Treating @file{/} specially
1280 Certain commands can operate destructively on entire hierarchies.
1281 For example, if a user with appropriate privileges mistakenly runs
1282 @samp{rm -rf / tmp/junk}, that may remove
1283 all files on the entire system. Since there are so few
1284 legitimate uses for such a command,
1285 @sc{gnu} @command{rm} normally declines to operate on any directory
1286 that resolves to @file{/}. If you really want to try to remove all
1287 the files on your system, you can use the @option{--no-preserve-root}
1288 option, but the default behavior, specified by the
1289 @option{--preserve-option}, is safer for most purposes.
1291 The commands @command{chgrp}, @command{chmod} and @command{chown}
1292 can also operate destructively on entire hierarchies, so they too
1293 support these options. Although, unlike @command{rm}, they don't
1294 actually unlink files, these commands are arguably more dangerous
1295 when operating recursively on @file{/}, since they often work much
1296 more quickly, and hence damage more files before an alert user can
1297 interrupt them. Tradition and @acronym{POSIX} require these commands
1298 to operate recursively on @file{/}, so they default to
1299 @option{--no-preserve-root}, but using the @option{--preserve-root}
1300 option makes them safer for most purposes. For convenience you can
1301 specify @option{--preserve-root} in an alias or in a shell function.
1303 Note that the @option{--preserve-root} option also ensures
1304 that @command{chgrp} and @command{chown} do not modify @file{/}
1305 even when dereferencing a symlink pointing to @file{/}.
1307 @node Special built-in utilities
1308 @section Special built-in utilities
1310 Some programs like @command{nice} can invoke other programs; for
1311 example, the command @samp{nice cat file} invokes the program
1312 @command{cat} by executing the command @samp{cat file}. However,
1313 @dfn{special built-in utilities} like @command{exit} cannot be invoked
1314 this way. For example, the command @samp{nice exit} does not have a
1315 well-defined behavior: it may generate an error message instead of
1318 Here is a list of the special built-in utilities that are standardized
1319 by @acronym{POSIX} 1003.1-2004.
1322 @t{.@: : break continue eval exec exit export readonly
1323 return set shift times trap unset}
1326 For example, because @samp{.}, @samp{:}, and @samp{exec} are special,
1327 the commands @samp{nice . foo.sh}, @samp{nice :}, and @samp{nice exec
1328 pwd} do not work as you might expect.
1330 Many shells extend this list. For example, Bash has several extra
1331 special built-in utilities like @command{history}, and
1332 @command{suspend}, and with Bash the command @samp{nice suspend}
1333 generates an error message instead of suspending.
1335 @node Standards conformance
1336 @section Standards conformance
1338 @vindex POSIXLY_CORRECT
1339 In a few cases, the @sc{gnu} utilities' default behavior is
1340 incompatible with the @acronym{POSIX} standard. To suppress these
1341 incompatibilities, define the @env{POSIXLY_CORRECT} environment
1342 variable. Unless you are checking for @acronym{POSIX} conformance, you
1343 probably do not need to define @env{POSIXLY_CORRECT}.
1345 Newer versions of @acronym{POSIX} are occasionally incompatible with older
1346 versions. For example, older versions of @acronym{POSIX} required the
1347 command @samp{sort +1} to sort based on the second and succeeding
1348 fields in each input line, but starting with @acronym{POSIX} 1003.1-2001
1349 the same command is required to sort the file named @file{+1}, and you
1350 must instead use the command @samp{sort -k 2} to get the field-based
1353 @vindex _POSIX2_VERSION
1354 The @sc{gnu} utilities normally conform to the version of @acronym{POSIX}
1355 that is standard for your system. To cause them to conform to a
1356 different version of @acronym{POSIX}, define the @env{_POSIX2_VERSION}
1357 environment variable to a value of the form @var{yyyymm} specifying
1358 the year and month the standard was adopted. Two values are currently
1359 supported for @env{_POSIX2_VERSION}: @samp{199209} stands for
1360 @acronym{POSIX} 1003.2-1992, and @samp{200112} stands for @acronym{POSIX}
1361 1003.1-2001. For example, if you have a newer system but are running software
1362 that assumes an older version of @acronym{POSIX} and uses @samp{sort +1}
1363 or @samp{tail +10}, you can work around any compatibility problems by setting
1364 @samp{_POSIX2_VERSION=199209} in your environment.
1366 @node Output of entire files
1367 @chapter Output of entire files
1369 @cindex output of entire files
1370 @cindex entire files, output of
1372 These commands read and write entire files, possibly transforming them
1376 * cat invocation:: Concatenate and write files.
1377 * tac invocation:: Concatenate and write files in reverse.
1378 * nl invocation:: Number lines and write files.
1379 * od invocation:: Write files in octal or other formats.
1380 * base64 invocation:: Transform data into printable data.
1383 @node cat invocation
1384 @section @command{cat}: Concatenate and write files
1387 @cindex concatenate and write files
1388 @cindex copying files
1390 @command{cat} copies each @var{file} (@samp{-} means standard input), or
1391 standard input if none are given, to standard output. Synopsis:
1394 cat [@var{option}] [@var{file}]@dots{}
1397 The program accepts the following options. Also see @ref{Common options}.
1405 Equivalent to @option{-vET}.
1408 @itemx --number-nonblank
1410 @opindex --number-nonblank
1411 Number all nonempty output lines, starting with 1.
1415 Equivalent to @option{-vE}.
1420 @opindex --show-ends
1421 Display a @samp{$} after the end of each line.
1427 Number all output lines, starting with 1.
1430 @itemx --squeeze-blank
1432 @opindex --squeeze-blank
1433 @cindex squeezing empty lines
1434 Suppress repeated adjacent empty lines; output just one empty line
1439 Equivalent to @option{-vT}.
1444 @opindex --show-tabs
1445 Display TAB characters as @samp{^I}.
1449 Ignored; for @acronym{POSIX} compatibility.
1452 @itemx --show-nonprinting
1454 @opindex --show-nonprinting
1455 Display control characters except for LFD and TAB using
1456 @samp{^} notation and precede characters that have the high bit set with
1461 On systems like MS-DOS that distinguish between text and binary files,
1462 @command{cat} normally reads and writes in binary mode. However,
1463 @command{cat} reads in text mode if one of the options
1464 @option{-bensAE} is used or if @command{cat} is reading from standard
1465 input and standard input is a terminal. Similarly, @command{cat}
1466 writes in text mode if one of the options @option{-bensAE} is used or
1467 if standard output is a terminal.
1474 # Output f's contents, then standard input, then g's contents.
1477 # Copy standard input to standard output.
1482 @node tac invocation
1483 @section @command{tac}: Concatenate and write files in reverse
1486 @cindex reversing files
1488 @command{tac} copies each @var{file} (@samp{-} means standard input), or
1489 standard input if none are given, to standard output, reversing the
1490 records (lines by default) in each separately. Synopsis:
1493 tac [@var{option}]@dots{} [@var{file}]@dots{}
1496 @dfn{Records} are separated by instances of a string (newline by
1497 default). By default, this separator string is attached to the end of
1498 the record that it follows in the file.
1500 The program accepts the following options. Also see @ref{Common options}.
1508 The separator is attached to the beginning of the record that it
1509 precedes in the file.
1515 Treat the separator string as a regular expression. Users of @command{tac}
1516 on MS-DOS/MS-Windows should note that, since @command{tac} reads files in
1517 binary mode, each line of a text file might end with a CR/LF pair
1518 instead of the Unix-style LF.
1520 @item -s @var{separator}
1521 @itemx --separator=@var{separator}
1523 @opindex --separator
1524 Use @var{separator} as the record separator, instead of newline.
1532 @section @command{nl}: Number lines and write files
1535 @cindex numbering lines
1536 @cindex line numbering
1538 @command{nl} writes each @var{file} (@samp{-} means standard input), or
1539 standard input if none are given, to standard output, with line numbers
1540 added to some or all of the lines. Synopsis:
1543 nl [@var{option}]@dots{} [@var{file}]@dots{}
1546 @cindex logical pages, numbering on
1547 @command{nl} decomposes its input into (logical) pages; by default, the
1548 line number is reset to 1 at the top of each logical page. @command{nl}
1549 treats all of the input files as a single document; it does not reset
1550 line numbers or logical pages between files.
1552 @cindex headers, numbering
1553 @cindex body, numbering
1554 @cindex footers, numbering
1555 A logical page consists of three sections: header, body, and footer.
1556 Any of the sections can be empty. Each can be numbered in a different
1557 style from the others.
1559 The beginnings of the sections of logical pages are indicated in the
1560 input file by a line containing exactly one of these delimiter strings:
1571 The two characters from which these strings are made can be changed from
1572 @samp{\} and @samp{:} via options (see below), but the pattern and
1573 length of each string cannot be changed.
1575 A section delimiter is replaced by an empty line on output. Any text
1576 that comes before the first section delimiter string in the input file
1577 is considered to be part of a body section, so @command{nl} treats a
1578 file that contains no section delimiters as a single body section.
1580 The program accepts the following options. Also see @ref{Common options}.
1584 @item -b @var{style}
1585 @itemx --body-numbering=@var{style}
1587 @opindex --body-numbering
1588 Select the numbering style for lines in the body section of each
1589 logical page. When a line is not numbered, the current line number
1590 is not incremented, but the line number separator character is still
1591 prepended to the line. The styles are:
1597 number only nonempty lines (default for body),
1599 do not number lines (default for header and footer),
1601 number only lines that contain a match for the basic regular
1602 expression @var{bre}.
1603 @xref{Regular Expressions, , Regular Expressions, grep, The GNU Grep Manual}.
1607 @itemx --section-delimiter=@var{cd}
1609 @opindex --section-delimiter
1610 @cindex section delimiters of pages
1611 Set the section delimiter characters to @var{cd}; default is
1612 @samp{\:}. If only @var{c} is given, the second remains @samp{:}.
1613 (Remember to protect @samp{\} or other metacharacters from shell
1614 expansion with quotes or extra backslashes.)
1616 @item -f @var{style}
1617 @itemx --footer-numbering=@var{style}
1619 @opindex --footer-numbering
1620 Analogous to @option{--body-numbering}.
1622 @item -h @var{style}
1623 @itemx --header-numbering=@var{style}
1625 @opindex --header-numbering
1626 Analogous to @option{--body-numbering}.
1628 @item -i @var{number}
1629 @itemx --page-increment=@var{number}
1631 @opindex --page-increment
1632 Increment line numbers by @var{number} (default 1).
1634 @item -l @var{number}
1635 @itemx --join-blank-lines=@var{number}
1637 @opindex --join-blank-lines
1638 @cindex empty lines, numbering
1639 @cindex blank lines, numbering
1640 Consider @var{number} (default 1) consecutive empty lines to be one
1641 logical line for numbering, and only number the last one. Where fewer
1642 than @var{number} consecutive empty lines occur, do not number them.
1643 An empty line is one that contains no characters, not even spaces
1646 @item -n @var{format}
1647 @itemx --number-format=@var{format}
1649 @opindex --number-format
1650 Select the line numbering format (default is @code{rn}):
1654 @opindex ln @r{format for @command{nl}}
1655 left justified, no leading zeros;
1657 @opindex rn @r{format for @command{nl}}
1658 right justified, no leading zeros;
1660 @opindex rz @r{format for @command{nl}}
1661 right justified, leading zeros.
1665 @itemx --no-renumber
1667 @opindex --no-renumber
1668 Do not reset the line number at the start of a logical page.
1670 @item -s @var{string}
1671 @itemx --number-separator=@var{string}
1673 @opindex --number-separator
1674 Separate the line number from the text line in the output with
1675 @var{string} (default is the TAB character).
1677 @item -v @var{number}
1678 @itemx --starting-line-number=@var{number}
1680 @opindex --starting-line-number
1681 Set the initial line number on each logical page to @var{number} (default 1).
1683 @item -w @var{number}
1684 @itemx --number-width=@var{number}
1686 @opindex --number-width
1687 Use @var{number} characters for line numbers (default 6).
1695 @section @command{od}: Write files in octal or other formats
1698 @cindex octal dump of files
1699 @cindex hex dump of files
1700 @cindex ASCII dump of files
1701 @cindex file contents, dumping unambiguously
1703 @command{od} writes an unambiguous representation of each @var{file}
1704 (@samp{-} means standard input), or standard input if none are given.
1708 od [@var{option}]@dots{} [@var{file}]@dots{}
1709 od [-abcdfilosx]@dots{} [@var{file}] [[+]@var{offset}[.][b]]
1710 od [@var{option}]@dots{} --traditional [@var{file}] [[+]@var{offset}[.][b] [[+]@var{label}[.][b]]]
1713 Each line of output consists of the offset in the input, followed by
1714 groups of data from the file. By default, @command{od} prints the offset in
1715 octal, and each group of file data is a C @code{short int}'s worth of input
1716 printed as a single octal number.
1718 If @var{offset} is given, it specifies how many input bytes to skip
1719 before formatting and writing. By default, it is interpreted as an
1720 octal number, but the optional trailing decimal point causes it to be
1721 interpreted as decimal. If no decimal is specified and the offset
1722 begins with @samp{0x} or @samp{0X} it is interpreted as a hexadecimal
1723 number. If there is a trailing @samp{b}, the number of bytes skipped
1724 will be @var{offset} multiplied by 512.
1726 If a command is of both the first and second forms, the second form is
1727 assumed if the last operand begins with @samp{+} or (if there are two
1728 operands) a digit. For example, in @samp{od foo 10} and @samp{od +10}
1729 the @samp{10} is an offset, whereas in @samp{od 10} the @samp{10} is a
1732 The program accepts the following options. Also see @ref{Common options}.
1736 @item -A @var{radix}
1737 @itemx --address-radix=@var{radix}
1739 @opindex --address-radix
1740 @cindex radix for file offsets
1741 @cindex file offset radix
1742 Select the base in which file offsets are printed. @var{radix} can
1743 be one of the following:
1753 none (do not print offsets).
1756 The default is octal.
1758 @item -j @var{bytes}
1759 @itemx --skip-bytes=@var{bytes}
1761 @opindex --skip-bytes
1762 Skip @var{bytes} input bytes before formatting and writing. If
1763 @var{bytes} begins with @samp{0x} or @samp{0X}, it is interpreted in
1764 hexadecimal; otherwise, if it begins with @samp{0}, in octal; otherwise,
1765 in decimal. Appending @samp{b} multiplies @var{bytes} by 512,
1766 @samp{kB} by 1000, @samp{K} by 1024,
1767 @samp{MB} by 1000*1000, @samp{M} by 1024*1024,
1768 @samp{GB} by 1000*1000*1000, @samp{G} by 1024*1024*1024,
1769 and so on for @samp{T}, @samp{P}, @samp{E}, @samp{Z}, and @samp{Y}.
1771 @item -N @var{bytes}
1772 @itemx --read-bytes=@var{bytes}
1774 @opindex --read-bytes
1775 Output at most @var{bytes} bytes of the input. Prefixes and suffixes on
1776 @code{bytes} are interpreted as for the @option{-j} option.
1778 @item -S @var{bytes}
1779 @itemx --strings[=@var{bytes}]
1782 @cindex string constants, outputting
1783 Instead of the normal output, output only @dfn{string constants}: at
1784 least @var{bytes} consecutive @acronym{ASCII} graphic characters,
1785 followed by a null (zero) byte.
1786 Prefixes and suffixes on @code{bytes} are interpreted as for the
1789 If @var{n} is omitted with @option{--strings}, the default is 3.
1792 @itemx --format=@var{type}
1795 Select the format in which to output the file data. @var{type} is a
1796 string of one or more of the below type indicator characters. If you
1797 include more than one type indicator character in a single @var{type}
1798 string, or use this option more than once, @command{od} writes one copy
1799 of each output line using each of the data types that you specified,
1800 in the order that you specified.
1802 Adding a trailing ``z'' to any type specification appends a display
1803 of the @acronym{ASCII} character representation of the printable characters
1804 to the output line generated by the type specification.
1808 named character, ignoring high-order bit
1810 @acronym{ASCII} character or backslash escape,
1823 The type @code{a} outputs things like @samp{sp} for space, @samp{nl} for
1824 newline, and @samp{nul} for a null (zero) byte. Only the least significant
1825 seven bits of each byte is used; the high-order bit is ignored.
1826 Type @code{c} outputs
1827 @samp{ }, @samp{\n}, and @code{\0}, respectively.
1830 Except for types @samp{a} and @samp{c}, you can specify the number
1831 of bytes to use in interpreting each number in the given data type
1832 by following the type indicator character with a decimal integer.
1833 Alternately, you can specify the size of one of the C compiler's
1834 built-in data types by following the type indicator character with
1835 one of the following characters. For integers (@samp{d}, @samp{o},
1836 @samp{u}, @samp{x}):
1849 For floating point (@code{f}):
1861 @itemx --output-duplicates
1863 @opindex --output-duplicates
1864 Output consecutive lines that are identical. By default, when two or
1865 more consecutive output lines would be identical, @command{od} outputs only
1866 the first line, and puts just an asterisk on the following line to
1867 indicate the elision.
1870 @itemx --width[=@var{n}]
1873 Dump @code{n} input bytes per output line. This must be a multiple of
1874 the least common multiple of the sizes associated with the specified
1877 If this option is not given at all, the default is 16. If @var{n} is
1878 omitted, the default is 32.
1882 The next several options are shorthands for format specifications.
1883 @sc{gnu} @command{od} accepts any combination of shorthands and format
1884 specification options. These options accumulate.
1890 Output as named characters. Equivalent to @samp{-t a}.
1894 Output as octal bytes. Equivalent to @samp{-t o1}.
1898 Output as @acronym{ASCII} characters or backslash escapes. Equivalent to
1903 Output as unsigned decimal two-byte units. Equivalent to @samp{-t u2}.
1907 Output as floats. Equivalent to @samp{-t fF}.
1911 Output as decimal ints. Equivalent to @samp{-t dI}.
1915 Output as decimal long ints. Equivalent to @samp{-t dL}.
1919 Output as octal two-byte units. Equivalent to @option{-t o2}.
1923 Output as decimal two-byte units. Equivalent to @option{-t d2}.
1927 Output as hexadecimal two-byte units. Equivalent to @samp{-t x2}.
1930 @opindex --traditional
1931 Recognize the non-option label argument that traditional @command{od}
1932 accepted. The following syntax:
1935 od --traditional [@var{file}] [[+]@var{offset}[.][b] [[+]@var{label}[.][b]]]
1939 can be used to specify at most one file and optional arguments
1940 specifying an offset and a pseudo-start address, @var{label}.
1941 The @var{label} argument is interpreted
1942 just like @var{offset}, but it specifies an initial pseudo-address. The
1943 pseudo-addresses are displayed in parentheses following any normal
1950 @node base64 invocation
1951 @section @command{base64}: Transform data into printable data.
1954 @cindex base64 encoding
1956 @command{base64} transforms data read from a file, or standard input,
1957 into (or from) base64 encoded form. The base64 encoded form uses
1958 printable @acronym{ASCII} characters to represent binary data.
1962 base64 [@var{option}]@dots{} [@var{file}]
1963 base64 --decode [@var{option}]@dots{} [@var{file}]
1966 The base64 encoding expands data to roughly 133% of the original.
1967 The format conforms to
1968 @uref{ftp://ftp.rfc-editor.org/in-notes/rfc4648.txt, RFC 4648}.
1970 The program accepts the following options. Also see @ref{Common options}.
1975 @itemx --wrap=@var{COLS}
1979 @cindex column to wrap data after
1980 During encoding, wrap lines after @var{COLS} characters. This must be
1983 The default is to wrap after 76 characters. Use the value 0 to
1984 disable line wrapping altogether.
1990 @cindex Decode base64 data
1991 @cindex Base64 decoding
1992 Change the mode of operation, from the default of encoding data, to
1993 decoding data. Input is expected to be base64 encoded data, and the
1994 output will be the original data.
1997 @itemx --ignore-garbage
1999 @opindex --ignore-garbage
2000 @cindex Ignore garbage in base64 stream
2001 When decoding, newlines are always accepted.
2002 During decoding, ignore unrecognized bytes,
2003 to permit distorted data to be decoded.
2010 @node Formatting file contents
2011 @chapter Formatting file contents
2013 @cindex formatting file contents
2015 These commands reformat the contents of files.
2018 * fmt invocation:: Reformat paragraph text.
2019 * pr invocation:: Paginate or columnate files for printing.
2020 * fold invocation:: Wrap input lines to fit in specified width.
2024 @node fmt invocation
2025 @section @command{fmt}: Reformat paragraph text
2028 @cindex reformatting paragraph text
2029 @cindex paragraphs, reformatting
2030 @cindex text, reformatting
2032 @command{fmt} fills and joins lines to produce output lines of (at most)
2033 a given number of characters (75 by default). Synopsis:
2036 fmt [@var{option}]@dots{} [@var{file}]@dots{}
2039 @command{fmt} reads from the specified @var{file} arguments (or standard
2040 input if none are given), and writes to standard output.
2042 By default, blank lines, spaces between words, and indentation are
2043 preserved in the output; successive input lines with different
2044 indentation are not joined; tabs are expanded on input and introduced on
2047 @cindex line-breaking
2048 @cindex sentences and line-breaking
2049 @cindex Knuth, Donald E.
2050 @cindex Plass, Michael F.
2051 @command{fmt} prefers breaking lines at the end of a sentence, and tries to
2052 avoid line breaks after the first word of a sentence or before the last
2053 word of a sentence. A @dfn{sentence break} is defined as either the end
2054 of a paragraph or a word ending in any of @samp{.?!}, followed by two
2055 spaces or end of line, ignoring any intervening parentheses or quotes.
2056 Like @TeX{}, @command{fmt} reads entire ``paragraphs'' before choosing line
2057 breaks; the algorithm is a variant of that given by Donald E. Knuth
2058 and Michael F. Plass in ``Breaking Paragraphs Into Lines'',
2059 @cite{Software---Practice & Experience} @b{11}, 11 (November 1981),
2062 The program accepts the following options. Also see @ref{Common options}.
2067 @itemx --crown-margin
2069 @opindex --crown-margin
2070 @cindex crown margin
2071 @dfn{Crown margin} mode: preserve the indentation of the first two
2072 lines within a paragraph, and align the left margin of each subsequent
2073 line with that of the second line.
2076 @itemx --tagged-paragraph
2078 @opindex --tagged-paragraph
2079 @cindex tagged paragraphs
2080 @dfn{Tagged paragraph} mode: like crown margin mode, except that if
2081 indentation of the first line of a paragraph is the same as the
2082 indentation of the second, the first line is treated as a one-line
2088 @opindex --split-only
2089 Split lines only. Do not join short lines to form longer ones. This
2090 prevents sample lines of code, and other such ``formatted'' text from
2091 being unduly combined.
2094 @itemx --uniform-spacing
2096 @opindex --uniform-spacing
2097 Uniform spacing. Reduce spacing between words to one space, and spacing
2098 between sentences to two spaces.
2101 @itemx -w @var{width}
2102 @itemx --width=@var{width}
2103 @opindex -@var{width}
2106 Fill output lines up to @var{width} characters (default 75). @command{fmt}
2107 initially tries to make lines about 7% shorter than this, to give it
2108 room to balance line lengths.
2110 @item -p @var{prefix}
2111 @itemx --prefix=@var{prefix}
2112 Only lines beginning with @var{prefix} (possibly preceded by whitespace)
2113 are subject to formatting. The prefix and any preceding whitespace are
2114 stripped for the formatting and then re-attached to each formatted output
2115 line. One use is to format certain kinds of program comments, while
2116 leaving the code unchanged.
2124 @section @command{pr}: Paginate or columnate files for printing
2127 @cindex printing, preparing files for
2128 @cindex multicolumn output, generating
2129 @cindex merging files in parallel
2131 @command{pr} writes each @var{file} (@samp{-} means standard input), or
2132 standard input if none are given, to standard output, paginating and
2133 optionally outputting in multicolumn format; optionally merges all
2134 @var{file}s, printing all in parallel, one per column. Synopsis:
2137 pr [@var{option}]@dots{} [@var{file}]@dots{}
2141 By default, a 5-line header is printed at each page: two blank lines;
2142 a line with the date, the file name, and the page count; and two more
2143 blank lines. A footer of five blank lines is also printed.
2144 The default @var{page_length} is 66
2145 lines. The default number of text lines is therefore 56.
2146 The text line of the header takes the form
2147 @samp{@var{date} @var{string} @var{page}}, with spaces inserted around
2148 @var{string} so that the line takes up the full @var{page_width}. Here,
2149 @var{date} is the date (see the @option{-D} or @option{--date-format}
2150 option for details), @var{string} is the centered header string, and
2151 @var{page} identifies the page number. The @env{LC_MESSAGES} locale
2152 category affects the spelling of @var{page}; in the default C locale, it
2153 is @samp{Page @var{number}} where @var{number} is the decimal page
2156 Form feeds in the input cause page breaks in the output. Multiple form
2157 feeds produce empty pages.
2159 Columns are of equal width, separated by an optional string (default
2160 is @samp{space}). For multicolumn output, lines will always be truncated to
2161 @var{page_width} (default 72), unless you use the @option{-J} option.
2163 column output no line truncation occurs by default. Use @option{-W} option to
2164 truncate lines in that case.
2166 The following changes were made in version 1.22i and apply to later
2167 versions of @command{pr}:
2168 @c FIXME: this whole section here sounds very awkward to me. I
2169 @c made a few small changes, but really it all needs to be redone. - Brian
2170 @c OK, I fixed another sentence or two, but some of it I just don't understand.
2175 Some small @var{letter options} (@option{-s}, @option{-w}) have been
2176 redefined for better @acronym{POSIX} compliance. The output of some further
2177 cases has been adapted to other Unix systems. These changes are not
2178 compatible with earlier versions of the program.
2181 Some @var{new capital letter} options (@option{-J}, @option{-S}, @option{-W})
2182 have been introduced to turn off unexpected interferences of small letter
2183 options. The @option{-N} option and the second argument @var{last_page}
2184 of @samp{+FIRST_PAGE} offer more flexibility. The detailed handling of
2185 form feeds set in the input files requires the @option{-T} option.
2188 Capital letter options override small letter ones.
2191 Some of the option-arguments (compare @option{-s}, @option{-e},
2192 @option{-i}, @option{-n}) cannot be specified as separate arguments from the
2193 preceding option letter (already stated in the @acronym{POSIX} specification).
2196 The program accepts the following options. Also see @ref{Common options}.
2200 @item +@var{first_page}[:@var{last_page}]
2201 @itemx --pages=@var{first_page}[:@var{last_page}]
2202 @c The two following @opindex lines evoke warnings because they contain `:'
2203 @c The `info' spec does not permit that. If we use those lines, we end
2204 @c up with truncated index entries that don't work.
2205 @c @opindex +@var{first_page}[:@var{last_page}]
2206 @c @opindex --pages=@var{first_page}[:@var{last_page}]
2207 @opindex +@var{page_range}
2208 @opindex --pages=@var{page_range}
2209 Begin printing with page @var{first_page} and stop with @var{last_page}.
2210 Missing @samp{:@var{last_page}} implies end of file. While estimating
2211 the number of skipped pages each form feed in the input file results
2212 in a new page. Page counting with and without @samp{+@var{first_page}}
2213 is identical. By default, counting starts with the first page of input
2214 file (not first page printed). Line numbering may be altered by @option{-N}
2218 @itemx --columns=@var{column}
2219 @opindex -@var{column}
2221 @cindex down columns
2222 With each single @var{file}, produce @var{column} columns of output
2223 (default is 1) and print columns down, unless @option{-a} is used. The
2224 column width is automatically decreased as @var{column} increases; unless
2225 you use the @option{-W/-w} option to increase @var{page_width} as well.
2226 This option might well cause some lines to be truncated. The number of
2227 lines in the columns on each page are balanced. The options @option{-e}
2228 and @option{-i} are on for multiple text-column output. Together with
2229 @option{-J} option column alignment and line truncation is turned off.
2230 Lines of full length are joined in a free field format and @option{-S}
2231 option may set field separators. @option{-@var{column}} may not be used
2232 with @option{-m} option.
2238 @cindex across columns
2239 With each single @var{file}, print columns across rather than down. The
2240 @option{-@var{column}} option must be given with @var{column} greater than one.
2241 If a line is too long to fit in a column, it is truncated.
2244 @itemx --show-control-chars
2246 @opindex --show-control-chars
2247 Print control characters using hat notation (e.g., @samp{^G}); print
2248 other nonprinting characters in octal backslash notation. By default,
2249 nonprinting characters are not changed.
2252 @itemx --double-space
2254 @opindex --double-space
2255 @cindex double spacing
2256 Double space the output.
2258 @item -D @var{format}
2259 @itemx --date-format=@var{format}
2260 @cindex time formats
2261 @cindex formatting times
2262 Format header dates using @var{format}, using the same conventions as
2263 for the command @samp{date +@var{format}}; @xref{date invocation}.
2264 Except for directives, which start with
2265 @samp{%}, characters in @var{format} are printed unchanged. You can use
2266 this option to specify an arbitrary string in place of the header date,
2267 e.g., @option{--date-format="Monday morning"}.
2269 @vindex POSIXLY_CORRECT
2271 The default date format is @samp{%Y-%m-%d %H:%M} (for example,
2272 @samp{2001-12-04 23:59});
2273 but if the @env{POSIXLY_CORRECT} environment variable is set
2274 and the @env{LC_TIME} locale category specifies the @acronym{POSIX}
2275 locale, the default is @samp{%b %e %H:%M %Y} (for example,
2276 @samp{Dec@ @ 4 23:59 2001}.
2279 Time stamps are listed according to the time zone rules specified by
2280 the @env{TZ} environment variable, or by the system default rules if
2281 @env{TZ} is not set. @xref{TZ Variable,, Specifying the Time Zone
2282 with @env{TZ}, libc, The GNU C Library Reference Manual}.
2284 @item -e[@var{in-tabchar}[@var{in-tabwidth}]]
2285 @itemx --expand-tabs[=@var{in-tabchar}[@var{in-tabwidth}]]
2287 @opindex --expand-tabs
2289 Expand @var{tab}s to spaces on input. Optional argument @var{in-tabchar} is
2290 the input tab character (default is the TAB character). Second optional
2291 argument @var{in-tabwidth} is the input tab character's width (default
2299 @opindex --form-feed
2300 Use a form feed instead of newlines to separate output pages. This does
2301 not alter the default page length of 66 lines.
2303 @item -h @var{HEADER}
2304 @itemx --header=@var{HEADER}
2307 Replace the file name in the header with the centered string @var{header}.
2308 When using the shell, @var{header} should be quoted and should be
2309 separated from @option{-h} by a space.
2311 @item -i[@var{out-tabchar}[@var{out-tabwidth}]]
2312 @itemx --output-tabs[=@var{out-tabchar}[@var{out-tabwidth}]]
2314 @opindex --output-tabs
2316 Replace spaces with @var{tab}s on output. Optional argument @var{out-tabchar}
2317 is the output tab character (default is the TAB character). Second optional
2318 argument @var{out-tabwidth} is the output tab character's width (default
2324 @opindex --join-lines
2325 Merge lines of full length. Used together with the column options
2326 @option{-@var{column}}, @option{-a -@var{column}} or @option{-m}. Turns off
2327 @option{-W/-w} line truncation;
2328 no column alignment used; may be used with
2329 @option{--sep-string[=@var{string}]}. @option{-J} has been introduced
2330 (together with @option{-W} and @option{--sep-string})
2331 to disentangle the old (@acronym{POSIX}-compliant) options @option{-w} and
2332 @option{-s} along with the three column options.
2335 @item -l @var{page_length}
2336 @itemx --length=@var{page_length}
2339 Set the page length to @var{page_length} (default 66) lines, including
2340 the lines of the header [and the footer]. If @var{page_length} is less
2341 than or equal to 10, the header and footer are omitted, as if the
2342 @option{-t} option had been given.
2348 Merge and print all @var{file}s in parallel, one in each column. If a
2349 line is too long to fit in a column, it is truncated, unless the @option{-J}
2350 option is used. @option{--sep-string[=@var{string}]} may be used.
2352 some @var{file}s (form feeds set) produce empty columns, still marked
2353 by @var{string}. The result is a continuous line numbering and column
2354 marking throughout the whole merged file. Completely empty merged pages
2355 show no separators or line numbers. The default header becomes
2356 @samp{@var{date} @var{page}} with spaces inserted in the middle; this
2357 may be used with the @option{-h} or @option{--header} option to fill up
2358 the middle blank part.
2360 @item -n[@var{number-separator}[@var{digits}]]
2361 @itemx --number-lines[=@var{number-separator}[@var{digits}]]
2363 @opindex --number-lines
2364 Provide @var{digits} digit line numbering (default for @var{digits} is
2365 5). With multicolumn output the number occupies the first @var{digits}
2366 column positions of each text column or only each line of @option{-m}
2367 output. With single column output the number precedes each line just as
2368 @option{-m} does. Default counting of the line numbers starts with the
2369 first line of the input file (not the first line printed, compare the
2370 @option{--page} option and @option{-N} option).
2371 Optional argument @var{number-separator} is the character appended to
2372 the line number to separate it from the text followed. The default
2373 separator is the TAB character. In a strict sense a TAB is always
2374 printed with single column output only. The @var{TAB}-width varies
2375 with the @var{TAB}-position, e.g., with the left @var{margin} specified
2376 by @option{-o} option. With multicolumn output priority is given to
2377 @samp{equal width of output columns} (a @acronym{POSIX} specification).
2378 The @var{TAB}-width is fixed to the value of the first column and does
2379 not change with different values of left @var{margin}. That means a
2380 fixed number of spaces is always printed in the place of the
2381 @var{number-separator tab}. The tabification depends upon the output
2384 @item -N @var{line_number}
2385 @itemx --first-line-number=@var{line_number}
2387 @opindex --first-line-number
2388 Start line counting with the number @var{line_number} at first line of
2389 first page printed (in most cases not the first line of the input file).
2391 @item -o @var{margin}
2392 @itemx --indent=@var{margin}
2395 @cindex indenting lines
2397 Indent each line with a margin @var{margin} spaces wide (default is zero).
2398 The total page width is the size of the margin plus the @var{page_width}
2399 set with the @option{-W/-w} option. A limited overflow may occur with
2400 numbered single column output (compare @option{-n} option).
2403 @itemx --no-file-warnings
2405 @opindex --no-file-warnings
2406 Do not print a warning message when an argument @var{file} cannot be
2407 opened. (The exit status will still be nonzero, however.)
2409 @item -s[@var{char}]
2410 @itemx --separator[=@var{char}]
2412 @opindex --separator
2413 Separate columns by a single character @var{char}. The default for
2414 @var{char} is the TAB character without @option{-w} and @samp{no
2415 character} with @option{-w}. Without @option{-s} the default separator
2416 @samp{space} is set. @option{-s[char]} turns off line truncation of all
2417 three column options (@option{-COLUMN}|@option{-a -COLUMN}|@option{-m}) unless
2418 @option{-w} is set. This is a @acronym{POSIX}-compliant formulation.
2421 @item -S@var{string}
2422 @itemx --sep-string[=@var{string}]
2424 @opindex --sep-string
2425 Use @var{string} to separate output columns. The @option{-S} option doesn't
2426 affect the @option{-W/-w} option, unlike the @option{-s} option which does. It
2427 does not affect line truncation or column alignment.
2428 Without @option{-S}, and with @option{-J}, @command{pr} uses the default output
2430 Without @option{-S} or @option{-J}, @command{pr} uses a @samp{space}
2431 (same as @option{-S"@w{ }"}). @option{--sep-string} with no
2432 @samp{=@var{string}} is equivalent to @option{--sep-string=""}.
2435 @itemx --omit-header
2437 @opindex --omit-header
2438 Do not print the usual header [and footer] on each page, and do not fill
2439 out the bottom of pages (with blank lines or a form feed). No page
2440 structure is produced, but form feeds set in the input files are retained.
2441 The predefined pagination is not changed. @option{-t} or @option{-T} may be
2442 useful together with other options; e.g.: @option{-t -e4}, expand TAB characters
2443 in the input file to 4 spaces but don't make any other changes. Use of
2444 @option{-t} overrides @option{-h}.
2447 @itemx --omit-pagination
2449 @opindex --omit-pagination
2450 Do not print header [and footer]. In addition eliminate all form feeds
2451 set in the input files.
2454 @itemx --show-nonprinting
2456 @opindex --show-nonprinting
2457 Print nonprinting characters in octal backslash notation.
2459 @item -w @var{page_width}
2460 @itemx --width=@var{page_width}
2463 Set page width to @var{page_width} characters for multiple text-column
2464 output only (default for @var{page_width} is 72). @option{-s[CHAR]} turns
2465 off the default page width and any line truncation and column alignment.
2466 Lines of full length are merged, regardless of the column options
2467 set. No @var{page_width} setting is possible with single column output.
2468 A @acronym{POSIX}-compliant formulation.
2470 @item -W @var{page_width}
2471 @itemx --page_width=@var{page_width}
2473 @opindex --page_width
2474 Set the page width to @var{page_width} characters. That's valid with and
2475 without a column option. Text lines are truncated, unless @option{-J}
2476 is used. Together with one of the three column options
2477 (@option{-@var{column}}, @option{-a -@var{column}} or @option{-m}) column
2478 alignment is always used. The separator options @option{-S} or @option{-s}
2479 don't affect the @option{-W} option. Default is 72 characters. Without
2480 @option{-W @var{page_width}} and without any of the column options NO line
2481 truncation is used (defined to keep downward compatibility and to meet
2482 most frequent tasks). That's equivalent to @option{-W 72 -J}. The header
2483 line is never truncated.
2490 @node fold invocation
2491 @section @command{fold}: Wrap input lines to fit in specified width
2494 @cindex wrapping long input lines
2495 @cindex folding long input lines
2497 @command{fold} writes each @var{file} (@option{-} means standard input), or
2498 standard input if none are given, to standard output, breaking long
2502 fold [@var{option}]@dots{} [@var{file}]@dots{}
2505 By default, @command{fold} breaks lines wider than 80 columns. The output
2506 is split into as many lines as necessary.
2508 @cindex screen columns
2509 @command{fold} counts screen columns by default; thus, a tab may count more
2510 than one column, backspace decreases the column count, and carriage
2511 return sets the column to zero.
2513 The program accepts the following options. Also see @ref{Common options}.
2521 Count bytes rather than columns, so that tabs, backspaces, and carriage
2522 returns are each counted as taking up one column, just like other
2529 Break at word boundaries: the line is broken after the last blank before
2530 the maximum line length. If the line contains no such blanks, the line
2531 is broken at the maximum line length as usual.
2533 @item -w @var{width}
2534 @itemx --width=@var{width}
2537 Use a maximum line length of @var{width} columns instead of 80.
2539 For compatibility @command{fold} supports an obsolete option syntax
2540 @option{-@var{width}}. New scripts should use @option{-w @var{width}}
2548 @node Output of parts of files
2549 @chapter Output of parts of files
2551 @cindex output of parts of files
2552 @cindex parts of files, output of
2554 These commands output pieces of the input.
2557 * head invocation:: Output the first part of files.
2558 * tail invocation:: Output the last part of files.
2559 * split invocation:: Split a file into fixed-size pieces.
2560 * csplit invocation:: Split a file into context-determined pieces.
2563 @node head invocation
2564 @section @command{head}: Output the first part of files
2567 @cindex initial part of files, outputting
2568 @cindex first part of files, outputting
2570 @command{head} prints the first part (10 lines by default) of each
2571 @var{file}; it reads from standard input if no files are given or
2572 when given a @var{file} of @option{-}. Synopsis:
2575 head [@var{option}]@dots{} [@var{file}]@dots{}
2578 If more than one @var{file} is specified, @command{head} prints a
2579 one-line header consisting of:
2582 ==> @var{file name} <==
2586 before the output for each @var{file}.
2588 The program accepts the following options. Also see @ref{Common options}.
2593 @itemx --bytes=@var{n}
2596 Print the first @var{n} bytes, instead of initial lines.
2597 However, if @var{n} starts with a @samp{-},
2598 print all but the last @var{n} bytes of each file.
2599 Appending @samp{b} multiplies @var{n} by 512,
2600 @samp{kB} by 1000, @samp{K} by 1024,
2601 @samp{MB} by 1000*1000, @samp{M} by 1024*1024,
2602 @samp{GB} by 1000*1000*1000, @samp{G} by 1024*1024*1024,
2603 and so on for @samp{T}, @samp{P}, @samp{E}, @samp{Z}, and @samp{Y}.
2606 @itemx --lines=@var{n}
2609 Output the first @var{n} lines.
2610 However, if @var{n} starts with a @samp{-},
2611 print all but the last @var{n} lines of each file.
2612 Size multiplier suffixes are the same as with the @option{-c} option.
2620 Never print file name headers.
2626 Always print file name headers.
2630 For compatibility @command{head} also supports an obsolete option syntax
2631 @option{-@var{count}@var{options}}, which is recognized only if it is
2632 specified first. @var{count} is a decimal number optionally followed
2633 by a size letter (@samp{b}, @samp{k}, @samp{m}) as in @option{-c}, or
2634 @samp{l} to mean count by lines, or other option letters (@samp{cqv}).
2635 Scripts intended for standard hosts should use @option{-c @var{count}}
2636 or @option{-n @var{count}} instead. If your script must also run on
2637 hosts that support only the obsolete syntax, it is usually simpler to
2638 avoid @command{head}, e.g., by using @samp{sed 5q} instead of
2644 @node tail invocation
2645 @section @command{tail}: Output the last part of files
2648 @cindex last part of files, outputting
2650 @command{tail} prints the last part (10 lines by default) of each
2651 @var{file}; it reads from standard input if no files are given or
2652 when given a @var{file} of @samp{-}. Synopsis:
2655 tail [@var{option}]@dots{} [@var{file}]@dots{}
2658 If more than one @var{file} is specified, @command{tail} prints a
2659 one-line header consisting of:
2662 ==> @var{file name} <==
2666 before the output for each @var{file}.
2668 @cindex BSD @command{tail}
2669 @sc{gnu} @command{tail} can output any amount of data (some other versions of
2670 @command{tail} cannot). It also has no @option{-r} option (print in
2671 reverse), since reversing a file is really a different job from printing
2672 the end of a file; BSD @command{tail} (which is the one with @option{-r}) can
2673 only reverse files that are at most as large as its buffer, which is
2674 typically 32 KiB@. A more reliable and versatile way to reverse files is
2675 the @sc{gnu} @command{tac} command.
2677 The program accepts the following options. Also see @ref{Common options}.
2681 @item -c @var{bytes}
2682 @itemx --bytes=@var{bytes}
2685 Output the last @var{bytes} bytes, instead of final lines.
2686 However, if @var{n} starts with a @samp{+}, start printing with the
2687 @var{n}th byte from the start of each file, instead of from the end.
2688 Appending @samp{b} multiplies @var{bytes} by 512,
2689 @samp{kB} by 1000, @samp{K} by 1024,
2690 @samp{MB} by 1000*1000, @samp{M} by 1024*1024,
2691 @samp{GB} by 1000*1000*1000, @samp{G} by 1024*1024*1024,
2692 and so on for @samp{T}, @samp{P}, @samp{E}, @samp{Z}, and @samp{Y}.
2695 @itemx --follow[=@var{how}]
2698 @cindex growing files
2699 @vindex name @r{follow option}
2700 @vindex descriptor @r{follow option}
2701 Loop forever trying to read more characters at the end of the file,
2702 presumably because the file is growing.
2703 If more than one file is given, @command{tail} prints a header whenever it
2704 gets output from a different file, to indicate which file that output is
2707 There are two ways to specify how you'd like to track files with this option,
2708 but that difference is noticeable only when a followed file is removed or
2710 If you'd like to continue to track the end of a growing file even after
2711 it has been unlinked, use @option{--follow=descriptor}. This is the default
2712 behavior, but it is not useful if you're tracking a log file that may be
2713 rotated (removed or renamed, then reopened). In that case, use
2714 @option{--follow=name} to track the named file by reopening it periodically
2715 to see if it has been removed and recreated by some other program.
2717 No matter which method you use, if the tracked file is determined to have
2718 shrunk, @command{tail} prints a message saying the file has been truncated
2719 and resumes tracking the end of the file from the newly-determined endpoint.
2721 When a file is removed, @command{tail}'s behavior depends on whether it is
2722 following the name or the descriptor. When following by name, tail can
2723 detect that a file has been removed and gives a message to that effect,
2724 and if @option{--retry} has been specified it will continue checking
2725 periodically to see if the file reappears.
2726 When following a descriptor, tail does not detect that the file has
2727 been unlinked or renamed and issues no message; even though the file
2728 may no longer be accessible via its original name, it may still be
2731 The option values @samp{descriptor} and @samp{name} may be specified only
2732 with the long form of the option, not with @option{-f}.
2734 @vindex POSIXLY_CORRECT
2735 If @env{POSIXLY_CORRECT} is set, the @option{-f} option is ignored if
2736 no @var{file} operand is specified and standard input is a FIFO or a pipe.
2740 This option is the same as @option{--follow=name --retry}. That is, tail
2741 will attempt to reopen a file when it is removed. Should this fail, tail
2742 will keep trying until it becomes accessible again.
2746 This option is useful mainly when following by name (i.e., with
2747 @option{--follow=name}).
2748 Without this option, when tail encounters a file that doesn't
2749 exist or is otherwise inaccessible, it reports that fact and
2750 never checks it again.
2752 @itemx --sleep-interval=@var{number}
2753 @opindex --sleep-interval
2754 Change the number of seconds to wait between iterations (the default is 1.0).
2755 During one iteration, every specified file is checked to see if it has
2757 Historical implementations of @command{tail} have required that
2758 @var{number} be an integer. However, GNU @command{tail} accepts
2759 an arbitrary floating point number (using a period before any
2762 @itemx --pid=@var{pid}
2764 When following by name or by descriptor, you may specify the process ID,
2765 @var{pid}, of the sole writer of all @var{file} arguments. Then, shortly
2766 after that process terminates, tail will also terminate. This will
2767 work properly only if the writer and the tailing process are running on
2768 the same machine. For example, to save the output of a build in a file
2769 and to watch the file grow, if you invoke @command{make} and @command{tail}
2770 like this then the tail process will stop when your build completes.
2771 Without this option, you would have had to kill the @code{tail -f}
2775 $ make >& makerr & tail --pid=$! -f makerr
2778 If you specify a @var{pid} that is not in use or that does not correspond
2779 to the process that is writing to the tailed files, then @command{tail}
2780 may terminate long before any @var{file}s stop growing or it may not
2781 terminate until long after the real writer has terminated.
2782 Note that @option{--pid} cannot be supported on some systems; @command{tail}
2783 will print a warning if this is the case.
2785 @itemx --max-unchanged-stats=@var{n}
2786 @opindex --max-unchanged-stats
2787 When tailing a file by name, if there have been @var{n} (default
2788 n=@value{DEFAULT_MAX_N_UNCHANGED_STATS_BETWEEN_OPENS}) consecutive
2789 iterations for which the file has not changed, then
2790 @code{open}/@code{fstat} the file to determine if that file name is
2791 still associated with the same device/inode-number pair as before.
2792 When following a log file that is rotated, this is approximately the
2793 number of seconds between when tail prints the last pre-rotation lines
2794 and when it prints the lines that have accumulated in the new log file.
2795 This option is meaningful only when following by name.
2798 @itemx --lines=@var{n}
2801 Output the last @var{n} lines.
2802 However, if @var{n} starts with a @samp{+}, start printing with the
2803 @var{n}th line from the start of each file, instead of from the end.
2804 Size multiplier suffixes are the same as with the @option{-c} option.
2812 Never print file name headers.
2818 Always print file name headers.
2822 For compatibility @command{tail} also supports an obsolete usage
2823 @samp{tail -[@var{count}][bcl][f] [@var{file}]}, which is recognized
2824 only if it does not conflict with the usage described
2825 above. This obsolete form uses exactly one option and at most one
2826 file. In the option, @var{count} is an optional decimal number optionally
2827 followed by a size letter (@samp{b}, @samp{c}, @samp{l}) to mean count
2828 by 512-byte blocks, bytes, or lines, optionally followed by @samp{f}
2829 which has the same meaning as @option{-f}.
2831 @vindex _POSIX2_VERSION
2832 On older systems, the leading @samp{-} can be replaced by @samp{+} in
2833 the obsolete option syntax with the same meaning as in counts, and
2834 obsolete usage overrides normal usage when the two conflict.
2835 This obsolete behavior can be enabled or disabled with the
2836 @env{_POSIX2_VERSION} environment variable (@pxref{Standards
2839 Scripts intended for use on standard hosts should avoid obsolete
2840 syntax and should use @option{-c @var{count}[b]}, @option{-n
2841 @var{count}}, and/or @option{-f} instead. If your script must also
2842 run on hosts that support only the obsolete syntax, you can often
2843 rewrite it to avoid problematic usages, e.g., by using @samp{sed -n
2844 '$p'} rather than @samp{tail -1}. If that's not possible, the script
2845 can use a test like @samp{if tail -c +1 </dev/null >/dev/null 2>&1;
2846 then @dots{}} to decide which syntax to use.
2848 Even if your script assumes the standard behavior, you should still
2849 beware usages whose behaviors differ depending on the @acronym{POSIX}
2850 version. For example, avoid @samp{tail - main.c}, since it might be
2851 interpreted as either @samp{tail main.c} or as @samp{tail -- -
2852 main.c}; avoid @samp{tail -c 4}, since it might mean either @samp{tail
2853 -c4} or @samp{tail -c 10 4}; and avoid @samp{tail +4}, since it might
2854 mean either @samp{tail ./+4} or @samp{tail -n +4}.
2859 @node split invocation
2860 @section @command{split}: Split a file into fixed-size pieces
2863 @cindex splitting a file into pieces
2864 @cindex pieces, splitting a file into
2866 @command{split} creates output files containing consecutive sections of
2867 @var{input} (standard input if none is given or @var{input} is
2868 @samp{-}). Synopsis:
2871 split [@var{option}] [@var{input} [@var{prefix}]]
2874 By default, @command{split} puts 1000 lines of @var{input} (or whatever is
2875 left over for the last section), into each output file.
2877 @cindex output file name prefix
2878 The output files' names consist of @var{prefix} (@samp{x} by default)
2879 followed by a group of characters (@samp{aa}, @samp{ab}, @dots{} by
2880 default), such that concatenating the output files in traditional
2881 sorted order by file name produces
2882 the original input file. If the output file names are exhausted,
2883 @command{split} reports an error without deleting the output files
2886 The program accepts the following options. Also see @ref{Common options}.
2890 @item -l @var{lines}
2891 @itemx --lines=@var{lines}
2894 Put @var{lines} lines of @var{input} into each output file.
2896 For compatibility @command{split} also supports an obsolete
2897 option syntax @option{-@var{lines}}. New scripts should use @option{-l
2898 @var{lines}} instead.
2901 @itemx --bytes=@var{size}
2904 Put @var{size} bytes of @var{input} into each output file.
2905 @var{size} is a number which may be followed by one of these
2906 multiplicative suffixes:
2908 @samp{b} => 512 ("blocks")
2909 @samp{KB} => 1000 (KiloBytes)
2910 @samp{K} => 1024 (KibiBytes)
2911 @samp{MB} => 1000*1000 (MegaBytes)
2912 @samp{M} => 1024*1024 (MebiBytes)
2914 and so on for @samp{G}, @samp{T}, @samp{P}, @samp{E}, @samp{Z}, and @samp{Y}.
2917 @itemx --line-bytes=@var{size}
2919 @opindex --line-bytes
2920 Put into each output file as many complete lines of @var{input} as
2921 possible without exceeding @var{size} bytes. Individual lines longer than
2922 @var{size} bytes are broken into multiple files.
2923 @var{size} has the same format as for the @option{--bytes} option.
2925 @item -a @var{length}
2926 @itemx --suffix-length=@var{length}
2928 @opindex --suffix-length
2929 Use suffixes of length @var{length}. The default @var{length} is 2.
2932 @itemx --numeric-suffixes
2934 @opindex --numeric-suffixes
2935 Use digits in suffixes rather than lower-case letters.
2939 Write a diagnostic just before each output file is opened.
2946 @node csplit invocation
2947 @section @command{csplit}: Split a file into context-determined pieces
2950 @cindex context splitting
2951 @cindex splitting a file into pieces by context
2953 @command{csplit} creates zero or more output files containing sections of
2954 @var{input} (standard input if @var{input} is @samp{-}). Synopsis:
2957 csplit [@var{option}]@dots{} @var{input} @var{pattern}@dots{}
2960 The contents of the output files are determined by the @var{pattern}
2961 arguments, as detailed below. An error occurs if a @var{pattern}
2962 argument refers to a nonexistent line of the input file (e.g., if no
2963 remaining line matches a given regular expression). After every
2964 @var{pattern} has been matched, any remaining input is copied into one
2967 By default, @command{csplit} prints the number of bytes written to each
2968 output file after it has been created.
2970 The types of pattern arguments are:
2975 Create an output file containing the input up to but not including line
2976 @var{n} (a positive integer). If followed by a repeat count, also
2977 create an output file containing the next @var{n} lines of the input
2978 file once for each repeat.
2980 @item /@var{regexp}/[@var{offset}]
2981 Create an output file containing the current line up to (but not
2982 including) the next line of the input file that contains a match for
2983 @var{regexp}. The optional @var{offset} is an integer.
2984 If it is given, the input up to (but not including) the
2985 matching line plus or minus @var{offset} is put into the output file,
2986 and the line after that begins the next section of input.
2988 @item %@var{regexp}%[@var{offset}]
2989 Like the previous type, except that it does not create an output
2990 file, so that section of the input file is effectively ignored.
2992 @item @{@var{repeat-count}@}
2993 Repeat the previous pattern @var{repeat-count} additional
2994 times. The @var{repeat-count} can either be a positive integer or an
2995 asterisk, meaning repeat as many times as necessary until the input is
3000 The output files' names consist of a prefix (@samp{xx} by default)
3001 followed by a suffix. By default, the suffix is an ascending sequence
3002 of two-digit decimal numbers from @samp{00} to @samp{99}. In any case,
3003 concatenating the output files in sorted order by file name produces the
3004 original input file.
3006 By default, if @command{csplit} encounters an error or receives a hangup,
3007 interrupt, quit, or terminate signal, it removes any output files
3008 that it has created so far before it exits.
3010 The program accepts the following options. Also see @ref{Common options}.
3014 @item -f @var{prefix}
3015 @itemx --prefix=@var{prefix}
3018 @cindex output file name prefix
3019 Use @var{prefix} as the output file name prefix.
3021 @item -b @var{suffix}
3022 @itemx --suffix=@var{suffix}
3025 @cindex output file name suffix
3026 Use @var{suffix} as the output file name suffix. When this option is
3027 specified, the suffix string must include exactly one
3028 @code{printf(3)}-style conversion specification, possibly including
3029 format specification flags, a field width, a precision specifications,
3030 or all of these kinds of modifiers. The format letter must convert a
3031 binary integer argument to readable form; thus, only @samp{d}, @samp{i},
3032 @samp{u}, @samp{o}, @samp{x}, and @samp{X} conversions are allowed. The
3033 entire @var{suffix} is given (with the current output file number) to
3034 @code{sprintf(3)} to form the file name suffixes for each of the
3035 individual output files in turn. If this option is used, the
3036 @option{--digits} option is ignored.
3038 @item -n @var{digits}
3039 @itemx --digits=@var{digits}
3042 Use output file names containing numbers that are @var{digits} digits
3043 long instead of the default 2.
3048 @opindex --keep-files
3049 Do not remove output files when errors are encountered.
3052 @itemx --elide-empty-files
3054 @opindex --elide-empty-files
3055 Suppress the generation of zero-length output files. (In cases where
3056 the section delimiters of the input file are supposed to mark the first
3057 lines of each of the sections, the first output file will generally be a
3058 zero-length file unless you use this option.) The output file sequence
3059 numbers always run consecutively starting from 0, even when this option
3070 Do not print counts of output file sizes.
3077 @node Summarizing files
3078 @chapter Summarizing files
3080 @cindex summarizing files
3082 These commands generate just a few numbers representing entire
3086 * wc invocation:: Print newline, word, and byte counts.
3087 * sum invocation:: Print checksum and block counts.
3088 * cksum invocation:: Print CRC checksum and byte counts.
3089 * md5sum invocation:: Print or check MD5 digests.
3090 * sha1sum invocation:: Print or check SHA-1 digests.
3091 * sha2 utilities:: Print or check SHA-2 digests.
3096 @section @command{wc}: Print newline, word, and byte counts
3100 @cindex character count
3104 @command{wc} counts the number of bytes, characters, whitespace-separated
3105 words, and newlines in each given @var{file}, or standard input if none
3106 are given or for a @var{file} of @samp{-}. Synopsis:
3109 wc [@var{option}]@dots{} [@var{file}]@dots{}
3112 @cindex total counts
3113 @command{wc} prints one line of counts for each file, and if the file was
3114 given as an argument, it prints the file name following the counts. If
3115 more than one @var{file} is given, @command{wc} prints a final line
3116 containing the cumulative counts, with the file name @file{total}. The
3117 counts are printed in this order: newlines, words, characters, bytes,
3118 maximum line length.
3119 Each count is printed right-justified in a field with at least one
3120 space between fields so that the numbers and file names normally line
3121 up nicely in columns. The width of the count fields varies depending
3122 on the inputs, so you should not depend on a particular field width.
3123 However, as a @acronym{GNU} extension, if only one count is printed,
3124 it is guaranteed to be printed without leading spaces.
3126 By default, @command{wc} prints three counts: the newline, words, and byte
3127 counts. Options can specify that only certain counts be printed.
3128 Options do not undo others previously given, so
3135 prints both the byte counts and the word counts.
3137 With the @option{--max-line-length} option, @command{wc} prints the length
3138 of the longest line per file, and if there is more than one file it
3139 prints the maximum (not the sum) of those lengths.
3141 The program accepts the following options. Also see @ref{Common options}.
3149 Print only the byte counts.
3155 Print only the character counts.
3161 Print only the word counts.
3167 Print only the newline counts.
3170 @itemx --max-line-length
3172 @opindex --max-line-length
3173 Print only the maximum line lengths.
3175 @macro filesZeroFromOption{cmd,withTotalOption,subListOutput}
3176 @itemx --files0-from=@var{FILE}
3177 @opindex --files0-from=@var{FILE}
3178 @c This is commented out to avoid a texi2dvi failure.
3179 @c texi2dvi (GNU Texinfo 4.11) 1.104
3180 @c @cindex including files from @command{\cmd\}
3181 Rather than processing files named on the command line, process those
3182 named in file @var{FILE}; each name is terminated by a null byte.
3183 This is useful \withTotalOption\
3184 when the list of file names is so long that it may exceed a command line
3186 In such cases, running @command{\cmd\} via @command{xargs} is undesirable
3187 because it splits the list into pieces and makes @command{\cmd\} print
3188 \subListOutput\ for each sublist rather than for the entire list.
3189 One way to produce a list of null-byte-terminated file names is with @sc{gnu}
3190 @command{find}, using its @option{-print0} predicate.
3191 Do not specify any @var{FILE} on the command line when using this option.
3193 @filesZeroFromOption{wc,,a total}
3195 For example, to find the length of the longest line in any @file{.c} or
3196 @file{.h} file in the current hierarchy, do this:
3199 find . -name '*.[ch]' -print0 |
3200 wc -L --files0-from=- | tail -n1
3208 @node sum invocation
3209 @section @command{sum}: Print checksum and block counts
3212 @cindex 16-bit checksum
3213 @cindex checksum, 16-bit
3215 @command{sum} computes a 16-bit checksum for each given @var{file}, or
3216 standard input if none are given or for a @var{file} of @samp{-}. Synopsis:
3219 sum [@var{option}]@dots{} [@var{file}]@dots{}
3222 @command{sum} prints the checksum for each @var{file} followed by the
3223 number of blocks in the file (rounded up). If more than one @var{file}
3224 is given, file names are also printed (by default). (With the
3225 @option{--sysv} option, corresponding file names are printed when there is
3226 at least one file argument.)
3228 By default, @sc{gnu} @command{sum} computes checksums using an algorithm
3229 compatible with BSD @command{sum} and prints file sizes in units of
3232 The program accepts the following options. Also see @ref{Common options}.
3238 @cindex BSD @command{sum}
3239 Use the default (BSD compatible) algorithm. This option is included for
3240 compatibility with the System V @command{sum}. Unless @option{-s} was also
3241 given, it has no effect.
3247 @cindex System V @command{sum}
3248 Compute checksums using an algorithm compatible with System V
3249 @command{sum}'s default, and print file sizes in units of 512-byte blocks.
3253 @command{sum} is provided for compatibility; the @command{cksum} program (see
3254 next section) is preferable in new applications.
3259 @node cksum invocation
3260 @section @command{cksum}: Print CRC checksum and byte counts
3263 @cindex cyclic redundancy check
3264 @cindex CRC checksum
3266 @command{cksum} computes a cyclic redundancy check (CRC) checksum for each
3267 given @var{file}, or standard input if none are given or for a
3268 @var{file} of @samp{-}. Synopsis:
3271 cksum [@var{option}]@dots{} [@var{file}]@dots{}
3274 @command{cksum} prints the CRC checksum for each file along with the number
3275 of bytes in the file, and the file name unless no arguments were given.
3277 @command{cksum} is typically used to ensure that files
3278 transferred by unreliable means (e.g., netnews) have not been corrupted,
3279 by comparing the @command{cksum} output for the received files with the
3280 @command{cksum} output for the original files (typically given in the
3283 The CRC algorithm is specified by the @acronym{POSIX} standard. It is not
3284 compatible with the BSD or System V @command{sum} algorithms (see the
3285 previous section); it is more robust.
3287 The only options are @option{--help} and @option{--version}. @xref{Common
3293 @node md5sum invocation
3294 @section @command{md5sum}: Print or check MD5 digests
3298 @cindex 128-bit checksum
3299 @cindex checksum, 128-bit
3300 @cindex fingerprint, 128-bit
3301 @cindex message-digest, 128-bit
3303 @command{md5sum} computes a 128-bit checksum (or @dfn{fingerprint} or
3304 @dfn{message-digest}) for each specified @var{file}.
3306 Note: The MD5 digest is more reliable than a simple CRC (provided by
3307 the @command{cksum} command) for detecting accidental file corruption,
3308 as the chances of accidentally having two files with identical MD5
3309 are vanishingly small. However, it should not be considered truly
3310 secure against malicious tampering: although finding a file with a
3311 given MD5 fingerprint, or modifying a file so as to retain its MD5 are
3312 considered infeasible at the moment, it is known how to produce
3313 different files with identical MD5 (a ``collision''), something which
3314 can be a security issue in certain contexts. For more secure hashes,
3315 consider using SHA-1 or SHA-2. @xref{sha1sum invocation}, and
3316 @ref{sha2 utilities}.
3318 If a @var{file} is specified as @samp{-} or if no files are given
3319 @command{md5sum} computes the checksum for the standard input.
3320 @command{md5sum} can also determine whether a file and checksum are
3321 consistent. Synopsis:
3324 md5sum [@var{option}]@dots{} [@var{file}]@dots{}
3327 For each @var{file}, @samp{md5sum} outputs the MD5 checksum, a flag
3328 indicating a binary or text input file, and the file name.
3329 If @var{file} contains a backslash or newline, the
3330 line is started with a backslash, and each problematic character in
3331 the file name is escaped with a backslash, making the output
3332 unambiguous even in the presence of arbitrary file names.
3333 If @var{file} is omitted or specified as @samp{-}, standard input is read.
3335 The program accepts the following options. Also see @ref{Common options}.
3343 @cindex binary input files
3344 Treat each input file as binary, by reading it in binary mode and
3345 outputting a @samp{*} flag. This is the inverse of @option{--text}.
3346 On systems like @acronym{GNU} that do not distinguish between binary
3347 and text files, this option merely flags each input file as binary:
3348 the MD5 checksum is unaffected. This option is the default on systems
3349 like MS-DOS that distinguish between binary and text files, except
3350 for reading standard input when standard input is a terminal.
3354 Read file names and checksum information (not data) from each
3355 @var{file} (or from stdin if no @var{file} was specified) and report
3356 whether the checksums match the contents of the named files.
3357 The input to this mode of @command{md5sum} is usually the output of
3358 a prior, checksum-generating run of @samp{md5sum}.
3359 Each valid line of input consists of an MD5 checksum, a binary/text
3360 flag, and then a file name.
3361 Binary files are marked with @samp{*}, text with @samp{ }.
3362 For each such line, @command{md5sum} reads the named file and computes its
3363 MD5 checksum. Then, if the computed message digest does not match the
3364 one on the line with the file name, the file is noted as having
3365 failed the test. Otherwise, the file passes the test.
3366 By default, for each valid line, one line is written to standard
3367 output indicating whether the named file passed the test.
3368 After all checks have been performed, if there were any failures,
3369 a warning is issued to standard error.
3370 Use the @option{--status} option to inhibit that output.
3371 If any listed file cannot be opened or read, if any valid line has
3372 an MD5 checksum inconsistent with the associated file, or if no valid
3373 line is found, @command{md5sum} exits with nonzero status. Otherwise,
3374 it exits successfully.
3378 @cindex verifying MD5 checksums
3379 This option is useful only when verifying checksums.
3380 When verifying checksums, don't generate an 'OK' message per successfully
3381 checked file. Files that fail the verification are reported in the
3382 default one-line-per-file format. If there is any checksum mismatch,
3383 print a warning summarizing the failures to standard error.
3387 @cindex verifying MD5 checksums
3388 This option is useful only when verifying checksums.
3389 When verifying checksums, don't generate the default one-line-per-file
3390 diagnostic and don't output the warning summarizing any failures.
3391 Failures to open or read a file still evoke individual diagnostics to
3393 If all listed files are readable and are consistent with the associated
3394 MD5 checksums, exit successfully. Otherwise exit with a status code
3395 indicating there was a failure.
3401 @cindex text input files
3402 Treat each input file as text, by reading it in text mode and
3403 outputting a @samp{ } flag. This is the inverse of @option{--binary}.
3404 This option is the default on systems like @acronym{GNU} that do not
3405 distinguish between binary and text files. On other systems, it is
3406 the default for reading standard input when standard input is a
3413 @cindex verifying MD5 checksums
3414 When verifying checksums, warn about improperly formatted MD5 checksum lines.
3415 This option is useful only if all but a few lines in the checked input
3423 @node sha1sum invocation
3424 @section @command{sha1sum}: Print or check SHA-1 digests
3428 @cindex 160-bit checksum
3429 @cindex checksum, 160-bit
3430 @cindex fingerprint, 160-bit
3431 @cindex message-digest, 160-bit
3433 @command{sha1sum} computes a 160-bit checksum for each specified
3434 @var{file}. The usage and options of this command are precisely the
3435 same as for @command{md5sum}. @xref{md5sum invocation}.
3437 Note: The SHA-1 digest is more secure than MD5, and no collisions of
3438 it are known (different files having the same fingerprint). However,
3439 it is known that they can be produced with considerable, but not
3440 unreasonable, resources. For this reason, it is generally considered
3441 that SHA-1 should be gradually phased out in favor of the more secure
3442 SHA-2 hash algorithms. @xref{sha2 utilities}.
3445 @node sha2 utilities
3446 @section sha2 utilities: Print or check SHA-2 digests
3453 @cindex 224-bit checksum
3454 @cindex 256-bit checksum
3455 @cindex 384-bit checksum
3456 @cindex 512-bit checksum
3457 @cindex checksum, 224-bit
3458 @cindex checksum, 256-bit
3459 @cindex checksum, 384-bit
3460 @cindex checksum, 512-bit
3461 @cindex fingerprint, 224-bit
3462 @cindex fingerprint, 256-bit
3463 @cindex fingerprint, 384-bit
3464 @cindex fingerprint, 512-bit
3465 @cindex message-digest, 224-bit
3466 @cindex message-digest, 256-bit
3467 @cindex message-digest, 384-bit
3468 @cindex message-digest, 512-bit
3470 The commands @command{sha224sum}, @command{sha256sum},
3471 @command{sha384sum} and @command{sha512sum} compute checksums of
3472 various lengths (respectively 224, 256, 384 and 512 bits),
3473 collectively known as the SHA-2 hashes. The usage and options of
3474 these commands are precisely the same as for @command{md5sum}.
3475 @xref{md5sum invocation}.
3477 Note: The SHA384 and SHA512 digests are considerably slower to
3478 compute, especially on 32-bit computers, than SHA224 or SHA256.
3481 @node Operating on sorted files
3482 @chapter Operating on sorted files
3484 @cindex operating on sorted files
3485 @cindex sorted files, operations on
3487 These commands work with (or produce) sorted files.
3490 * sort invocation:: Sort text files.
3491 * shuf invocation:: Shuffle text files.
3492 * uniq invocation:: Uniquify files.
3493 * comm invocation:: Compare two sorted files line by line.
3494 * ptx invocation:: Produce a permuted index of file contents.
3495 * tsort invocation:: Topological sort.
3496 * tsort background:: Where tsort came from.
3500 @node sort invocation
3501 @section @command{sort}: Sort text files
3504 @cindex sorting files
3506 @command{sort} sorts, merges, or compares all the lines from the given
3507 files, or standard input if none are given or for a @var{file} of
3508 @samp{-}. By default, @command{sort} writes the results to standard
3512 sort [@var{option}]@dots{} [@var{file}]@dots{}
3515 @command{sort} has three modes of operation: sort (the default), merge,
3516 and check for sortedness. The following options change the operation
3523 @itemx --check=diagnose-first
3526 @cindex checking for sortedness
3527 Check whether the given file is already sorted: if it is not all
3528 sorted, print a diagnostic containing the first out-of-order line and
3529 exit with a status of 1.
3530 Otherwise, exit successfully.
3531 At most one input file can be given.
3534 @itemx --check=quiet
3535 @itemx --check=silent
3538 @cindex checking for sortedness
3539 Exit successfully if the given file is already sorted, and
3540 exit with status 1 otherwise.
3541 At most one input file can be given.
3542 This is like @option{-c}, except it does not print a diagnostic.
3548 @cindex merging sorted files
3549 Merge the given files by sorting them as a group. Each input file must
3550 always be individually sorted. It always works to sort instead of
3551 merge; merging is provided because it is faster, in the case where it
3556 @cindex sort stability
3557 @cindex sort's last-resort comparison
3558 A pair of lines is compared as follows:
3559 @command{sort} compares each pair of fields, in the
3560 order specified on the command line, according to the associated
3561 ordering options, until a difference is found or no fields are left.
3562 If no key fields are specified, @command{sort} uses a default key of
3563 the entire line. Finally, as a last resort when all keys compare
3564 equal, @command{sort} compares entire lines as if no ordering options
3565 other than @option{--reverse} (@option{-r}) were specified. The
3566 @option{--stable} (@option{-s}) option disables this @dfn{last-resort
3567 comparison} so that lines in which all fields compare equal are left
3568 in their original relative order. The @option{--unique}
3569 (@option{-u}) option also disables the last-resort comparison.
3573 Unless otherwise specified, all comparisons use the character collating
3574 sequence specified by the @env{LC_COLLATE} locale.@footnote{If you
3575 use a non-@acronym{POSIX} locale (e.g., by setting @env{LC_ALL}
3576 to @samp{en_US}), then @command{sort} may produce output that is sorted
3577 differently than you're accustomed to. In that case, set the @env{LC_ALL}
3578 environment variable to @samp{C}. Note that setting only @env{LC_COLLATE}
3579 has two problems. First, it is ineffective if @env{LC_ALL} is also set.
3580 Second, it has undefined behavior if @env{LC_CTYPE} (or @env{LANG}, if
3581 @env{LC_CTYPE} is unset) is set to an incompatible value. For example,
3582 you get undefined behavior if @env{LC_CTYPE} is @code{ja_JP.PCK} but
3583 @env{LC_COLLATE} is @code{en_US.UTF-8}.}
3585 @sc{gnu} @command{sort} (as specified for all @sc{gnu} utilities) has no
3586 limit on input line length or restrictions on bytes allowed within lines.
3587 In addition, if the final byte of an input file is not a newline, @sc{gnu}
3588 @command{sort} silently supplies one. A line's trailing newline is not
3589 part of the line for comparison purposes.
3591 @cindex exit status of @command{sort}
3595 0 if no error occurred
3596 1 if invoked with @option{-c} or @option{-C} and the input is not sorted
3597 2 if an error occurred
3601 If the environment variable @env{TMPDIR} is set, @command{sort} uses its
3602 value as the directory for temporary files instead of @file{/tmp}. The
3603 @option{--temporary-directory} (@option{-T}) option in turn overrides
3604 the environment variable.
3606 The following options affect the ordering of output lines. They may be
3607 specified globally or as part of a specific key field. If no key
3608 fields are specified, global options apply to comparison of entire
3609 lines; otherwise the global options are inherited by key fields that do
3610 not specify any special options of their own. In pre-@acronym{POSIX}
3611 versions of @command{sort}, global options affect only later key fields,
3612 so portable shell scripts should specify global options first.
3617 @itemx --ignore-leading-blanks
3619 @opindex --ignore-leading-blanks
3620 @cindex blanks, ignoring leading
3622 Ignore leading blanks when finding sort keys in each line.
3623 By default a blank is a space or a tab, but the @env{LC_CTYPE} locale
3627 @itemx --dictionary-order
3629 @opindex --dictionary-order
3630 @cindex dictionary order
3631 @cindex phone directory order
3632 @cindex telephone directory order
3634 Sort in @dfn{phone directory} order: ignore all characters except
3635 letters, digits and blanks when sorting.
3636 By default letters and digits are those of @acronym{ASCII} and a blank
3637 is a space or a tab, but the @env{LC_CTYPE} locale can change this.
3640 @itemx --ignore-case
3642 @opindex --ignore-case
3643 @cindex ignoring case
3644 @cindex case folding
3646 Fold lowercase characters into the equivalent uppercase characters when
3647 comparing so that, for example, @samp{b} and @samp{B} sort as equal.
3648 The @env{LC_CTYPE} locale determines character types.
3651 @itemx --general-numeric-sort
3652 @itemx --sort=general-numeric
3654 @opindex --general-numeric-sort
3656 @cindex general numeric sort
3658 Sort numerically, using the standard C function @code{strtod} to convert
3659 a prefix of each line to a double-precision floating point number.
3660 This allows floating point numbers to be specified in scientific notation,
3661 like @code{1.0e-34} and @code{10e100}.
3662 The @env{LC_NUMERIC} locale determines the decimal-point character.
3663 Do not report overflow, underflow, or conversion errors.
3664 Use the following collating sequence:
3668 Lines that do not start with numbers (all considered to be equal).
3670 NaNs (``Not a Number'' values, in IEEE floating point arithmetic)
3671 in a consistent but machine-dependent order.
3675 Finite numbers in ascending numeric order (with @math{-0} and @math{+0} equal).
3680 Use this option only if there is no alternative; it is much slower than
3681 @option{--numeric-sort} (@option{-n}) and it can lose information when
3682 converting to floating point.
3685 @itemx --ignore-nonprinting
3687 @opindex --ignore-nonprinting
3688 @cindex nonprinting characters, ignoring
3689 @cindex unprintable characters, ignoring
3691 Ignore nonprinting characters.
3692 The @env{LC_CTYPE} locale determines character types.
3693 This option has no effect if the stronger @option{--dictionary-order}
3694 (@option{-d}) option is also given.
3700 @opindex --month-sort
3702 @cindex months, sorting by
3704 An initial string, consisting of any amount of blanks, followed
3705 by a month name abbreviation, is folded to UPPER case and
3706 compared in the order @samp{JAN} < @samp{FEB} < @dots{} < @samp{DEC}.
3707 Invalid names compare low to valid names. The @env{LC_TIME} locale
3708 category determines the month spellings.
3709 By default a blank is a space or a tab, but the @env{LC_CTYPE} locale
3713 @itemx --numeric-sort
3714 @itemx --sort=numeric
3716 @opindex --numeric-sort
3718 @cindex numeric sort
3720 Sort numerically. The number begins each line and consists
3721 of optional blanks, an optional @samp{-} sign, and zero or more
3722 digits possibly separated by thousands separators, optionally followed
3723 by a decimal-point character and zero or more digits. An empty
3724 number is treated as @samp{0}. The @env{LC_NUMERIC}
3725 locale specifies the decimal-point character and thousands separator.
3726 By default a blank is a space or a tab, but the @env{LC_CTYPE} locale
3729 Comparison is exact; there is no rounding error.
3731 Neither a leading @samp{+} nor exponential notation is recognized.
3732 To compare such strings numerically, use the
3733 @option{--general-numeric-sort} (@option{-g}) option.
3739 @cindex reverse sorting
3740 Reverse the result of comparison, so that lines with greater key values
3741 appear earlier in the output instead of later.
3744 @itemx --random-sort
3745 @itemx --sort=random
3747 @opindex --random-sort
3750 Sort by hashing the input keys and then sorting the hash values.
3751 Choose the hash function at random, ensuring that it is free of
3752 collisions so that differing keys have differing hash values. This is
3753 like a random permutation of the inputs (@pxref{shuf invocation}),
3754 except that keys with the same value sort together.
3756 If multiple random sort fields are specified, the same random hash
3757 function is used for all fields. To use different random hash
3758 functions for different fields, you can invoke @command{sort} more
3761 The choice of hash function is affected by the
3762 @option{--random-source} option.
3770 @item --compress-program=@var{prog}
3771 Compress any temporary files with the program @var{prog}.
3773 With no arguments, @var{prog} must compress standard input to standard
3774 output, and when given the @option{-d} option it must decompress
3775 standard input to standard output.
3777 Terminate with an error if @var{prog} exits with nonzero status.
3779 White space and the backslash character should not appear in
3780 @var{prog}; they are reserved for future use.
3782 @filesZeroFromOption{sort,,sorted output}
3784 @item -k @var{pos1}[,@var{pos2}]
3785 @itemx --key=@var{pos1}[,@var{pos2}]
3789 Specify a sort field that consists of the part of the line between
3790 @var{pos1} and @var{pos2} (or the end of the line, if @var{pos2} is
3791 omitted), @emph{inclusive}.
3793 Each @var{pos} has the form @samp{@var{f}[.@var{c}][@var{opts}]},
3794 where @var{f} is the number of the field to use, and @var{c} is the number
3795 of the first character from the beginning of the field. Fields and character
3796 positions are numbered starting with 1; a character position of zero in
3797 @var{pos2} indicates the field's last character. If @samp{.@var{c}} is
3798 omitted from @var{pos1}, it defaults to 1 (the beginning of the field);
3799 if omitted from @var{pos2}, it defaults to 0 (the end of the field).
3800 @var{opts} are ordering options, allowing individual keys to be sorted
3801 according to different rules; see below for details. Keys can span
3804 Example: To sort on the second field, use @option{--key=2,2}
3805 (@option{-k 2,2}). See below for more examples.
3807 @item --batch-size=@var{nmerge}
3808 @opindex --batch-size
3809 @cindex number of inputs to merge, nmerge
3810 Merge at most @var{nmerge} inputs at once.
3812 When @command{sort} has to merge more than @var{nmerge} inputs,
3813 it merges them in groups of @var{nmerge}, saving the result in
3814 a temporary file, which is then used as an input in a subsequent merge.
3816 A large value of @var{nmerge} may improve merge performance and decrease
3817 temporary storage utilization at the expense of increased memory usage
3818 and I/0. Conversely a small value of @var{nmerge} may reduce memory
3819 requirements and I/0 at the expense of temporary storage consumption and
3822 The value of @var{nmerge} must be at least 2.
3824 The value of @var{nmerge} may be bounded by a resource limit for open
3825 file descriptors. Try @samp{ulimit -n} or @samp{getconf OPEN_MAX} to
3826 to display the limit for a particular system.
3827 If the value of @var{nmerge} exceeds this limit, then @command{sort} will
3828 issue a warning to standard error and exit with a nonzero status.
3830 @item -o @var{output-file}
3831 @itemx --output=@var{output-file}
3834 @cindex overwriting of input, allowed
3835 Write output to @var{output-file} instead of standard output.
3836 Normally, @command{sort} reads all input before opening
3837 @var{output-file}, so you can safely sort a file in place by using
3838 commands like @code{sort -o F F} and @code{cat F | sort -o F}.
3839 However, @command{sort} with @option{--merge} (@option{-m}) can open
3840 the output file before reading all input, so a command like @code{cat
3841 F | sort -m -o F - G} is not safe as @command{sort} might start
3842 writing @file{F} before @command{cat} is done reading it.
3844 @vindex POSIXLY_CORRECT
3845 On newer systems, @option{-o} cannot appear after an input file if
3846 @env{POSIXLY_CORRECT} is set, e.g., @samp{sort F -o F}. Portable
3847 scripts should specify @option{-o @var{output-file}} before any input
3850 @item --random-source=@var{file}
3851 @opindex --random-source
3852 @cindex random source for sorting
3853 Use @var{file} as a source of random data used to determine which
3854 random hash function to use with the @option{-R} option. @xref{Random
3861 @cindex sort stability
3862 @cindex sort's last-resort comparison
3864 Make @command{sort} stable by disabling its last-resort comparison.
3865 This option has no effect if no fields or global ordering options
3866 other than @option{--reverse} (@option{-r}) are specified.
3869 @itemx --buffer-size=@var{size}
3871 @opindex --buffer-size
3872 @cindex size for main memory sorting
3873 Use a main-memory sort buffer of the given @var{size}. By default,
3874 @var{size} is in units of 1024 bytes. Appending @samp{%} causes
3875 @var{size} to be interpreted as a percentage of physical memory.
3876 Appending @samp{K} multiplies @var{size} by 1024 (the default),
3877 @samp{M} by 1,048,576, @samp{G} by 1,073,741,824, and so on for
3878 @samp{T}, @samp{P}, @samp{E}, @samp{Z}, and @samp{Y}. Appending
3879 @samp{b} causes @var{size} to be interpreted as a byte count, with no
3882 This option can improve the performance of @command{sort} by causing it
3883 to start with a larger or smaller sort buffer than the default.
3884 However, this option affects only the initial buffer size. The buffer
3885 grows beyond @var{size} if @command{sort} encounters input lines larger
3888 @item -t @var{separator}
3889 @itemx --field-separator=@var{separator}
3891 @opindex --field-separator
3892 @cindex field separator character
3893 Use character @var{separator} as the field separator when finding the
3894 sort keys in each line. By default, fields are separated by the empty
3895 string between a non-blank character and a blank character.
3896 By default a blank is a space or a tab, but the @env{LC_CTYPE} locale
3899 That is, given the input line @w{@samp{ foo bar}}, @command{sort} breaks it
3900 into fields @w{@samp{ foo}} and @w{@samp{ bar}}. The field separator is
3901 not considered to be part of either the field preceding or the field
3902 following, so with @samp{sort @w{-t " "}} the same input line has
3903 three fields: an empty field, @samp{foo}, and @samp{bar}.
3904 However, fields that extend to the end of the line,
3905 as @option{-k 2}, or fields consisting of a range, as @option{-k 2,3},
3906 retain the field separators present between the endpoints of the range.
3908 To specify a null character (@acronym{ASCII} @sc{nul}) as
3909 the field separator, use the two-character string @samp{\0}, e.g.,
3910 @samp{sort -t '\0'}.
3912 @item -T @var{tempdir}
3913 @itemx --temporary-directory=@var{tempdir}
3915 @opindex --temporary-directory
3916 @cindex temporary directory
3918 Use directory @var{tempdir} to store temporary files, overriding the
3919 @env{TMPDIR} environment variable. If this option is given more than
3920 once, temporary files are stored in all the directories given. If you
3921 have a large sort or merge that is I/O-bound, you can often improve
3922 performance by using this option to specify directories on different
3923 disks and controllers.
3929 @cindex uniquifying output
3931 Normally, output only the first of a sequence of lines that compare
3932 equal. For the @option{--check} (@option{-c} or @option{-C}) option,
3933 check that no pair of consecutive lines compares equal.
3935 This option also disables the default last-resort comparison.
3937 The commands @code{sort -u} and @code{sort | uniq} are equivalent, but
3938 this equivalence does not extend to arbitrary @command{sort} options.
3939 For example, @code{sort -n -u} inspects only the value of the initial
3940 numeric string when checking for uniqueness, whereas @code{sort -n |
3941 uniq} inspects the entire line. @xref{uniq invocation}.
3944 @itemx --zero-terminated
3946 @opindex --zero-terminated
3947 @cindex sort zero-terminated lines
3948 Treat the input as a set of lines, each terminated by a null character
3949 (@acronym{ASCII} @sc{nul}) instead of a line feed
3950 (@acronym{ASCII} @sc{lf}).
3951 This option can be useful in conjunction with @samp{perl -0} or
3952 @samp{find -print0} and @samp{xargs -0} which do the same in order to
3953 reliably handle arbitrary file names (even those containing blanks
3954 or other special characters).
3958 Historical (BSD and System V) implementations of @command{sort} have
3959 differed in their interpretation of some options, particularly
3960 @option{-b}, @option{-f}, and @option{-n}. @sc{gnu} sort follows the @acronym{POSIX}
3961 behavior, which is usually (but not always!) like the System V behavior.
3962 According to @acronym{POSIX}, @option{-n} no longer implies @option{-b}. For
3963 consistency, @option{-M} has been changed in the same way. This may
3964 affect the meaning of character positions in field specifications in
3965 obscure cases. The only fix is to add an explicit @option{-b}.
3967 A position in a sort field specified with @option{-k} may have any
3968 of the option letters @samp{Mbdfinr} appended to it, in which case the
3969 global ordering options are not used for that particular field. The
3970 @option{-b} option may be independently attached to either or both of
3971 the start and end positions of a field specification, and if it is
3972 inherited from the global options it will be attached to both.
3973 If input lines can contain leading or adjacent blanks and @option{-t}
3974 is not used, then @option{-k} is typically combined with @option{-b},
3975 @option{-g}, @option{-M}, or @option{-n}; otherwise the varying
3976 numbers of leading blanks in fields can cause confusing results.
3978 If the start position in a sort field specifier falls after the end of
3979 the line or after the end field, the field is empty. If the @option{-b}
3980 option was specified, the @samp{.@var{c}} part of a field specification
3981 is counted from the first nonblank character of the field.
3983 @vindex _POSIX2_VERSION
3984 @vindex POSIXLY_CORRECT
3985 On older systems, @command{sort} supports an obsolete origin-zero
3986 syntax @samp{+@var{pos1} [-@var{pos2}]} for specifying sort keys.
3987 This obsolete behavior can be enabled or disabled with the
3988 @env{_POSIX2_VERSION} environment variable (@pxref{Standards
3989 conformance}); it can also be enabled when @env{POSIXLY_CORRECT} is
3990 not set by using the obsolete syntax with @samp{-@var{pos2}} present.
3992 Scripts intended for use on standard hosts should avoid obsolete
3993 syntax and should use @option{-k} instead. For example, avoid
3994 @samp{sort +2}, since it might be interpreted as either @samp{sort
3995 ./+2} or @samp{sort -k 3}. If your script must also run on hosts that
3996 support only the obsolete syntax, it can use a test like @samp{if sort
3997 -k 1 </dev/null >/dev/null 2>&1; then @dots{}} to decide which syntax
4000 Here are some examples to illustrate various combinations of options.
4005 Sort in descending (reverse) numeric order.
4012 Sort alphabetically, omitting the first and second fields
4013 and the blanks at the start of the third field.
4014 This uses a single key composed of the characters beginning
4015 at the start of the first nonblank character in field three
4016 and extending to the end of each line.
4023 Sort numerically on the second field and resolve ties by sorting
4024 alphabetically on the third and fourth characters of field five.
4025 Use @samp{:} as the field delimiter.
4028 sort -t : -k 2,2n -k 5.3,5.4
4031 Note that if you had written @option{-k 2n} instead of @option{-k 2,2n}
4032 @command{sort} would have used all characters beginning in the second field
4033 and extending to the end of the line as the primary @emph{numeric}
4034 key. For the large majority of applications, treating keys spanning
4035 more than one field as numeric will not do what you expect.
4037 Also note that the @samp{n} modifier was applied to the field-end
4038 specifier for the first key. It would have been equivalent to
4039 specify @option{-k 2n,2} or @option{-k 2n,2n}. All modifiers except
4040 @samp{b} apply to the associated @emph{field}, regardless of whether
4041 the modifier character is attached to the field-start and/or the
4042 field-end part of the key specifier.
4045 Sort the password file on the fifth field and ignore any
4046 leading blanks. Sort lines with equal values in field five
4047 on the numeric user ID in field three. Fields are separated
4051 sort -t : -k 5b,5 -k 3,3n /etc/passwd
4052 sort -t : -n -k 5b,5 -k 3,3 /etc/passwd
4053 sort -t : -b -k 5,5 -k 3,3n /etc/passwd
4056 These three commands have equivalent effect. The first specifies that
4057 the first key's start position ignores leading blanks and the second
4058 key is sorted numerically. The other two commands rely on global
4059 options being inherited by sort keys that lack modifiers. The inheritance
4060 works in this case because @option{-k 5b,5b} and @option{-k 5b,5} are
4061 equivalent, as the location of a field-end lacking a @samp{.@var{c}}
4062 character position is not affected by whether initial blanks are
4066 Sort a set of log files, primarily by IPv4 address and secondarily by
4067 time stamp. If two lines' primary and secondary keys are identical,
4068 output the lines in the same order that they were input. The log
4069 files contain lines that look like this:
4072 4.150.156.3 - - [01/Apr/2004:06:31:51 +0000] message 1
4073 211.24.3.231 - - [24/Apr/2004:20:17:39 +0000] message 2
4076 Fields are separated by exactly one space. Sort IPv4 addresses
4077 lexicographically, e.g., 212.61.52.2 sorts before 212.129.233.201
4078 because 61 is less than 129.
4081 sort -s -t ' ' -k 4.9n -k 4.5M -k 4.2n -k 4.14,4.21 file*.log |
4082 sort -s -t '.' -k 1,1n -k 2,2n -k 3,3n -k 4,4n
4085 This example cannot be done with a single @command{sort} invocation,
4086 since IPv4 address components are separated by @samp{.} while dates
4087 come just after a space. So it is broken down into two invocations of
4088 @command{sort}: the first sorts by time stamp and the second by IPv4
4089 address. The time stamp is sorted by year, then month, then day, and
4090 finally by hour-minute-second field, using @option{-k} to isolate each
4091 field. Except for hour-minute-second there's no need to specify the
4092 end of each key field, since the @samp{n} and @samp{M} modifiers sort
4093 based on leading prefixes that cannot cross field boundaries. The
4094 IPv4 addresses are sorted lexicographically. The second sort uses
4095 @samp{-s} so that ties in the primary key are broken by the secondary
4096 key; the first sort uses @samp{-s} so that the combination of the two
4100 Generate a tags file in case-insensitive sorted order.
4103 find src -type f -print0 | sort -z -f | xargs -0 etags --append
4106 The use of @option{-print0}, @option{-z}, and @option{-0} in this case means
4107 that file names that contain blanks or other special characters are
4109 by the sort operation.
4111 @c This example is a bit contrived and needs more explanation.
4113 @c Sort records separated by an arbitrary string by using a pipe to convert
4114 @c each record delimiter string to @samp{\0}, then using sort's -z option,
4115 @c and converting each @samp{\0} back to the original record delimiter.
4118 @c printf 'c\n\nb\n\na\n'|perl -0pe 's/\n\n/\n\0/g'|sort -z|perl -0pe 's/\0/\n/g'
4122 Shuffle a list of directories, but preserve the order of files within
4123 each directory. For instance, one could use this to generate a music
4124 playlist in which albums are shuffled but the songs of each album are
4128 ls */* | sort -t / -k 1,1R -k 2,2
4134 @node shuf invocation
4135 @section @command{shuf}: Shuffling text
4138 @cindex shuffling files
4140 @command{shuf} shuffles its input by outputting a random permutation
4141 of its input lines. Each output permutation is equally likely.
4145 shuf [@var{option}]@dots{} [@var{file}]
4146 shuf -e [@var{option}]@dots{} [@var{arg}]@dots{}
4147 shuf -i @var{lo}-@var{hi} [@var{option}]@dots{}
4150 @command{shuf} has three modes of operation that affect where it
4151 obtains its input lines. By default, it reads lines from standard
4152 input. The following options change the operation mode:
4160 @cindex command-line operands to shuffle
4161 Treat each command-line operand as an input line.
4163 @item -i @var{lo}-@var{hi}
4164 @itemx --input-range=@var{lo}-@var{hi}
4166 @opindex --input-range
4167 @cindex input range to shuffle
4168 Act as if input came from a file containing the range of unsigned
4169 decimal integers @var{lo}@dots{}@var{hi}, one per line.
4173 @command{shuf}'s other options can affect its behavior in all
4178 @item -n @var{lines}
4179 @itemx --head-lines=@var{lines}
4181 @opindex --head-lines
4182 @cindex head of output
4183 Output at most @var{lines} lines. By default, all input lines are
4186 @item -o @var{output-file}
4187 @itemx --output=@var{output-file}
4190 @cindex overwriting of input, allowed
4191 Write output to @var{output-file} instead of standard output.
4192 @command{shuf} reads all input before opening
4193 @var{output-file}, so you can safely shuffle a file in place by using
4194 commands like @code{shuf -o F <F} and @code{cat F | shuf -o F}.
4196 @item --random-source=@var{file}
4197 @opindex --random-source
4198 @cindex random source for shuffling
4199 Use @var{file} as a source of random data used to determine which
4200 permutation to generate. @xref{Random sources}.
4203 @itemx --zero-terminated
4205 @opindex --zero-terminated
4206 @cindex sort zero-terminated lines
4207 Treat the input and output as a set of lines, each terminated by a zero byte
4208 (@acronym{ASCII} @sc{nul} (Null) character) instead of an
4209 @acronym{ASCII} @sc{lf} (Line Feed).
4210 This option can be useful in conjunction with @samp{perl -0} or
4211 @samp{find -print0} and @samp{xargs -0} which do the same in order to
4212 reliably handle arbitrary file names (even those containing blanks
4213 or other special characters).
4229 might produce the output
4239 Similarly, the command:
4242 shuf -e clubs hearts diamonds spades
4256 and the command @samp{shuf -i 1-4} might output:
4266 These examples all have four input lines, so @command{shuf} might
4267 produce any of the twenty-four possible permutations of the input. In
4268 general, if there are @var{N} input lines, there are @var{N}! (i.e.,
4269 @var{N} factorial, or @var{N} * (@var{N} - 1) * @dots{} * 1) possible
4270 output permutations.
4275 @node uniq invocation
4276 @section @command{uniq}: Uniquify files
4279 @cindex uniquify files
4281 @command{uniq} writes the unique lines in the given @file{input}, or
4282 standard input if nothing is given or for an @var{input} name of
4286 uniq [@var{option}]@dots{} [@var{input} [@var{output}]]
4289 By default, @command{uniq} prints its input lines, except that
4290 it discards all but the first of adjacent repeated lines, so that
4291 no output lines are repeated. Optionally, it can instead discard
4292 lines that are not repeated, or all repeated lines.
4294 The input need not be sorted, but repeated input lines are detected
4295 only if they are adjacent. If you want to discard non-adjacent
4296 duplicate lines, perhaps you want to use @code{sort -u}.
4297 @xref{sort invocation}.
4300 Comparisons use the character collating sequence specified by the
4301 @env{LC_COLLATE} locale category.
4303 If no @var{output} file is specified, @command{uniq} writes to standard
4306 The program accepts the following options. Also see @ref{Common options}.
4311 @itemx --skip-fields=@var{n}
4313 @opindex --skip-fields
4314 Skip @var{n} fields on each line before checking for uniqueness. Use
4315 a null string for comparison if a line has fewer than @var{n} fields. Fields
4316 are sequences of non-space non-tab characters that are separated from
4317 each other by at least one space or tab.
4319 For compatibility @command{uniq} supports an obsolete option syntax
4320 @option{-@var{n}}. New scripts should use @option{-f @var{n}} instead.
4323 @itemx --skip-chars=@var{n}
4325 @opindex --skip-chars
4326 Skip @var{n} characters before checking for uniqueness. Use a null string
4327 for comparison if a line has fewer than @var{n} characters. If you use both
4328 the field and character skipping options, fields are skipped over first.
4330 @vindex _POSIX2_VERSION
4331 On older systems, @command{uniq} supports an obsolete option syntax
4333 This obsolete behavior can be enabled or disabled with the
4334 @env{_POSIX2_VERSION} environment variable (@pxref{Standards
4335 conformance}), but portable scripts should avoid commands whose
4336 behavior depends on this variable.
4337 For example, use @samp{uniq ./+10} or @samp{uniq -s 10} rather than
4338 the ambiguous @samp{uniq +10}.
4344 Print the number of times each line occurred along with the line.
4347 @itemx --ignore-case
4349 @opindex --ignore-case
4350 Ignore differences in case when comparing lines.
4356 @cindex repeated lines, outputting
4357 Discard lines that are not repeated. When used by itself, this option
4358 causes @command{uniq} to print the first copy of each repeated line,
4362 @itemx --all-repeated[=@var{delimit-method}]
4364 @opindex --all-repeated
4365 @cindex all repeated lines, outputting
4366 Do not discard the second and subsequent repeated input lines,
4367 but discard lines that are not repeated.
4368 This option is useful mainly in conjunction with other options e.g.,
4369 to ignore case or to compare only selected fields.
4370 The optional @var{delimit-method} tells how to delimit
4371 groups of repeated lines, and must be one of the following:
4376 Do not delimit groups of repeated lines.
4377 This is equivalent to @option{--all-repeated} (@option{-D}).
4380 Output a newline before each group of repeated lines.
4381 With @option{--zero-terminated} (@option{-z}), use
4382 an @acronym{ASCII} @sc{nul} (zero) byte instead of a newline.
4385 Separate groups of repeated lines with a single newline.
4386 With @option{--zero-terminated} (@option{-z}), use
4387 an @acronym{ASCII} @sc{nul} (zero) byte instead of a newline.
4388 This is the same as using @samp{prepend}, except that
4389 no delimiter is inserted before the first group, and hence
4390 may be better suited for output direct to users.
4393 Note that when groups are delimited and the input stream contains
4394 two or more consecutive blank lines, then the output is ambiguous.
4395 To avoid that, filter the input through @samp{tr -s '\n'} to replace
4396 each sequence of consecutive newlines with a single newline.
4398 This is a @sc{gnu} extension.
4399 @c FIXME: give an example showing *how* it's useful
4405 @cindex unique lines, outputting
4406 Discard the first repeated line. When used by itself, this option
4407 causes @command{uniq} to print unique lines, and nothing else.
4410 @itemx --check-chars=@var{n}
4412 @opindex --check-chars
4413 Compare at most @var{n} characters on each line (after skipping any specified
4414 fields and characters). By default the entire rest of the lines are
4418 @itemx --zero-terminated
4420 @opindex --zero-terminated
4421 @cindex sort zero-terminated lines
4422 Treat the input as a set of lines, each terminated by a null character
4423 (@acronym{ASCII} @sc{nul}) instead of a line feed
4424 (@acronym{ASCII} @sc{lf}).
4425 This option can be useful in conjunction with @samp{sort -z}, @samp{perl -0} or
4426 @samp{find -print0} and @samp{xargs -0} which do the same in order to
4427 reliably handle arbitrary file names (even those containing blanks
4428 or other special characters).
4435 @node comm invocation
4436 @section @command{comm}: Compare two sorted files line by line
4439 @cindex line-by-line comparison
4440 @cindex comparing sorted files
4442 @command{comm} writes to standard output lines that are common, and lines
4443 that are unique, to two input files; a file name of @samp{-} means
4444 standard input. Synopsis:
4447 comm [@var{option}]@dots{} @var{file1} @var{file2}
4451 Before @command{comm} can be used, the input files must be sorted using the
4452 collating sequence specified by the @env{LC_COLLATE} locale.
4453 If an input file ends in a non-newline
4454 character, a newline is silently appended. The @command{sort} command with
4455 no options always outputs a file that is suitable input to @command{comm}.
4457 @cindex differing lines
4458 @cindex common lines
4459 With no options, @command{comm} produces three-column output. Column one
4460 contains lines unique to @var{file1}, column two contains lines unique
4461 to @var{file2}, and column three contains lines common to both files.
4462 Columns are separated by a single TAB character.
4463 @c FIXME: when there's an option to supply an alternative separator
4464 @c string, append `by default' to the above sentence.
4469 The options @option{-1}, @option{-2}, and @option{-3} suppress printing of
4470 the corresponding columns. Also see @ref{Common options}.
4472 Unlike some other comparison utilities, @command{comm} has an exit
4473 status that does not depend on the result of the comparison.
4474 Upon normal completion @command{comm} produces an exit code of zero.
4475 If there is an error it exits with nonzero status.
4477 @macro checkOrderOption{cmd}
4478 If the @option{--check-order} option is given, unsorted inputs will
4479 cause a fatal error message. If the option @option{--nocheck-order}
4480 is given, unsorted inputs will never cause an error message. If
4481 neither of these options is given, wrongly sorted inputs are diagnosed
4482 only if an input file is found to contain unpairable lines. If an
4483 input file is diagnosed as being unsorted, the @command{\cmd\} command
4484 will exit with a nonzero status (and the output should not be used).
4486 Forcing @command{\cmd\} to process wrongly sorted input files
4487 containing unpairable lines by specifying @option{--nocheck-order} is
4488 not guaranteed to produce any particular output. The output will
4489 probably not correspond with whatever you hoped it would be.
4491 @checkOrderOption{comm}
4496 Fail with an error message if either input file is wrongly ordered.
4498 @item --nocheck-order
4499 Do not check that both input files are in sorted order.
4503 @item --output-delimiter=@var{str}
4504 Print @var{str} between adjacent output columns,
4505 rather than the default of a single TAB character.
4507 The delimiter @var{str} may not be empty.
4511 @node tsort invocation
4512 @section @command{tsort}: Topological sort
4515 @cindex topological sort
4517 @command{tsort} performs a topological sort on the given @var{file}, or
4518 standard input if no input file is given or for a @var{file} of
4519 @samp{-}. For more details and some history, see @ref{tsort background}.
4523 tsort [@var{option}] [@var{file}]
4526 @command{tsort} reads its input as pairs of strings, separated by blanks,
4527 indicating a partial ordering. The output is a total ordering that
4528 corresponds to the given partial ordering.
4542 will produce the output
4553 Consider a more realistic example.
4554 You have a large set of functions all in one file, and they may all be
4555 declared static except one. Currently that one (say @code{main}) is the
4556 first function defined in the file, and the ones it calls directly follow
4557 it, followed by those they call, etc. Let's say that you are determined
4558 to take advantage of prototypes, so you have to choose between declaring
4559 all of those functions (which means duplicating a lot of information from
4560 the definitions) and rearranging the functions so that as many as possible
4561 are defined before they are used. One way to automate the latter process
4562 is to get a list for each function of the functions it calls directly.
4563 Many programs can generate such lists. They describe a call graph.
4564 Consider the following list, in which a given line indicates that the
4565 function on the left calls the one on the right directly.
4571 tail_file pretty_name
4572 tail_file write_header
4574 tail_forever recheck
4575 tail_forever pretty_name
4576 tail_forever write_header
4577 tail_forever dump_remainder
4580 tail_lines start_lines
4581 tail_lines dump_remainder
4582 tail_lines file_lines
4583 tail_lines pipe_lines
4585 tail_bytes start_bytes
4586 tail_bytes dump_remainder
4587 tail_bytes pipe_bytes
4588 file_lines dump_remainder
4592 then you can use @command{tsort} to produce an ordering of those
4593 functions that satisfies your requirement.
4596 example$ tsort call-graph | tac
4616 @command{tsort} detects any cycles in the input and writes the first cycle
4617 encountered to standard error.
4619 Note that for a given partial ordering, generally there is no unique
4620 total ordering. In the context of the call graph above, the function
4621 @code{parse_options} may be placed anywhere in the list as long as it
4622 precedes @code{main}.
4624 The only options are @option{--help} and @option{--version}. @xref{Common
4627 @node tsort background
4628 @section @command{tsort}: Background
4630 @command{tsort} exists because very early versions of the Unix linker processed
4631 an archive file exactly once, and in order. As @command{ld} read each object
4632 in the archive, it decided whether it was needed in the program based on
4633 whether it defined any symbols which were undefined at that point in
4636 This meant that dependencies within the archive had to be handled
4637 specially. For example, @code{scanf} probably calls @code{read}. That means
4638 that in a single pass through an archive, it was important for @code{scanf.o}
4639 to appear before read.o, because otherwise a program which calls
4640 @code{scanf} but not @code{read} might end up with an unexpected unresolved
4641 reference to @code{read}.
4643 The way to address this problem was to first generate a set of
4644 dependencies of one object file on another. This was done by a shell
4645 script called @command{lorder}. The GNU tools don't provide a version of
4646 lorder, as far as I know, but you can still find it in BSD
4649 Then you ran @command{tsort} over the @command{lorder} output, and you used the
4650 resulting sort to define the order in which you added objects to the archive.
4652 This whole procedure has been obsolete since about 1980, because
4653 Unix archives now contain a symbol table (traditionally built by
4654 @command{ranlib}, now generally built by @command{ar} itself), and the Unix
4655 linker uses the symbol table to effectively make multiple passes over
4658 Anyhow, that's where tsort came from. To solve an old problem with
4659 the way the linker handled archive files, which has since been solved
4665 @node ptx invocation
4666 @section @command{ptx}: Produce permuted indexes
4670 @command{ptx} reads a text file and essentially produces a permuted index, with
4671 each keyword in its context. The calling sketch is either one of:
4674 ptx [@var{option} @dots{}] [@var{file} @dots{}]
4675 ptx -G [@var{option} @dots{}] [@var{input} [@var{output}]]
4678 The @option{-G} (or its equivalent: @option{--traditional}) option disables
4679 all @sc{gnu} extensions and reverts to traditional mode, thus introducing some
4680 limitations and changing several of the program's default option values.
4681 When @option{-G} is not specified, @sc{gnu} extensions are always enabled.
4682 @sc{gnu} extensions to @command{ptx} are documented wherever appropriate in this
4683 document. For the full list, see @xref{Compatibility in ptx}.
4685 Individual options are explained in the following sections.
4687 When @sc{gnu} extensions are enabled, there may be zero, one or several
4688 @var{file}s after the options. If there is no @var{file}, the program
4689 reads the standard input. If there is one or several @var{file}s, they
4690 give the name of input files which are all read in turn, as if all the
4691 input files were concatenated. However, there is a full contextual
4692 break between each file and, when automatic referencing is requested,
4693 file names and line numbers refer to individual text input files. In
4694 all cases, the program outputs the permuted index to the standard
4697 When @sc{gnu} extensions are @emph{not} enabled, that is, when the program
4698 operates in traditional mode, there may be zero, one or two parameters
4699 besides the options. If there are no parameters, the program reads the
4700 standard input and outputs the permuted index to the standard output.
4701 If there is only one parameter, it names the text @var{input} to be read
4702 instead of the standard input. If two parameters are given, they give
4703 respectively the name of the @var{input} file to read and the name of
4704 the @var{output} file to produce. @emph{Be very careful} to note that,
4705 in this case, the contents of file given by the second parameter is
4706 destroyed. This behavior is dictated by System V @command{ptx}
4707 compatibility; @sc{gnu} Standards normally discourage output parameters not
4708 introduced by an option.
4710 Note that for @emph{any} file named as the value of an option or as an
4711 input text file, a single dash @kbd{-} may be used, in which case
4712 standard input is assumed. However, it would not make sense to use this
4713 convention more than once per program invocation.
4716 * General options in ptx:: Options which affect general program behavior.
4717 * Charset selection in ptx:: Underlying character set considerations.
4718 * Input processing in ptx:: Input fields, contexts, and keyword selection.
4719 * Output formatting in ptx:: Types of output format, and sizing the fields.
4720 * Compatibility in ptx::
4724 @node General options in ptx
4725 @subsection General options
4730 @itemx --traditional
4731 As already explained, this option disables all @sc{gnu} extensions to
4732 @command{ptx} and switches to traditional mode.
4735 Print a short help on standard output, then exit without further
4739 Print the program version on standard output, then exit without further
4747 @node Charset selection in ptx
4748 @subsection Charset selection
4750 @c FIXME: People don't necessarily know what an IBM-PC was these days.
4751 As it is set up now, the program assumes that the input file is coded
4752 using 8-bit @acronym{ISO} 8859-1 code, also known as Latin-1 character set,
4753 @emph{unless} it is compiled for MS-DOS, in which case it uses the
4754 character set of the IBM-PC@. (@sc{gnu} @command{ptx} is not known to work on
4755 smaller MS-DOS machines anymore.) Compared to 7-bit @acronym{ASCII}, the set
4756 of characters which are letters is different; this alters the behavior
4757 of regular expression matching. Thus, the default regular expression
4758 for a keyword allows foreign or diacriticized letters. Keyword sorting,
4759 however, is still crude; it obeys the underlying character set ordering
4765 @itemx --ignore-case
4766 Fold lower case letters to upper case for sorting.
4771 @node Input processing in ptx
4772 @subsection Word selection and input processing
4777 @itemx --break-file=@var{file}
4779 This option provides an alternative (to @option{-W}) method of describing
4780 which characters make up words. It introduces the name of a
4781 file which contains a list of characters which can@emph{not} be part of
4782 one word; this file is called the @dfn{Break file}. Any character which
4783 is not part of the Break file is a word constituent. If both options
4784 @option{-b} and @option{-W} are specified, then @option{-W} has precedence and
4785 @option{-b} is ignored.
4787 When @sc{gnu} extensions are enabled, the only way to avoid newline as a
4788 break character is to write all the break characters in the file with no
4789 newline at all, not even at the end of the file. When @sc{gnu} extensions
4790 are disabled, spaces, tabs and newlines are always considered as break
4791 characters even if not included in the Break file.
4794 @itemx --ignore-file=@var{file}
4796 The file associated with this option contains a list of words which will
4797 never be taken as keywords in concordance output. It is called the
4798 @dfn{Ignore file}. The file contains exactly one word in each line; the
4799 end of line separation of words is not subject to the value of the
4803 @itemx --only-file=@var{file}
4805 The file associated with this option contains a list of words which will
4806 be retained in concordance output; any word not mentioned in this file
4807 is ignored. The file is called the @dfn{Only file}. The file contains
4808 exactly one word in each line; the end of line separation of words is
4809 not subject to the value of the @option{-S} option.
4811 There is no default for the Only file. When both an Only file and an
4812 Ignore file are specified, a word is considered a keyword only
4813 if it is listed in the Only file and not in the Ignore file.
4818 On each input line, the leading sequence of non-white space characters will be
4819 taken to be a reference that has the purpose of identifying this input
4820 line in the resulting permuted index. For more information about reference
4821 production, see @xref{Output formatting in ptx}.
4822 Using this option changes the default value for option @option{-S}.
4824 Using this option, the program does not try very hard to remove
4825 references from contexts in output, but it succeeds in doing so
4826 @emph{when} the context ends exactly at the newline. If option
4827 @option{-r} is used with @option{-S} default value, or when @sc{gnu} extensions
4828 are disabled, this condition is always met and references are completely
4829 excluded from the output contexts.
4831 @item -S @var{regexp}
4832 @itemx --sentence-regexp=@var{regexp}
4834 This option selects which regular expression will describe the end of a
4835 line or the end of a sentence. In fact, this regular expression is not
4836 the only distinction between end of lines or end of sentences, and input
4837 line boundaries have no special significance outside this option. By
4838 default, when @sc{gnu} extensions are enabled and if @option{-r} option is not
4839 used, end of sentences are used. In this case, this @var{regex} is
4840 imported from @sc{gnu} Emacs:
4843 [.?!][]\"')@}]*\\($\\|\t\\| \\)[ \t\n]*
4846 Whenever @sc{gnu} extensions are disabled or if @option{-r} option is used, end
4847 of lines are used; in this case, the default @var{regexp} is just:
4853 Using an empty @var{regexp} is equivalent to completely disabling end of
4854 line or end of sentence recognition. In this case, the whole file is
4855 considered to be a single big line or sentence. The user might want to
4856 disallow all truncation flag generation as well, through option @option{-F
4857 ""}. @xref{Regexps, , Syntax of Regular Expressions, emacs, The GNU Emacs
4860 When the keywords happen to be near the beginning of the input line or
4861 sentence, this often creates an unused area at the beginning of the
4862 output context line; when the keywords happen to be near the end of the
4863 input line or sentence, this often creates an unused area at the end of
4864 the output context line. The program tries to fill those unused areas
4865 by wrapping around context in them; the tail of the input line or
4866 sentence is used to fill the unused area on the left of the output line;
4867 the head of the input line or sentence is used to fill the unused area
4868 on the right of the output line.
4870 As a matter of convenience to the user, many usual backslashed escape
4871 sequences from the C language are recognized and converted to the
4872 corresponding characters by @command{ptx} itself.
4874 @item -W @var{regexp}
4875 @itemx --word-regexp=@var{regexp}
4877 This option selects which regular expression will describe each keyword.
4878 By default, if @sc{gnu} extensions are enabled, a word is a sequence of
4879 letters; the @var{regexp} used is @samp{\w+}. When @sc{gnu} extensions are
4880 disabled, a word is by default anything which ends with a space, a tab
4881 or a newline; the @var{regexp} used is @samp{[^ \t\n]+}.
4883 An empty @var{regexp} is equivalent to not using this option.
4884 @xref{Regexps, , Syntax of Regular Expressions, emacs, The GNU Emacs
4887 As a matter of convenience to the user, many usual backslashed escape
4888 sequences, as found in the C language, are recognized and converted to
4889 the corresponding characters by @command{ptx} itself.
4894 @node Output formatting in ptx
4895 @subsection Output formatting
4897 Output format is mainly controlled by the @option{-O} and @option{-T} options
4898 described in the table below. When neither @option{-O} nor @option{-T} are
4899 selected, and if @sc{gnu} extensions are enabled, the program chooses an
4900 output format suitable for a dumb terminal. Each keyword occurrence is
4901 output to the center of one line, surrounded by its left and right
4902 contexts. Each field is properly justified, so the concordance output
4903 can be readily observed. As a special feature, if automatic
4904 references are selected by option @option{-A} and are output before the
4905 left context, that is, if option @option{-R} is @emph{not} selected, then
4906 a colon is added after the reference; this nicely interfaces with @sc{gnu}
4907 Emacs @code{next-error} processing. In this default output format, each
4908 white space character, like newline and tab, is merely changed to
4909 exactly one space, with no special attempt to compress consecutive
4910 spaces. This might change in the future. Except for those white space
4911 characters, every other character of the underlying set of 256
4912 characters is transmitted verbatim.
4914 Output format is further controlled by the following options.
4918 @item -g @var{number}
4919 @itemx --gap-size=@var{number}
4921 Select the size of the minimum white space gap between the fields on the
4924 @item -w @var{number}
4925 @itemx --width=@var{number}
4927 Select the maximum output width of each final line. If references are
4928 used, they are included or excluded from the maximum output width
4929 depending on the value of option @option{-R}. If this option is not
4930 selected, that is, when references are output before the left context,
4931 the maximum output width takes into account the maximum length of all
4932 references. If this option is selected, that is, when references are
4933 output after the right context, the maximum output width does not take
4934 into account the space taken by references, nor the gap that precedes
4938 @itemx --auto-reference
4940 Select automatic references. Each input line will have an automatic
4941 reference made up of the file name and the line ordinal, with a single
4942 colon between them. However, the file name will be empty when standard
4943 input is being read. If both @option{-A} and @option{-r} are selected, then
4944 the input reference is still read and skipped, but the automatic
4945 reference is used at output time, overriding the input reference.
4948 @itemx --right-side-refs
4950 In the default output format, when option @option{-R} is not used, any
4951 references produced by the effect of options @option{-r} or @option{-A} are
4952 placed to the far right of output lines, after the right context. With
4953 default output format, when the @option{-R} option is specified, references
4954 are rather placed at the beginning of each output line, before the left
4955 context. For any other output format, option @option{-R} is
4956 ignored, with one exception: with @option{-R} the width of references
4957 is @emph{not} taken into account in total output width given by @option{-w}.
4959 This option is automatically selected whenever @sc{gnu} extensions are
4962 @item -F @var{string}
4963 @itemx --flac-truncation=@var{string}
4965 This option will request that any truncation in the output be reported
4966 using the string @var{string}. Most output fields theoretically extend
4967 towards the beginning or the end of the current line, or current
4968 sentence, as selected with option @option{-S}. But there is a maximum
4969 allowed output line width, changeable through option @option{-w}, which is
4970 further divided into space for various output fields. When a field has
4971 to be truncated because it cannot extend beyond the beginning or the end of
4972 the current line to fit in, then a truncation occurs. By default,
4973 the string used is a single slash, as in @option{-F /}.
4975 @var{string} may have more than one character, as in @option{-F ...}.
4976 Also, in the particular case when @var{string} is empty (@option{-F ""}),
4977 truncation flagging is disabled, and no truncation marks are appended in
4980 As a matter of convenience to the user, many usual backslashed escape
4981 sequences, as found in the C language, are recognized and converted to
4982 the corresponding characters by @command{ptx} itself.
4984 @item -M @var{string}
4985 @itemx --macro-name=@var{string}
4987 Select another @var{string} to be used instead of @samp{xx}, while
4988 generating output suitable for @command{nroff}, @command{troff} or @TeX{}.
4991 @itemx --format=roff
4993 Choose an output format suitable for @command{nroff} or @command{troff}
4994 processing. Each output line will look like:
4997 .xx "@var{tail}" "@var{before}" "@var{keyword_and_after}" "@var{head}" "@var{ref}"
5000 so it will be possible to write a @samp{.xx} roff macro to take care of
5001 the output typesetting. This is the default output format when @sc{gnu}
5002 extensions are disabled. Option @option{-M} can be used to change
5003 @samp{xx} to another macro name.
5005 In this output format, each non-graphical character, like newline and
5006 tab, is merely changed to exactly one space, with no special attempt to
5007 compress consecutive spaces. Each quote character: @kbd{"} is doubled
5008 so it will be correctly processed by @command{nroff} or @command{troff}.
5013 Choose an output format suitable for @TeX{} processing. Each output
5014 line will look like:
5017 \xx @{@var{tail}@}@{@var{before}@}@{@var{keyword}@}@{@var{after}@}@{@var{head}@}@{@var{ref}@}
5021 so it will be possible to write a @code{\xx} definition to take care of
5022 the output typesetting. Note that when references are not being
5023 produced, that is, neither option @option{-A} nor option @option{-r} is
5024 selected, the last parameter of each @code{\xx} call is inhibited.
5025 Option @option{-M} can be used to change @samp{xx} to another macro
5028 In this output format, some special characters, like @kbd{$}, @kbd{%},
5029 @kbd{&}, @kbd{#} and @kbd{_} are automatically protected with a
5030 backslash. Curly brackets @kbd{@{}, @kbd{@}} are protected with a
5031 backslash and a pair of dollar signs (to force mathematical mode). The
5032 backslash itself produces the sequence @code{\backslash@{@}}.
5033 Circumflex and tilde diacritical marks produce the sequence @code{^\@{ @}} and
5034 @code{~\@{ @}} respectively. Other diacriticized characters of the
5035 underlying character set produce an appropriate @TeX{} sequence as far
5036 as possible. The other non-graphical characters, like newline and tab,
5037 and all other characters which are not part of @acronym{ASCII}, are merely
5038 changed to exactly one space, with no special attempt to compress
5039 consecutive spaces. Let me know how to improve this special character
5040 processing for @TeX{}.
5045 @node Compatibility in ptx
5046 @subsection The @sc{gnu} extensions to @command{ptx}
5048 This version of @command{ptx} contains a few features which do not exist in
5049 System V @command{ptx}. These extra features are suppressed by using the
5050 @option{-G} command line option, unless overridden by other command line
5051 options. Some @sc{gnu} extensions cannot be recovered by overriding, so the
5052 simple rule is to avoid @option{-G} if you care about @sc{gnu} extensions.
5053 Here are the differences between this program and System V @command{ptx}.
5058 This program can read many input files at once, it always writes the
5059 resulting concordance on standard output. On the other hand, System V
5060 @command{ptx} reads only one file and sends the result to standard output
5061 or, if a second @var{file} parameter is given on the command, to that
5064 Having output parameters not introduced by options is a dangerous
5065 practice which @sc{gnu} avoids as far as possible. So, for using @command{ptx}
5066 portably between @sc{gnu} and System V, you should always use it with a
5067 single input file, and always expect the result on standard output. You
5068 might also want to automatically configure in a @option{-G} option to
5069 @command{ptx} calls in products using @command{ptx}, if the configurator finds
5070 that the installed @command{ptx} accepts @option{-G}.
5073 The only options available in System V @command{ptx} are options @option{-b},
5074 @option{-f}, @option{-g}, @option{-i}, @option{-o}, @option{-r}, @option{-t} and
5075 @option{-w}. All other options are @sc{gnu} extensions and are not repeated in
5076 this enumeration. Moreover, some options have a slightly different
5077 meaning when @sc{gnu} extensions are enabled, as explained below.
5080 By default, concordance output is not formatted for @command{troff} or
5081 @command{nroff}. It is rather formatted for a dumb terminal. @command{troff}
5082 or @command{nroff} output may still be selected through option @option{-O}.
5085 Unless @option{-R} option is used, the maximum reference width is
5086 subtracted from the total output line width. With @sc{gnu} extensions
5087 disabled, width of references is not taken into account in the output
5088 line width computations.
5091 All 256 bytes, even null bytes, are always read and processed from
5092 input file with no adverse effect, even if @sc{gnu} extensions are disabled.
5093 However, System V @command{ptx} does not accept 8-bit characters, a few
5094 control characters are rejected, and the tilde @kbd{~} is also rejected.
5097 Input line length is only limited by available memory, even if @sc{gnu}
5098 extensions are disabled. However, System V @command{ptx} processes only
5099 the first 200 characters in each line.
5102 The break (non-word) characters default to be every character except all
5103 letters of the underlying character set, diacriticized or not. When @sc{gnu}
5104 extensions are disabled, the break characters default to space, tab and
5108 The program makes better use of output line width. If @sc{gnu} extensions
5109 are disabled, the program rather tries to imitate System V @command{ptx},
5110 but still, there are some slight disposition glitches this program does
5111 not completely reproduce.
5114 The user can specify both an Ignore file and an Only file. This is not
5115 allowed with System V @command{ptx}.
5120 @node Operating on fields within a line
5121 @chapter Operating on fields within a line
5124 * cut invocation:: Print selected parts of lines.
5125 * paste invocation:: Merge lines of files.
5126 * join invocation:: Join lines on a common field.
5130 @node cut invocation
5131 @section @command{cut}: Print selected parts of lines
5134 @command{cut} writes to standard output selected parts of each line of each
5135 input file, or standard input if no files are given or for a file name of
5139 cut @var{option}@dots{} [@var{file}]@dots{}
5142 In the table which follows, the @var{byte-list}, @var{character-list},
5143 and @var{field-list} are one or more numbers or ranges (two numbers
5144 separated by a dash) separated by commas. Bytes, characters, and
5145 fields are numbered starting at 1. Incomplete ranges may be
5146 given: @option{-@var{m}} means @samp{1-@var{m}}; @samp{@var{n}-} means
5147 @samp{@var{n}} through end of line or last field. The list elements
5148 can be repeated, can overlap, and can be specified in any order; but
5149 the selected input is written in the same order that it is read, and
5150 is written exactly once.
5152 The program accepts the following options. Also see @ref{Common
5157 @item -b @var{byte-list}
5158 @itemx --bytes=@var{byte-list}
5161 Select for printing only the bytes in positions listed in
5162 @var{byte-list}. Tabs and backspaces are treated like any other
5163 character; they take up 1 byte. If an output delimiter is specified,
5164 (see the description of @option{--output-delimiter}), then output that
5165 string between ranges of selected bytes.
5167 @item -c @var{character-list}
5168 @itemx --characters=@var{character-list}
5170 @opindex --characters
5171 Select for printing only the characters in positions listed in
5172 @var{character-list}. The same as @option{-b} for now, but
5173 internationalization will change that. Tabs and backspaces are
5174 treated like any other character; they take up 1 character. If an
5175 output delimiter is specified, (see the description of
5176 @option{--output-delimiter}), then output that string between ranges
5179 @item -f @var{field-list}
5180 @itemx --fields=@var{field-list}
5183 Select for printing only the fields listed in @var{field-list}.
5184 Fields are separated by a TAB character by default. Also print any
5185 line that contains no delimiter character, unless the
5186 @option{--only-delimited} (@option{-s}) option is specified
5188 @item -d @var{input_delim_byte}
5189 @itemx --delimiter=@var{input_delim_byte}
5191 @opindex --delimiter
5192 With @option{-f}, use the first byte of @var{input_delim_byte} as
5193 the input fields separator (default is TAB).
5197 Do not split multi-byte characters (no-op for now).
5200 @itemx --only-delimited
5202 @opindex --only-delimited
5203 For @option{-f}, do not print lines that do not contain the field separator
5204 character. Normally, any line without a field separator is printed verbatim.
5206 @item --output-delimiter=@var{output_delim_string}
5207 @opindex --output-delimiter
5208 With @option{-f}, output fields are separated by @var{output_delim_string}.
5209 The default with @option{-f} is to use the input delimiter.
5210 When using @option{-b} or @option{-c} to select ranges of byte or
5211 character offsets (as opposed to ranges of fields),
5212 output @var{output_delim_string} between non-overlapping
5213 ranges of selected bytes.
5216 @opindex --complement
5217 This option is a @acronym{GNU} extension.
5218 Select for printing the complement of the bytes, characters or fields
5219 selected with the @option{-b}, @option{-c} or @option{-f} options.
5220 In other words, do @emph{not} print the bytes, characters or fields
5221 specified via those options. This option is useful when you have
5222 many fields and want to print all but a few of them.
5229 @node paste invocation
5230 @section @command{paste}: Merge lines of files
5233 @cindex merging files
5235 @command{paste} writes to standard output lines consisting of sequentially
5236 corresponding lines of each given file, separated by a TAB character.
5237 Standard input is used for a file name of @samp{-} or if no input files
5259 paste [@var{option}]@dots{} [@var{file}]@dots{}
5262 The program accepts the following options. Also see @ref{Common options}.
5270 Paste the lines of one file at a time rather than one line from each
5271 file. Using the above example data:
5274 $ paste -s num2 let3
5279 @item -d @var{delim-list}
5280 @itemx --delimiters=@var{delim-list}
5282 @opindex --delimiters
5283 Consecutively use the characters in @var{delim-list} instead of
5284 TAB to separate merged lines. When @var{delim-list} is
5285 exhausted, start again at its beginning. Using the above example data:
5288 $ paste -d '%_' num2 let3 num2
5299 @node join invocation
5300 @section @command{join}: Join lines on a common field
5303 @cindex common field, joining on
5305 @command{join} writes to standard output a line for each pair of input
5306 lines that have identical join fields. Synopsis:
5309 join [@var{option}]@dots{} @var{file1} @var{file2}
5312 Either @var{file1} or @var{file2} (but not both) can be @samp{-},
5313 meaning standard input. @var{file1} and @var{file2} should be
5314 sorted on the join fields.
5317 Normally, the sort order is that of the
5318 collating sequence specified by the @env{LC_COLLATE} locale. Unless
5319 the @option{-t} option is given, the sort comparison ignores blanks at
5320 the start of the join field, as in @code{sort -b}. If the
5321 @option{--ignore-case} option is given, the sort comparison ignores
5322 the case of characters in the join field, as in @code{sort -f}.
5324 The @command{sort} and @command{join} commands should use consistent
5325 locales and options if the output of @command{sort} is fed to
5326 @command{join}. You can use a command like @samp{sort -k 1b,1} to
5327 sort a file on its default join field, but if you select a non-default
5328 locale, join field, separator, or comparison options, then you should
5329 do so consistently between @command{join} and @command{sort}.
5331 If the input has no unpairable lines, a @acronym{GNU} extension is
5332 available; the sort order can be any order that considers two fields
5333 to be equal if and only if the sort comparison described above
5334 considers them to be equal. For example:
5351 @checkOrderOption{join}
5355 @item the join field is the first field in each line;
5356 @item fields in the input are separated by one or more blanks, with leading
5357 blanks on the line ignored;
5358 @item fields in the output are separated by a space;
5359 @item each output line consists of the join field, the remaining
5360 fields from @var{file1}, then the remaining fields from @var{file2}.
5363 The program accepts the following options. Also see @ref{Common options}.
5367 @item -a @var{file-number}
5369 Print a line for each unpairable line in file @var{file-number} (either
5370 @samp{1} or @samp{2}), in addition to the normal output.
5373 Fail with an error message if either input file is wrongly ordered.
5375 @item --nocheck-order
5376 Do not check that both input files are in sorted order. This is the default.
5378 @item -e @var{string}
5380 Replace those output fields that are missing in the input with
5384 @itemx --ignore-case
5386 @opindex --ignore-case
5387 Ignore differences in case when comparing keys.
5388 With this option, the lines of the input files must be ordered in the same way.
5389 Use @samp{sort -f} to produce this ordering.
5391 @item -1 @var{field}
5393 Join on field @var{field} (a positive integer) of file 1.
5395 @item -2 @var{field}
5397 Join on field @var{field} (a positive integer) of file 2.
5399 @item -j @var{field}
5400 Equivalent to @option{-1 @var{field} -2 @var{field}}.
5402 @item -o @var{field-list}
5403 Construct each output line according to the format in @var{field-list}.
5404 Each element in @var{field-list} is either the single character @samp{0} or
5405 has the form @var{m.n} where the file number, @var{m}, is @samp{1} or
5406 @samp{2} and @var{n} is a positive field number.
5408 A field specification of @samp{0} denotes the join field.
5409 In most cases, the functionality of the @samp{0} field spec
5410 may be reproduced using the explicit @var{m.n} that corresponds
5411 to the join field. However, when printing unpairable lines
5412 (using either of the @option{-a} or @option{-v} options), there is no way
5413 to specify the join field using @var{m.n} in @var{field-list}
5414 if there are unpairable lines in both files.
5415 To give @command{join} that functionality, @acronym{POSIX} invented the @samp{0}
5416 field specification notation.
5418 The elements in @var{field-list}
5419 are separated by commas or blanks.
5420 Blank separators typically need to be quoted for the shell. For
5421 example, the commands @samp{join -o 1.2,2.2} and @samp{join -o '1.2
5422 2.2'} are equivalent.
5424 All output lines---including those printed because of any -a or -v
5425 option---are subject to the specified @var{field-list}.
5428 Use character @var{char} as the input and output field separator.
5429 Treat as significant each occurrence of @var{char} in the input file.
5430 Use @samp{sort -t @var{char}}, without the @option{-b} option of
5431 @samp{sort}, to produce this ordering.
5433 @item -v @var{file-number}
5434 Print a line for each unpairable line in file @var{file-number}
5435 (either @samp{1} or @samp{2}), instead of the normal output.
5442 @node Operating on characters
5443 @chapter Operating on characters
5445 @cindex operating on characters
5447 This commands operate on individual characters.
5450 * tr invocation:: Translate, squeeze, and/or delete characters.
5451 * expand invocation:: Convert tabs to spaces.
5452 * unexpand invocation:: Convert spaces to tabs.
5457 @section @command{tr}: Translate, squeeze, and/or delete characters
5464 tr [@var{option}]@dots{} @var{set1} [@var{set2}]
5467 @command{tr} copies standard input to standard output, performing
5468 one of the following operations:
5472 translate, and optionally squeeze repeated characters in the result,
5474 squeeze repeated characters,
5478 delete characters, then squeeze repeated characters from the result.
5481 The @var{set1} and (if given) @var{set2} arguments define ordered
5482 sets of characters, referred to below as @var{set1} and @var{set2}. These
5483 sets are the characters of the input that @command{tr} operates on.
5484 The @option{--complement} (@option{-c}, @option{-C}) option replaces
5486 complement (all of the characters that are not in @var{set1}).
5488 Currently @command{tr} fully supports only single-byte characters.
5489 Eventually it will support multibyte characters; when it does, the
5490 @option{-C} option will cause it to complement the set of characters,
5491 whereas @option{-c} will cause it to complement the set of values.
5492 This distinction will matter only when some values are not characters,
5493 and this is possible only in locales using multibyte encodings when
5494 the input contains encoding errors.
5496 The program accepts the @option{--help} and @option{--version}
5497 options. @xref{Common options}. Options must precede operands.
5502 * Character sets:: Specifying sets of characters.
5503 * Translating:: Changing one set of characters to another.
5504 * Squeezing:: Squeezing repeats and deleting.
5508 @node Character sets
5509 @subsection Specifying sets of characters
5511 @cindex specifying sets of characters
5513 The format of the @var{set1} and @var{set2} arguments resembles
5514 the format of regular expressions; however, they are not regular
5515 expressions, only lists of characters. Most characters simply
5516 represent themselves in these strings, but the strings can contain
5517 the shorthands listed below, for convenience. Some of them can be
5518 used only in @var{set1} or @var{set2}, as noted below.
5522 @item Backslash escapes
5523 @cindex backslash escapes
5525 The following backslash escape sequences are recognized:
5543 The character with the value given by @var{ooo}, which is 1 to 3
5549 While a backslash followed by a character not listed above is
5550 interpreted as that character, the backslash also effectively
5551 removes any special significance, so it is useful to escape
5552 @samp{[}, @samp{]}, @samp{*}, and @samp{-}.
5557 The notation @samp{@var{m}-@var{n}} expands to all of the characters
5558 from @var{m} through @var{n}, in ascending order. @var{m} should
5559 collate before @var{n}; if it doesn't, an error results. As an example,
5560 @samp{0-9} is the same as @samp{0123456789}.
5562 @sc{gnu} @command{tr} does not support the System V syntax that uses square
5563 brackets to enclose ranges. Translations specified in that format
5564 sometimes work as expected, since the brackets are often transliterated
5565 to themselves. However, they should be avoided because they sometimes
5566 behave unexpectedly. For example, @samp{tr -d '[0-9]'} deletes brackets
5569 Many historically common and even accepted uses of ranges are not
5570 portable. For example, on @acronym{EBCDIC} hosts using the @samp{A-Z}
5571 range will not do what most would expect because @samp{A} through @samp{Z}
5572 are not contiguous as they are in @acronym{ASCII}.
5573 If you can rely on a @acronym{POSIX} compliant version of @command{tr}, then
5574 the best way to work around this is to use character classes (see below).
5575 Otherwise, it is most portable (and most ugly) to enumerate the members
5578 @item Repeated characters
5579 @cindex repeated characters
5581 The notation @samp{[@var{c}*@var{n}]} in @var{set2} expands to @var{n}
5582 copies of character @var{c}. Thus, @samp{[y*6]} is the same as
5583 @samp{yyyyyy}. The notation @samp{[@var{c}*]} in @var{string2} expands
5584 to as many copies of @var{c} as are needed to make @var{set2} as long as
5585 @var{set1}. If @var{n} begins with @samp{0}, it is interpreted in
5586 octal, otherwise in decimal.
5588 @item Character classes
5589 @cindex character classes
5591 The notation @samp{[:@var{class}:]} expands to all of the characters in
5592 the (predefined) class @var{class}. The characters expand in no
5593 particular order, except for the @code{upper} and @code{lower} classes,
5594 which expand in ascending order. When the @option{--delete} (@option{-d})
5595 and @option{--squeeze-repeats} (@option{-s}) options are both given, any
5596 character class can be used in @var{set2}. Otherwise, only the
5597 character classes @code{lower} and @code{upper} are accepted in
5598 @var{set2}, and then only if the corresponding character class
5599 (@code{upper} and @code{lower}, respectively) is specified in the same
5600 relative position in @var{set1}. Doing this specifies case conversion.
5601 The class names are given below; an error results when an invalid class
5613 Horizontal whitespace.
5622 Printable characters, not including space.
5628 Printable characters, including space.
5631 Punctuation characters.
5634 Horizontal or vertical whitespace.
5643 @item Equivalence classes
5644 @cindex equivalence classes
5646 The syntax @samp{[=@var{c}=]} expands to all of the characters that are
5647 equivalent to @var{c}, in no particular order. Equivalence classes are
5648 a relatively recent invention intended to support non-English alphabets.
5649 But there seems to be no standard way to define them or determine their
5650 contents. Therefore, they are not fully implemented in @sc{gnu} @command{tr};
5651 each character's equivalence class consists only of that character,
5652 which is of no particular use.
5658 @subsection Translating
5660 @cindex translating characters
5662 @command{tr} performs translation when @var{set1} and @var{set2} are
5663 both given and the @option{--delete} (@option{-d}) option is not given.
5664 @command{tr} translates each character of its input that is in @var{set1}
5665 to the corresponding character in @var{set2}. Characters not in
5666 @var{set1} are passed through unchanged. When a character appears more
5667 than once in @var{set1} and the corresponding characters in @var{set2}
5668 are not all the same, only the final one is used. For example, these
5669 two commands are equivalent:
5676 A common use of @command{tr} is to convert lowercase characters to
5677 uppercase. This can be done in many ways. Here are three of them:
5680 tr abcdefghijklmnopqrstuvwxyz ABCDEFGHIJKLMNOPQRSTUVWXYZ
5682 tr '[:lower:]' '[:upper:]'
5686 But note that using ranges like @code{a-z} above is not portable.
5688 When @command{tr} is performing translation, @var{set1} and @var{set2}
5689 typically have the same length. If @var{set1} is shorter than
5690 @var{set2}, the extra characters at the end of @var{set2} are ignored.
5692 On the other hand, making @var{set1} longer than @var{set2} is not
5693 portable; @acronym{POSIX} says that the result is undefined. In this situation,
5694 BSD @command{tr} pads @var{set2} to the length of @var{set1} by repeating
5695 the last character of @var{set2} as many times as necessary. System V
5696 @command{tr} truncates @var{set1} to the length of @var{set2}.
5698 By default, @sc{gnu} @command{tr} handles this case like BSD @command{tr}.
5699 When the @option{--truncate-set1} (@option{-t}) option is given,
5700 @sc{gnu} @command{tr} handles this case like the System V @command{tr}
5701 instead. This option is ignored for operations other than translation.
5703 Acting like System V @command{tr} in this case breaks the relatively common
5707 tr -cs A-Za-z0-9 '\012'
5711 because it converts only zero bytes (the first element in the
5712 complement of @var{set1}), rather than all non-alphanumerics, to
5716 By the way, the above idiom is not portable because it uses ranges, and
5717 it assumes that the octal code for newline is 012.
5718 Assuming a @acronym{POSIX} compliant @command{tr}, here is a better way to write it:
5721 tr -cs '[:alnum:]' '[\n*]'
5726 @subsection Squeezing repeats and deleting
5728 @cindex squeezing repeat characters
5729 @cindex deleting characters
5731 When given just the @option{--delete} (@option{-d}) option, @command{tr}
5732 removes any input characters that are in @var{set1}.
5734 When given just the @option{--squeeze-repeats} (@option{-s}) option,
5735 @command{tr} replaces each input sequence of a repeated character that
5736 is in @var{set1} with a single occurrence of that character.
5738 When given both @option{--delete} and @option{--squeeze-repeats}, @command{tr}
5739 first performs any deletions using @var{set1}, then squeezes repeats
5740 from any remaining characters using @var{set2}.
5742 The @option{--squeeze-repeats} option may also be used when translating,
5743 in which case @command{tr} first performs translation, then squeezes
5744 repeats from any remaining characters using @var{set2}.
5746 Here are some examples to illustrate various combinations of options:
5751 Remove all zero bytes:
5758 Put all words on lines by themselves. This converts all
5759 non-alphanumeric characters to newlines, then squeezes each string
5760 of repeated newlines into a single newline:
5763 tr -cs '[:alnum:]' '[\n*]'
5767 Convert each sequence of repeated newlines to a single newline:
5774 Find doubled occurrences of words in a document.
5775 @c Separate the following two "the"s, so typo checkers don't complain.
5776 For example, people often write ``the @w{}the'' with the repeated words
5777 separated by a newline. The Bourne shell script below works first
5778 by converting each sequence of punctuation and blank characters to a
5779 single newline. That puts each ``word'' on a line by itself.
5780 Next it maps all uppercase characters to lower case, and finally it
5781 runs @command{uniq} with the @option{-d} option to print out only the words
5787 | tr -s '[:punct:][:blank:]' '[\n*]' \
5788 | tr '[:upper:]' '[:lower:]' \
5793 Deleting a small set of characters is usually straightforward. For example,
5794 to remove all @samp{a}s, @samp{x}s, and @samp{M}s you would do this:
5800 However, when @samp{-} is one of those characters, it can be tricky because
5801 @samp{-} has special meanings. Performing the same task as above but also
5802 removing all @samp{-} characters, we might try @code{tr -d -axM}, but
5803 that would fail because @command{tr} would try to interpret @option{-a} as
5804 a command-line option. Alternatively, we could try putting the hyphen
5805 inside the string, @code{tr -d a-xM}, but that wouldn't work either because
5806 it would make @command{tr} interpret @code{a-x} as the range of characters
5807 @samp{a}@dots{}@samp{x} rather than the three.
5808 One way to solve the problem is to put the hyphen at the end of the list
5815 Or you can use @samp{--} to terminate option processing:
5821 More generally, use the character class notation @code{[=c=]}
5822 with @samp{-} (or any other character) in place of the @samp{c}:
5828 Note how single quotes are used in the above example to protect the
5829 square brackets from interpretation by a shell.
5834 @node expand invocation
5835 @section @command{expand}: Convert tabs to spaces
5838 @cindex tabs to spaces, converting
5839 @cindex converting tabs to spaces
5841 @command{expand} writes the contents of each given @var{file}, or standard
5842 input if none are given or for a @var{file} of @samp{-}, to standard
5843 output, with tab characters converted to the appropriate number of
5847 expand [@var{option}]@dots{} [@var{file}]@dots{}
5850 By default, @command{expand} converts all tabs to spaces. It preserves
5851 backspace characters in the output; they decrement the column count for
5852 tab calculations. The default action is equivalent to @option{-t 8} (set
5853 tabs every 8 columns).
5855 The program accepts the following options. Also see @ref{Common options}.
5859 @item -t @var{tab1}[,@var{tab2}]@dots{}
5860 @itemx --tabs=@var{tab1}[,@var{tab2}]@dots{}
5863 @cindex tab stops, setting
5864 If only one tab stop is given, set the tabs @var{tab1} spaces apart
5865 (default is 8). Otherwise, set the tabs at columns @var{tab1},
5866 @var{tab2}, @dots{} (numbered from 0), and replace any tabs beyond the
5867 last tab stop given with single spaces. Tab stops can be separated by
5868 blanks as well as by commas.
5870 For compatibility, GNU @command{expand} also accepts the obsolete
5871 option syntax, @option{-@var{t1}[,@var{t2}]@dots{}}. New scripts
5872 should use @option{-t @var{t1}[,@var{t2}]@dots{}} instead.
5878 @cindex initial tabs, converting
5879 Only convert initial tabs (those that precede all non-space or non-tab
5880 characters) on each line to spaces.
5887 @node unexpand invocation
5888 @section @command{unexpand}: Convert spaces to tabs
5892 @command{unexpand} writes the contents of each given @var{file}, or
5893 standard input if none are given or for a @var{file} of @samp{-}, to
5894 standard output, converting blanks at the beginning of each line into
5895 as many tab characters as needed. In the default @acronym{POSIX}
5896 locale, a @dfn{blank} is a space or a tab; other locales may specify
5897 additional blank characters. Synopsis:
5900 unexpand [@var{option}]@dots{} [@var{file}]@dots{}
5903 By default, @command{unexpand} converts only initial blanks (those
5904 that precede all non-blank characters) on each line. It
5905 preserves backspace characters in the output; they decrement the column
5906 count for tab calculations. By default, tabs are set at every 8th
5909 The program accepts the following options. Also see @ref{Common options}.
5913 @item -t @var{tab1}[,@var{tab2}]@dots{}
5914 @itemx --tabs=@var{tab1}[,@var{tab2}]@dots{}
5917 If only one tab stop is given, set the tabs @var{tab1} columns apart
5918 instead of the default 8. Otherwise, set the tabs at columns
5919 @var{tab1}, @var{tab2}, @dots{} (numbered from 0), and leave blanks
5920 beyond the tab stops given unchanged. Tab stops can be separated by
5921 blanks as well as by commas. This option implies the @option{-a} option.
5923 For compatibility, GNU @command{unexpand} supports the obsolete option syntax,
5924 @option{-@var{tab1}[,@var{tab2}]@dots{}}, where tab stops must be
5925 separated by commas. (Unlike @option{-t}, this obsolete option does
5926 not imply @option{-a}.) New scripts should use @option{--first-only -t
5927 @var{tab1}[,@var{tab2}]@dots{}} instead.
5933 Also convert all sequences of two or more blanks just before a tab stop,
5934 even if they occur after non-blank characters in a line.
5941 @node Directory listing
5942 @chapter Directory listing
5944 This chapter describes the @command{ls} command and its variants @command{dir}
5945 and @command{vdir}, which list information about files.
5948 * ls invocation:: List directory contents.
5949 * dir invocation:: Briefly ls.
5950 * vdir invocation:: Verbosely ls.
5951 * dircolors invocation:: Color setup for ls, etc.
5956 @section @command{ls}: List directory contents
5959 @cindex directory listing
5961 The @command{ls} program lists information about files (of any type,
5962 including directories). Options and file arguments can be intermixed
5963 arbitrarily, as usual.
5965 For non-option command-line arguments that are directories, by default
5966 @command{ls} lists the contents of directories, not recursively, and
5967 omitting files with names beginning with @samp{.}. For other non-option
5968 arguments, by default @command{ls} lists just the file name. If no
5969 non-option argument is specified, @command{ls} operates on the current
5970 directory, acting as if it had been invoked with a single argument of @samp{.}.
5973 By default, the output is sorted alphabetically, according to the locale
5974 settings in effect.@footnote{If you use a non-@acronym{POSIX}
5975 locale (e.g., by setting @env{LC_ALL} to @samp{en_US}), then @command{ls} may
5976 produce output that is sorted differently than you're accustomed to.
5977 In that case, set the @env{LC_ALL} environment variable to @samp{C}.}
5978 If standard output is
5979 a terminal, the output is in columns (sorted vertically) and control
5980 characters are output as question marks; otherwise, the output is listed
5981 one per line and control characters are output as-is.
5983 Because @command{ls} is such a fundamental program, it has accumulated many
5984 options over the years. They are described in the subsections below;
5985 within each section, options are listed alphabetically (ignoring case).
5986 The division of options into the subsections is not absolute, since some
5987 options affect more than one aspect of @command{ls}'s operation.
5989 @cindex exit status of @command{ls}
5994 1 minor problems (e.g., a subdirectory was not found)
5995 2 serious trouble (e.g., memory exhausted)
5998 Also see @ref{Common options}.
6001 * Which files are listed::
6002 * What information is listed::
6003 * Sorting the output::
6004 * More details about version sort::
6005 * General output formatting::
6006 * Formatting file timestamps::
6007 * Formatting the file names::
6011 @node Which files are listed
6012 @subsection Which files are listed
6014 These options determine which files @command{ls} lists information for.
6015 By default, @command{ls} lists files and the contents of any
6016 directories on the command line, except that in directories it ignores
6017 files whose names start with @samp{.}.
6025 In directories, do not ignore file names that start with @samp{.}.
6030 @opindex --almost-all
6031 In directories, do not ignore all file names that start with @samp{.};
6032 ignore only @file{.} and @file{..}. The @option{--all} (@option{-a})
6033 option overrides this option.
6036 @itemx --ignore-backups
6038 @opindex --ignore-backups
6039 @cindex backup files, ignoring
6040 In directories, ignore files that end with @samp{~}. This option is
6041 equivalent to @samp{--ignore='*~' --ignore='.*~'}.
6046 @opindex --directory
6047 List just the names of directories, as with other types of files, rather
6048 than listing their contents.
6049 @c The following sentence is the same as the one for -F.
6050 Do not follow symbolic links listed on the
6051 command line unless the @option{--dereference-command-line} (@option{-H}),
6052 @option{--dereference} (@option{-L}), or
6053 @option{--dereference-command-line-symlink-to-dir} options are specified.
6056 @itemx --dereference-command-line
6058 @opindex --dereference-command-line
6059 @cindex symbolic links, dereferencing
6060 If a command line argument specifies a symbolic link, show information
6061 for the file the link references rather than for the link itself.
6063 @itemx --dereference-command-line-symlink-to-dir
6064 @opindex --dereference-command-line-symlink-to-dir
6065 @cindex symbolic links, dereferencing
6066 Do not dereference symbolic links, with one exception:
6067 if a command line argument specifies a symbolic link that refers to
6068 a directory, show information for that directory rather than for the
6070 This is the default behavior when no other dereferencing-related
6071 option has been specified (@option{--classify} (@option{-F}),
6072 @option{--directory} (@option{-d}),
6074 @option{--dereference} (@option{-L}), or
6075 @option{--dereference-command-line} (@option{-H})).
6077 @item --group-directories-first
6078 @opindex --group-directories-first
6079 Group all the directories before the files and then sort the
6080 directories and the files separately using the selected sort key
6081 (see --sort option).
6082 That is, this option specifies a primary sort key,
6083 and the --sort option specifies a secondary key.
6084 However, any use of @option{--sort=none}
6085 (@option{-U}) disables this option altogether.
6087 @item --hide=PATTERN
6088 @opindex --hide=@var{pattern}
6089 In directories, ignore files whose names match the shell pattern
6090 @var{pattern}, unless the @option{--all} (@option{-a}) or
6091 @option{--almost-all} (@option{-A}) is also given. This
6092 option acts like @option{--ignore=@var{pattern}} except that it has no
6093 effect if @option{--all} (@option{-a}) or @option{--almost-all}
6094 (@option{-A}) is also given.
6096 This option can be useful in shell aliases. For example, if
6097 @command{lx} is an alias for @samp{ls --hide='*~'} and @command{ly} is
6098 an alias for @samp{ls --ignore='*~'}, then the command @samp{lx -A}
6099 lists the file @file{README~} even though @samp{ly -A} would not.
6101 @item -I @var{pattern}
6102 @itemx --ignore=@var{pattern}
6104 @opindex --ignore=@var{pattern}
6105 In directories, ignore files whose names match the shell pattern
6106 (not regular expression) @var{pattern}. As
6107 in the shell, an initial @samp{.} in a file name does not match a
6108 wildcard at the start of @var{pattern}. Sometimes it is useful
6109 to give this option several times. For example,
6112 $ ls --ignore='.??*' --ignore='.[^.]' --ignore='#*'
6115 The first option ignores names of length 3 or more that start with @samp{.},
6116 the second ignores all two-character names that start with @samp{.}
6117 except @samp{..}, and the third ignores names that start with @samp{#}.
6120 @itemx --dereference
6122 @opindex --dereference
6123 @cindex symbolic links, dereferencing
6124 When showing file information for a symbolic link, show information
6125 for the file the link references rather than the link itself.
6126 However, even with this option, @command{ls} still prints the name
6127 of the link itself, not the name of the file that the link points to.
6132 @opindex --recursive
6133 @cindex recursive directory listing
6134 @cindex directory listing, recursive
6135 List the contents of all directories recursively.
6140 @node What information is listed
6141 @subsection What information is listed
6143 These options affect the information that @command{ls} displays. By
6144 default, only file names are shown.
6150 @cindex hurd, author, printing
6151 List each file's author when producing long format directory listings.
6152 In GNU/Hurd, file authors can differ from their owners, but in other
6153 operating systems the two are the same.
6159 @cindex dired Emacs mode support
6160 With the long listing (@option{-l}) format, print an additional line after
6164 //DIRED// @var{beg1} @var{end1} @var{beg2} @var{end2} @dots{}
6168 The @var{begN} and @var{endN} are unsigned integers that record the
6169 byte position of the beginning and end of each file name in the output.
6170 This makes it easy for Emacs to find the names, even when they contain
6171 unusual characters such as space or newline, without fancy searching.
6173 If directories are being listed recursively (@option{-R}), output a similar
6174 line with offsets for each subdirectory name:
6177 //SUBDIRED// @var{beg1} @var{end1} @dots{}
6180 Finally, output a line of the form:
6183 //DIRED-OPTIONS// --quoting-style=@var{word}
6187 where @var{word} is the quoting style (@pxref{Formatting the file names}).
6189 Here is an actual example:
6192 $ mkdir -p a/sub/deeper a/sub2
6194 $ touch a/sub/deeper/file
6195 $ ls -gloRF --dired a
6198 -rw-r--r-- 1 0 Jun 10 12:27 f1
6199 -rw-r--r-- 1 0 Jun 10 12:27 f2
6200 drwxr-xr-x 3 4096 Jun 10 12:27 sub/
6201 drwxr-xr-x 2 4096 Jun 10 12:27 sub2/
6205 drwxr-xr-x 2 4096 Jun 10 12:27 deeper/
6209 -rw-r--r-- 1 0 Jun 10 12:27 file
6213 //DIRED// 48 50 84 86 120 123 158 162 217 223 282 286
6214 //SUBDIRED// 2 3 167 172 228 240 290 296
6215 //DIRED-OPTIONS// --quoting-style=literal
6218 Note that the pairs of offsets on the @samp{//DIRED//} line above delimit
6219 these names: @file{f1}, @file{f2}, @file{sub}, @file{sub2}, @file{deeper},
6221 The offsets on the @samp{//SUBDIRED//} line delimit the following
6222 directory names: @file{a}, @file{a/sub}, @file{a/sub/deeper}, @file{a/sub2}.
6224 Here is an example of how to extract the fifth entry name, @samp{deeper},
6225 corresponding to the pair of offsets, 222 and 228:
6228 $ ls -gloRF --dired a > out
6229 $ dd bs=1 skip=222 count=6 < out 2>/dev/null; echo
6233 Note that although the listing above includes a trailing slash
6234 for the @samp{deeper} entry, the offsets select the name without
6235 the trailing slash. However, if you invoke @command{ls} with @option{--dired}
6236 along with an option like @option{--escape} (aka @option{-b}) and operate
6237 on a file whose name contains special characters, notice that the backslash
6242 $ ls -blog --dired 'a b'
6243 -rw-r--r-- 1 0 Jun 10 12:28 a\ b
6245 //DIRED-OPTIONS// --quoting-style=escape
6248 If you use a quoting style that adds quote marks
6249 (e.g., @option{--quoting-style=c}), then the offsets include the quote marks.
6250 So beware that the user may select the quoting style via the environment
6251 variable @env{QUOTING_STYLE}. Hence, applications using @option{--dired}
6252 should either specify an explicit @option{--quoting-style=literal} option
6253 (aka @option{-N} or @option{--literal}) on the command line, or else be
6254 prepared to parse the escaped names.
6257 @opindex --full-time
6258 Produce long format directory listings, and list times in full. It is
6259 equivalent to using @option{--format=long} with
6260 @option{--time-style=full-iso} (@pxref{Formatting file timestamps}).
6264 Produce long format directory listings, but don't display owner information.
6270 Inhibit display of group information in a long format directory listing.
6271 (This is the default in some non-@sc{gnu} versions of @command{ls}, so we
6272 provide this option for compatibility.)
6280 @cindex inode number, printing
6281 Print the inode number (also called the file serial number and index
6282 number) of each file to the left of the file name. (This number
6283 uniquely identifies each file within a particular file system.)
6286 @itemx --format=long
6287 @itemx --format=verbose
6290 @opindex long ls @r{format}
6291 @opindex verbose ls @r{format}
6292 In addition to the name of each file, print the file type, file mode bits,
6293 number of hard links, owner name, group name, size, and
6294 timestamp (@pxref{Formatting file timestamps}), normally
6295 the modification time. Print question marks for information that
6296 cannot be determined.
6298 Normally the size is printed as a byte count without punctuation, but
6299 this can be overridden (@pxref{Block size}). For example, @option{-h}
6300 prints an abbreviated, human-readable count, and
6301 @samp{--block-size="'1"} prints a byte count with the thousands
6302 separator of the current locale.
6304 For each directory that is listed, preface the files with a line
6305 @samp{total @var{blocks}}, where @var{blocks} is the total disk allocation
6306 for all files in that directory. The block size currently defaults to 1024
6307 bytes, but this can be overridden (@pxref{Block size}).
6308 The @var{blocks} computed counts each hard link separately;
6309 this is arguably a deficiency.
6311 The file type is one of the following characters:
6313 @c The commented-out entries are ones we're not sure about.
6321 character special file
6323 high performance (``contiguous data'') file
6327 door (Solaris 2.5 and up)
6329 @c semaphore, if this is a distinct file type
6333 @c multiplexed file (7th edition Unix; obsolete)
6335 off-line (``migrated'') file (Cray DMF)
6337 network special file (HP-UX)
6341 port (Solaris 10 and up)
6343 @c message queue, if this is a distinct file type
6347 @c shared memory object, if this is a distinct file type
6349 @c typed memory object, if this is a distinct file type
6351 @c whiteout (4.4BSD; not implemented)
6353 some other file type
6356 @cindex permissions, output by @command{ls}
6357 The file mode bits listed are similar to symbolic mode specifications
6358 (@pxref{Symbolic Modes}). But @command{ls} combines multiple bits into the
6359 third character of each set of permissions as follows:
6363 If the set-user-ID or set-group-ID bit and the corresponding executable bit
6367 If the set-user-ID or set-group-ID bit is set but the corresponding
6368 executable bit is not set.
6371 If the restricted deletion flag or sticky bit, and the
6372 other-executable bit, are both set. The restricted deletion flag is
6373 another name for the sticky bit. @xref{Mode Structure}.
6376 If the restricted deletion flag or sticky bit is set but the
6377 other-executable bit is not set.
6380 If the executable bit is set and none of the above apply.
6386 Following the file mode bits is a single character that specifies
6387 whether an alternate access method such as an access control list
6388 applies to the file. When the character following the file mode bits is a
6389 space, there is no alternate access method. When it is a printing
6390 character, then there is such a method.
6392 For a file with an extended access control list, a @samp{+} character is
6393 listed. Basic access control lists are equivalent to the permissions
6394 listed, and are not considered an alternate access method.
6397 @itemx --numeric-uid-gid
6399 @opindex --numeric-uid-gid
6400 @cindex numeric uid and gid
6401 @cindex numeric user and group IDs
6402 Produce long format directory listings, but
6403 display numeric user and group IDs instead of the owner and group names.
6407 Produce long format directory listings, but don't display group information.
6408 It is equivalent to using @option{--format=long} with @option{--no-group} .
6414 @cindex disk allocation
6415 @cindex size of files, reporting
6416 Print the disk allocation of each file to the left of the file name.
6417 This is the amount of disk space used by the file, which is usually a
6418 bit more than the file's size, but it can be less if the file has holes.
6420 Normally the disk allocation is printed in units of
6421 1024 bytes, but this can be overridden (@pxref{Block size}).
6423 @cindex NFS mounts from BSD to HP-UX
6424 For files that are NFS-mounted from an HP-UX system to a BSD system,
6425 this option reports sizes that are half the correct values. On HP-UX
6426 systems, it reports sizes that are twice the correct values for files
6427 that are NFS-mounted from BSD systems. This is due to a flaw in HP-UX;
6428 it also affects the HP-UX @command{ls} program.
6435 @node Sorting the output
6436 @subsection Sorting the output
6438 @cindex sorting @command{ls} output
6439 These options change the order in which @command{ls} sorts the information
6440 it outputs. By default, sorting is done by character code
6441 (e.g., @acronym{ASCII} order).
6447 @itemx --time=status
6450 @opindex ctime@r{, printing or sorting by}
6451 @opindex status time@r{, printing or sorting by}
6452 @opindex use time@r{, printing or sorting files by}
6453 If the long listing format (e.g., @option{-l}, @option{-o}) is being used,
6454 print the status change time (the @samp{ctime} in the inode) instead of
6455 the modification time.
6456 When explicitly sorting by time (@option{--sort=time} or @option{-t})
6457 or when not using a long listing format,
6458 sort according to the status change time.
6462 @cindex unsorted directory listing
6463 @cindex directory order, listing by
6464 Primarily, like @option{-U}---do not sort; list the files in whatever
6465 order they are stored in the directory. But also enable @option{-a} (list
6466 all files) and disable @option{-l}, @option{--color}, and @option{-s} (if they
6467 were specified before the @option{-f}).
6473 @cindex reverse sorting
6474 Reverse whatever the sorting method is---e.g., list files in reverse
6475 alphabetical order, youngest first, smallest first, or whatever.
6481 @opindex size of files@r{, sorting files by}
6482 Sort by file size, largest first.
6488 @opindex modification time@r{, sorting files by}
6489 Sort by modification time (the @samp{mtime} in the inode), newest first.
6493 @itemx --time=access
6497 @opindex use time@r{, printing or sorting files by}
6498 @opindex atime@r{, printing or sorting files by}
6499 @opindex access time@r{, printing or sorting files by}
6500 If the long listing format (e.g., @option{--format=long}) is being used,
6501 print the last access time (the @samp{atime} in the inode).
6502 When explicitly sorting by time (@option{--sort=time} or @option{-t})
6503 or when not using a long listing format, sort according to the access time.
6509 @opindex none@r{, sorting option for @command{ls}}
6510 Do not sort; list the files in whatever order they are
6511 stored in the directory. (Do not do any of the other unrelated things
6512 that @option{-f} does.) This is especially useful when listing very large
6513 directories, since not doing any sorting can be noticeably faster.
6516 @itemx --sort=version
6519 @opindex version@r{, sorting option for @command{ls}}
6520 Sort by version name and number, lowest first. It behaves like a default
6521 sort, except that each sequence of decimal digits is treated numerically
6522 as an index/version number. (@xref{More details about version sort}.)
6525 @itemx --sort=extension
6528 @opindex extension@r{, sorting files by}
6529 Sort directory contents alphabetically by file extension (characters
6530 after the last @samp{.}); files with no extension are sorted first.
6535 @node More details about version sort
6536 @subsection More details about version sort
6538 The version sort takes into account the fact that file names frequently include
6539 indices or version numbers. Standard sorting functions usually do not produce
6540 the ordering that people expect because comparisons are made on a
6541 character-by-character basis. The version
6542 sort addresses this problem, and is especially useful when browsing
6543 directories that contain many files with indices/version numbers in their
6548 foo.zml-1.gz foo.zml-1.gz
6549 foo.zml-100.gz foo.zml-2.gz
6550 foo.zml-12.gz foo.zml-6.gz
6551 foo.zml-13.gz foo.zml-12.gz
6552 foo.zml-2.gz foo.zml-13.gz
6553 foo.zml-25.gz foo.zml-25.gz
6554 foo.zml-6.gz foo.zml-100.gz
6557 Note also that numeric parts with leading zeros are considered as
6562 abc-1.007.tgz abc-1.007.tgz
6563 abc-1.012b.tgz abc-1.01a.tgz
6564 abc-1.01a.tgz abc-1.012b.tgz
6567 This functionality is implemented using the @code{strverscmp} function.
6568 @xref{String/Array Comparison, , , libc, The GNU C Library Reference Manual}.
6569 One result of that implementation decision is that @code{ls -v} does not
6570 use the locale category, @env{LC_COLLATE}. As a result, non-numeric prefixes
6571 are sorted as if @env{LC_COLLATE} were set to @code{C}.
6573 @node General output formatting
6574 @subsection General output formatting
6576 These options affect the appearance of the overall output.
6581 @itemx --format=single-column
6584 @opindex single-column @r{output of files}
6585 List one file per line. This is the default for @command{ls} when standard
6586 output is not a terminal.
6589 @itemx --format=vertical
6592 @opindex vertical @r{sorted files in columns}
6593 List files in columns, sorted vertically. This is the default for
6594 @command{ls} if standard output is a terminal. It is always the default
6595 for the @command{dir} program.
6596 @sc{gnu} @command{ls} uses variable width columns to display as many files as
6597 possible in the fewest lines.
6599 @item --color [=@var{when}]
6601 @cindex color, distinguishing file types with
6602 Specify whether to use color for distinguishing file types. @var{when}
6603 may be omitted, or one of:
6606 @vindex none @r{color option}
6607 - Do not use color at all. This is the default.
6609 @vindex auto @r{color option}
6610 @cindex terminal, using color iff
6611 - Only use color if standard output is a terminal.
6613 @vindex always @r{color option}
6616 Specifying @option{--color} and no @var{when} is equivalent to
6617 @option{--color=always}.
6618 Piping a colorized listing through a pager like @command{more} or
6619 @command{less} usually produces unreadable results. However, using
6620 @code{more -f} does seem to work.
6624 @itemx --indicator-style=classify
6627 @opindex --indicator-style
6628 @cindex file type and executables, marking
6629 @cindex executables and file type, marking
6630 Append a character to each file name indicating the file type. Also,
6631 for regular files that are executable, append @samp{*}. The file type
6632 indicators are @samp{/} for directories, @samp{@@} for symbolic links,
6633 @samp{|} for FIFOs, @samp{=} for sockets, @samp{>} for doors,
6634 and nothing for regular files.
6635 @c The following sentence is the same as the one for -d.
6636 Do not follow symbolic links listed on the
6637 command line unless the @option{--dereference-command-line} (@option{-H}),
6638 @option{--dereference} (@option{-L}), or
6639 @option{--dereference-command-line-symlink-to-dir} options are specified.
6642 @itemx --indicator-style=file-type
6643 @opindex --file-type
6644 @opindex --indicator-style
6645 @cindex file type, marking
6646 Append a character to each file name indicating the file type. This is
6647 like @option{-F}, except that executables are not marked.
6649 @item --indicator-style=@var{word}
6650 @opindex --indicator-style
6651 Append a character indicator with style @var{word} to entry names,
6656 Do not append any character indicator; this is the default.
6658 Append @samp{/} for directories. This is the same as the @option{-p}
6661 Append @samp{/} for directories, @samp{@@} for symbolic links, @samp{|}
6662 for FIFOs, @samp{=} for sockets, and nothing for regular files. This is
6663 the same as the @option{--file-type} option.
6665 Append @samp{*} for executable regular files, otherwise behave as for
6666 @samp{file-type}. This is the same as the @option{-F} or
6667 @option{--classify} option.
6672 Print file sizes in 1024-byte blocks, overriding the default block
6673 size (@pxref{Block size}).
6674 This option is equivalent to @option{--block-size=1K}.
6677 @itemx --format=commas
6680 @opindex commas@r{, outputting between files}
6681 List files horizontally, with as many as will fit on each line,
6682 separated by @samp{, } (a comma and a space).
6685 @itemx --indicator-style=slash
6687 @opindex --indicator-style
6688 @cindex file type, marking
6689 Append a @samp{/} to directory names.
6692 @itemx --format=across
6693 @itemx --format=horizontal
6696 @opindex across@r{, listing files}
6697 @opindex horizontal@r{, listing files}
6698 List the files in columns, sorted horizontally.
6701 @itemx --tabsize=@var{cols}
6704 Assume that each tab stop is @var{cols} columns wide. The default is 8.
6705 @command{ls} uses tabs where possible in the output, for efficiency. If
6706 @var{cols} is zero, do not use tabs at all.
6708 @c FIXME: remove in 2009, if Apple Terminal has been fixed for long enough.
6709 Some terminal emulators (at least Apple Terminal 1.5 (133) from Mac OS X 10.4.8)
6710 do not properly align columns to the right of a TAB following a
6711 non-@acronym{ASCII} byte. If you use such a terminal emulator, use the
6712 @option{-T0} option or put @code{TABSIZE=0} in your environment to tell
6713 @command{ls} to align using spaces, not tabs.
6716 @itemx --width=@var{cols}
6720 Assume the screen is @var{cols} columns wide. The default is taken
6721 from the terminal settings if possible; otherwise the environment
6722 variable @env{COLUMNS} is used if it is set; otherwise the default
6728 @node Formatting file timestamps
6729 @subsection Formatting file timestamps
6731 By default, file timestamps are listed in abbreviated form. Most
6732 locales use a timestamp like @samp{2002-03-30 23:45}. However, the
6733 default @acronym{POSIX} locale uses a date like @samp{Mar 30@ @ 2002}
6734 for non-recent timestamps, and a date-without-year and time like
6735 @samp{Mar 30 23:45} for recent timestamps.
6737 A timestamp is considered to be @dfn{recent} if it is less than six
6738 months old, and is not dated in the future. If a timestamp dated
6739 today is not listed in recent form, the timestamp is in the future,
6740 which means you probably have clock skew problems which may break
6741 programs like @command{make} that rely on file timestamps.
6744 Time stamps are listed according to the time zone rules specified by
6745 the @env{TZ} environment variable, or by the system default rules if
6746 @env{TZ} is not set. @xref{TZ Variable,, Specifying the Time Zone
6747 with @env{TZ}, libc, The GNU C Library Reference Manual}.
6749 The following option changes how file timestamps are printed.
6752 @item --time-style=@var{style}
6753 @opindex --time-style
6755 List timestamps in style @var{style}. The @var{style} should
6756 be one of the following:
6761 List timestamps using @var{format}, where @var{format} is interpreted
6762 like the format argument of @command{date} (@pxref{date invocation}).
6763 For example, @option{--time-style="+%Y-%m-%d %H:%M:%S"} causes
6764 @command{ls} to list timestamps like @samp{2002-03-30 23:45:56}. As
6765 with @command{date}, @var{format}'s interpretation is affected by the
6766 @env{LC_TIME} locale category.
6768 If @var{format} contains two format strings separated by a newline,
6769 the former is used for non-recent files and the latter for recent
6770 files; if you want output columns to line up, you may need to insert
6771 spaces in one of the two formats.
6774 List timestamps in full using @acronym{ISO} 8601 date, time, and time zone
6775 format with nanosecond precision, e.g., @samp{2002-03-30
6776 23:45:56.477817180 -0700}. This style is equivalent to
6777 @samp{+%Y-%m-%d %H:%M:%S.%N %z}.
6779 This is useful because the time output includes all the information that
6780 is available from the operating system. For example, this can help
6781 explain @command{make}'s behavior, since @acronym{GNU} @command{make}
6782 uses the full timestamp to determine whether a file is out of date.
6785 List @acronym{ISO} 8601 date and time in minutes, e.g.,
6786 @samp{2002-03-30 23:45}. These timestamps are shorter than
6787 @samp{full-iso} timestamps, and are usually good enough for everyday
6788 work. This style is equivalent to @samp{+%Y-%m-%d %H:%M}.
6791 List @acronym{ISO} 8601 dates for non-recent timestamps (e.g.,
6792 @samp{2002-03-30@ }), and @acronym{ISO} 8601 month, day, hour, and
6793 minute for recent timestamps (e.g., @samp{03-30 23:45}). These
6794 timestamps are uglier than @samp{long-iso} timestamps, but they carry
6795 nearly the same information in a smaller space and their brevity helps
6796 @command{ls} output fit within traditional 80-column output lines.
6797 The following two @command{ls} invocations are equivalent:
6802 ls -l --time-style="+%Y-%m-%d $newline%m-%d %H:%M"
6803 ls -l --time-style="iso"
6808 List timestamps in a locale-dependent form. For example, a Finnish
6809 locale might list non-recent timestamps like @samp{maalis 30@ @ 2002}
6810 and recent timestamps like @samp{maalis 30 23:45}. Locale-dependent
6811 timestamps typically consume more space than @samp{iso} timestamps and
6812 are harder for programs to parse because locale conventions vary so
6813 widely, but they are easier for many people to read.
6815 The @env{LC_TIME} locale category specifies the timestamp format. The
6816 default @acronym{POSIX} locale uses timestamps like @samp{Mar 30@
6817 @ 2002} and @samp{Mar 30 23:45}; in this locale, the following two
6818 @command{ls} invocations are equivalent:
6823 ls -l --time-style="+%b %e %Y$newline%b %e %H:%M"
6824 ls -l --time-style="locale"
6827 Other locales behave differently. For example, in a German locale,
6828 @option{--time-style="locale"} might be equivalent to
6829 @option{--time-style="+%e. %b %Y $newline%e. %b %H:%M"}
6830 and might generate timestamps like @samp{30. M@"ar 2002@ } and
6831 @samp{30. M@"ar 23:45}.
6833 @item posix-@var{style}
6835 List @acronym{POSIX}-locale timestamps if the @env{LC_TIME} locale
6836 category is @acronym{POSIX}, @var{style} timestamps otherwise. For
6837 example, the @samp{posix-long-iso} style lists
6838 timestamps like @samp{Mar 30@ @ 2002} and @samp{Mar 30 23:45} when in
6839 the @acronym{POSIX} locale, and like @samp{2002-03-30 23:45} otherwise.
6844 You can specify the default value of the @option{--time-style} option
6845 with the environment variable @env{TIME_STYLE}; if @env{TIME_STYLE} is not set
6846 the default style is @samp{locale}. @acronym{GNU} Emacs 21.3 and
6847 later use the @option{--dired} option and therefore can parse any date
6848 format, but if you are using Emacs 21.1 or 21.2 and specify a
6849 non-@acronym{POSIX} locale you may need to set
6850 @samp{TIME_STYLE="posix-long-iso"}.
6852 To avoid certain denial-of-service attacks, timestamps that would be
6853 longer than 1000 bytes may be treated as errors.
6856 @node Formatting the file names
6857 @subsection Formatting the file names
6859 These options change how file names themselves are printed.
6865 @itemx --quoting-style=escape
6868 @opindex --quoting-style
6869 @cindex backslash sequences for file names
6870 Quote nongraphic characters in file names using alphabetic and octal
6871 backslash sequences like those used in C.
6875 @itemx --quoting-style=literal
6878 @opindex --quoting-style
6879 Do not quote file names. However, with @command{ls} nongraphic
6880 characters are still printed as question marks if the output is a
6881 terminal and you do not specify the @option{--show-control-chars}
6885 @itemx --hide-control-chars
6887 @opindex --hide-control-chars
6888 Print question marks instead of nongraphic characters in file names.
6889 This is the default if the output is a terminal and the program is
6894 @itemx --quoting-style=c
6896 @opindex --quote-name
6897 @opindex --quoting-style
6898 Enclose file names in double quotes and quote nongraphic characters as
6901 @item --quoting-style=@var{word}
6902 @opindex --quoting-style
6903 @cindex quoting style
6904 Use style @var{word} to quote file names and other strings that may
6905 contain arbitrary characters. The @var{word} should
6906 be one of the following:
6910 Output strings as-is; this is the same as the @option{-N} or
6911 @option{--literal} option.
6913 Quote strings for the shell if they contain shell metacharacters or would
6914 cause ambiguous output.
6915 The quoting is suitable for @acronym{POSIX}-compatible shells like
6916 @command{bash}, but it does not always work for incompatible shells
6919 Quote strings for the shell, even if they would normally not require quoting.
6921 Quote strings as for C character string literals, including the
6922 surrounding double-quote characters; this is the same as the
6923 @option{-Q} or @option{--quote-name} option.
6925 Quote strings as for C character string literals, except omit the
6926 surrounding double-quote
6927 characters; this is the same as the @option{-b} or @option{--escape} option.
6929 Quote strings as for C character string literals, except use
6930 surrounding quotation marks appropriate for the
6933 @c Use @t instead of @samp to avoid duplicate quoting in some output styles.
6934 Quote strings as for C character string literals, except use
6935 surrounding quotation marks appropriate for the locale, and quote
6936 @t{`like this'} instead of @t{"like
6937 this"} in the default C locale. This looks nicer on many displays.
6940 You can specify the default value of the @option{--quoting-style} option
6941 with the environment variable @env{QUOTING_STYLE}. If that environment
6942 variable is not set, the default value is @samp{literal}, but this
6943 default may change to @samp{shell} in a future version of this package.
6945 @item --show-control-chars
6946 @opindex --show-control-chars
6947 Print nongraphic characters as-is in file names.
6948 This is the default unless the output is a terminal and the program is
6954 @node dir invocation
6955 @section @command{dir}: Briefly list directory contents
6958 @cindex directory listing, brief
6960 @command{dir} is equivalent to @code{ls -C
6961 -b}; that is, by default files are listed in columns, sorted vertically,
6962 and special characters are represented by backslash escape sequences.
6964 @xref{ls invocation, @command{ls}}.
6967 @node vdir invocation
6968 @section @command{vdir}: Verbosely list directory contents
6971 @cindex directory listing, verbose
6973 @command{vdir} is equivalent to @code{ls -l
6974 -b}; that is, by default files are listed in long format and special
6975 characters are represented by backslash escape sequences.
6977 @node dircolors invocation
6978 @section @command{dircolors}: Color setup for @command{ls}
6982 @cindex setup for color
6984 @command{dircolors} outputs a sequence of shell commands to set up the
6985 terminal for color output from @command{ls} (and @command{dir}, etc.).
6989 eval "`dircolors [@var{option}]@dots{} [@var{file}]`"
6992 If @var{file} is specified, @command{dircolors} reads it to determine which
6993 colors to use for which file types and extensions. Otherwise, a
6994 precompiled database is used. For details on the format of these files,
6995 run @samp{dircolors --print-database}.
6997 To make @command{dircolors} read a @file{~/.dircolors} file if it
6998 exists, you can put the following lines in your @file{~/.bashrc} (or
6999 adapt them to your favorite shell):
7003 test -r $d && eval "$(dircolors $d)"
7007 @vindex SHELL @r{environment variable, and color}
7008 The output is a shell command to set the @env{LS_COLORS} environment
7009 variable. You can specify the shell syntax to use on the command line,
7010 or @command{dircolors} will guess it from the value of the @env{SHELL}
7011 environment variable.
7013 The program accepts the following options. Also see @ref{Common options}.
7018 @itemx --bourne-shell
7021 @opindex --bourne-shell
7022 @cindex Bourne shell syntax for color setup
7023 @cindex @command{sh} syntax for color setup
7024 Output Bourne shell commands. This is the default if the @env{SHELL}
7025 environment variable is set and does not end with @samp{csh} or
7034 @cindex C shell syntax for color setup
7035 @cindex @command{csh} syntax for color setup
7036 Output C shell commands. This is the default if @code{SHELL} ends with
7037 @command{csh} or @command{tcsh}.
7040 @itemx --print-database
7042 @opindex --print-database
7043 @cindex color database, printing
7044 @cindex database for color setup, printing
7045 @cindex printing color database
7046 Print the (compiled-in) default color configuration database. This
7047 output is itself a valid configuration file, and is fairly descriptive
7048 of the possibilities.
7055 @node Basic operations
7056 @chapter Basic operations
7058 @cindex manipulating files
7060 This chapter describes the commands for basic file manipulation:
7061 copying, moving (renaming), and deleting (removing).
7064 * cp invocation:: Copy files.
7065 * dd invocation:: Convert and copy a file.
7066 * install invocation:: Copy files and set attributes.
7067 * mv invocation:: Move (rename) files.
7068 * rm invocation:: Remove files or directories.
7069 * shred invocation:: Remove files more securely.
7074 @section @command{cp}: Copy files and directories
7077 @cindex copying files and directories
7078 @cindex files, copying
7079 @cindex directories, copying
7081 @command{cp} copies files (or, optionally, directories). The copy is
7082 completely independent of the original. You can either copy one file to
7083 another, or copy arbitrarily many files to a destination directory.
7087 cp [@var{option}]@dots{} [-T] @var{source} @var{dest}
7088 cp [@var{option}]@dots{} @var{source}@dots{} @var{directory}
7089 cp [@var{option}]@dots{} -t @var{directory} @var{source}@dots{}
7094 If two file names are given, @command{cp} copies the first file to the
7098 If the @option{--target-directory} (@option{-t}) option is given, or
7099 failing that if the last file is a directory and the
7100 @option{--no-target-directory} (@option{-T}) option is not given,
7101 @command{cp} copies each @var{source} file to the specified directory,
7102 using the @var{source}s' names.
7105 Generally, files are written just as they are read. For exceptions,
7106 see the @option{--sparse} option below.
7108 By default, @command{cp} does not copy directories. However, the
7109 @option{-R}, @option{-a}, and @option{-r} options cause @command{cp} to
7110 copy recursively by descending into source directories and copying files
7111 to corresponding destination directories.
7113 When copying from a symbolic link, @command{cp} normally follows the
7114 link only when not copying
7115 recursively. This default can be overridden with the
7116 @option{--archive} (@option{-a}), @option{-d}, @option{--dereference}
7117 (@option{-L}), @option{--no-dereference} (@option{-P}), and
7118 @option{-H} options. If more than one of these options is specified,
7119 the last one silently overrides the others.
7121 When copying to a symbolic link, @command{cp} follows the
7122 link only when it refers to an existing regular file.
7123 However, when copying to a dangling symbolic link, @command{cp}
7124 refuses by default, and fails with a diagnostic, since the operation
7125 is inherently dangerous. This behavior is contrary to historical
7126 practice and to @acronym{POSIX}.
7127 Set @env{POSIXLY_CORRECT} to make @command{cp} attempt to create
7128 the target of a dangling destination symlink, in spite of the possible risk.
7129 Also, when an option like
7130 @option{--backup} or @option{--link} acts to rename or remove the
7131 destination before copying, @command{cp} renames or removes the
7132 symbolic link rather than the file it points to.
7134 By default, @command{cp} copies the contents of special files only
7135 when not copying recursively. This default can be overridden with the
7136 @option{--copy-contents} option.
7138 @cindex self-backups
7139 @cindex backups, making only
7140 @command{cp} generally refuses to copy a file onto itself, with the
7141 following exception: if @option{--force --backup} is specified with
7142 @var{source} and @var{dest} identical, and referring to a regular file,
7143 @command{cp} will make a backup file, either regular or numbered, as
7144 specified in the usual ways (@pxref{Backup options}). This is useful when
7145 you simply want to make a backup of an existing file before changing it.
7147 The program accepts the following options. Also see @ref{Common options}.
7154 Preserve as much as possible of the structure and attributes of the
7155 original files in the copy (but do not attempt to preserve internal
7156 directory structure; i.e., @samp{ls -U} may list the entries in a copied
7157 directory in a different order).
7158 Equivalent to @option{-dpR}.
7161 @itemx @w{@kbd{--backup}[=@var{method}]}
7164 @vindex VERSION_CONTROL
7165 @cindex backups, making
7166 @xref{Backup options}.
7167 Make a backup of each file that would otherwise be overwritten or removed.
7168 As a special case, @command{cp} makes a backup of @var{source} when the force
7169 and backup options are given and @var{source} and @var{dest} are the same
7170 name for an existing, regular file. One useful application of this
7171 combination of options is this tiny Bourne shell script:
7175 # Usage: backup FILE...
7176 # Create a @sc{gnu}-style backup of each listed FILE.
7178 cp --backup --force -- "$i" "$i"
7182 @item --copy-contents
7183 @cindex directories, copying recursively
7184 @cindex copying directories recursively
7185 @cindex recursively copying directories
7186 @cindex non-directories, copying as special files
7187 If copying recursively, copy the contents of any special files (e.g.,
7188 FIFOs and device files) as if they were regular files. This means
7189 trying to read the data in each source file and writing it to the
7190 destination. It is usually a mistake to use this option, as it
7191 normally has undesirable effects on special files like FIFOs and the
7192 ones typically found in the @file{/dev} directory. In most cases,
7193 @code{cp -R --copy-contents} will hang indefinitely trying to read
7194 from FIFOs and special files like @file{/dev/console}, and it will
7195 fill up your destination disk if you use it to copy @file{/dev/zero}.
7196 This option has no effect unless copying recursively, and it does not
7197 affect the copying of symbolic links.
7201 @cindex symbolic links, copying
7202 @cindex hard links, preserving
7203 Copy symbolic links as symbolic links rather than copying the files that
7204 they point to, and preserve hard links between source files in the copies.
7205 Equivalent to @option{--no-dereference --preserve=links}.
7211 When copying without this option and an existing destination file cannot
7212 be opened for writing, the copy fails. However, with @option{--force}),
7213 when a destination file cannot be opened, @command{cp} then removes it and
7214 tries to open it again. Contrast this behavior with that enabled by
7215 @option{--link} and @option{--symbolic-link}, whereby the destination file
7216 is never opened but rather is removed unconditionally. Also see the
7217 description of @option{--remove-destination}.
7219 This option is independent of the @option{--interactive} or
7220 @option{-i} option: neither cancels the effect of the other.
7224 If a command line argument specifies a symbolic link, then copy the
7225 file it points to rather than the symbolic link itself. However,
7226 copy (preserving its nature) any symbolic link that is encountered
7227 via recursive traversal.
7230 @itemx --interactive
7232 @opindex --interactive
7233 When copying a file other than a directory, prompt whether to
7234 overwrite an existing destination file.
7240 Make hard links instead of copies of non-directories.
7243 @itemx --dereference
7245 @opindex --dereference
7246 Follow symbolic links when copying from them.
7249 @itemx --no-dereference
7251 @opindex --no-dereference
7252 @cindex symbolic links, copying
7253 Copy symbolic links as symbolic links rather than copying the files that
7254 they point to. This option affects only symbolic links in the source;
7255 symbolic links in the destination are always followed if possible.
7258 @itemx @w{@kbd{--preserve}[=@var{attribute_list}]}
7261 @cindex file information, preserving
7262 Preserve the specified attributes of the original files.
7263 If specified, the @var{attribute_list} must be a comma-separated list
7264 of one or more of the following strings:
7268 Preserve the file mode bits and access control lists.
7270 Preserve the owner and group. On most modern systems,
7271 only users with appropriate privileges may change the owner of a file,
7273 may preserve the group ownership of a file only if they happen to be
7274 a member of the desired group.
7276 Preserve the times of last access and last modification, when possible.
7277 In general, it is not possible to preserve these attributes
7278 when the affected file is a symbolic link.
7279 However, FreeBSD now provides the @code{lutimes} function, which makes
7280 it possible even for symbolic links. However, this implementation does
7281 not yet take advantage of that.
7282 @c FIXME: once we provide lutimes support, update the above.
7284 Preserve in the destination files
7285 any links between corresponding source files.
7286 @c Give examples illustrating how hard links are preserved.
7287 @c Also, show how soft links map to hard links with -L and -H.
7289 Preserve all file attributes.
7290 Equivalent to specifying all of the above.
7293 Using @option{--preserve} with no @var{attribute_list} is equivalent
7294 to @option{--preserve=mode,ownership,timestamps}.
7296 In the absence of this option, each destination file is created with the
7297 mode bits of the corresponding source file, minus the bits set in the
7298 umask and minus the set-user-ID and set-group-ID bits.
7299 @xref{File permissions}.
7301 @itemx @w{@kbd{--no-preserve}=@var{attribute_list}}
7302 @cindex file information, preserving
7303 Do not preserve the specified attributes. The @var{attribute_list}
7304 has the same form as for @option{--preserve}.
7308 @cindex parent directories and @command{cp}
7309 Form the name of each destination file by appending to the target
7310 directory a slash and the specified name of the source file. The last
7311 argument given to @command{cp} must be the name of an existing directory.
7312 For example, the command:
7315 cp --parents a/b/c existing_dir
7319 copies the file @file{a/b/c} to @file{existing_dir/a/b/c}, creating
7320 any missing intermediate directories.
7322 @itemx @w{@kbd{--reply}=@var{how}}
7324 @cindex interactivity
7325 @c FIXME: remove in 2008
7326 @strong{Deprecated: to be removed in 2008.}@*
7327 Using @option{--reply=yes} makes @command{cp} act as if @samp{yes} were
7328 given as a response to every prompt about a destination file. That effectively
7329 cancels any preceding @option{--interactive} or @option{-i} option.
7330 Specify @option{--reply=no} to make @command{cp} act as if @samp{no} were
7331 given as a response to every prompt about a destination file.
7332 Specify @option{--reply=query} to make @command{cp} prompt the user
7333 about each existing destination file.
7340 @opindex --recursive
7341 @cindex directories, copying recursively
7342 @cindex copying directories recursively
7343 @cindex recursively copying directories
7344 @cindex non-directories, copying as special files
7345 Copy directories recursively. By default, do not follow symbolic
7346 links in the source; see the @option{--archive} (@option{-a}), @option{-d},
7347 @option{--dereference} (@option{-L}), @option{--no-dereference}
7348 (@option{-P}), and @option{-H} options. Special files are copied by
7349 creating a destination file of the same type as the source; see the
7350 @option{--copy-contents} option. It is not portable to use
7351 @option{-r} to copy symbolic links or special files. On some
7352 non-@sc{gnu} systems, @option{-r} implies the equivalent of
7353 @option{-L} and @option{--copy-contents} for historical reasons.
7354 Also, it is not portable to use @option{-R} to copy symbolic links
7355 unless you also specify @option{-P}, as @acronym{POSIX} allows
7356 implementations that dereference symbolic links by default.
7358 @item --remove-destination
7359 @opindex --remove-destination
7360 Remove each existing destination file before attempting to open it
7361 (contrast with @option{-f} above).
7363 @item --sparse=@var{when}
7364 @opindex --sparse=@var{when}
7365 @cindex sparse files, copying
7366 @cindex holes, copying files with
7367 @findex read @r{system call, and holes}
7368 A @dfn{sparse file} contains @dfn{holes}---a sequence of zero bytes that
7369 does not occupy any physical disk blocks; the @samp{read} system call
7370 reads these as zeros. This can both save considerable disk space and
7371 increase speed, since many binary files contain lots of consecutive zero
7372 bytes. By default, @command{cp} detects holes in input source files via a crude
7373 heuristic and makes the corresponding output file sparse as well.
7374 Only regular files may be sparse.
7376 The @var{when} value can be one of the following:
7380 The default behavior: if the input file is sparse, attempt to make
7381 the output file sparse, too. However, if an output file exists but
7382 refers to a non-regular file, then do not attempt to make it sparse.
7385 For each sufficiently long sequence of zero bytes in the input file,
7386 attempt to create a corresponding hole in the output file, even if the
7387 input file does not appear to be sparse.
7388 This is useful when the input file resides on a file system
7389 that does not support sparse files
7390 (for example, @samp{efs} file systems in SGI IRIX 5.3 and earlier),
7391 but the output file is on a type of file system that does support them.
7392 Holes may be created only in regular files, so if the destination file
7393 is of some other type, @command{cp} does not even try to make it sparse.
7396 Never make the output file sparse.
7397 This is useful in creating a file for use with the @command{mkswap} command,
7398 since such a file must not have any holes.
7401 @optStripTrailingSlashes
7404 @itemx --symbolic-link
7406 @opindex --symbolic-link
7407 @cindex symbolic links, copying with
7408 Make symbolic links instead of copies of non-directories. All source
7409 file names must be absolute (starting with @samp{/}) unless the
7410 destination files are in the current directory. This option merely
7411 results in an error message on systems that do not support symbolic links.
7417 @optNoTargetDirectory
7423 @cindex newer files, copying only
7424 Do not copy a non-directory that has an existing destination with the
7425 same or newer modification time. If time stamps are being preserved,
7426 the comparison is to the source time stamp truncated to the
7427 resolutions of the destination file system and of the system calls
7428 used to update time stamps; this avoids duplicate work if several
7429 @samp{cp -pu} commands are executed with the same source and
7436 Print the name of each file before copying it.
7439 @itemx --one-file-system
7441 @opindex --one-file-system
7442 @cindex file systems, omitting copying to different
7443 Skip subdirectories that are on different file systems from the one that
7444 the copy started on.
7445 However, mount point directories @emph{are} copied.
7453 @section @command{dd}: Convert and copy a file
7456 @cindex converting while copying a file
7458 @command{dd} copies a file (from standard input to standard output, by
7459 default) with a changeable I/O block size, while optionally performing
7460 conversions on it. Synopses:
7463 dd [@var{operand}]@dots{}
7467 The only options are @option{--help} and @option{--version}.
7468 @xref{Common options}. @command{dd} accepts the following operands.
7474 Read from @var{file} instead of standard input.
7478 Write to @var{file} instead of standard output. Unless
7479 @samp{conv=notrunc} is given, @command{dd} truncates @var{file} to zero
7480 bytes (or the size specified with @samp{seek=}).
7482 @item ibs=@var{bytes}
7484 @cindex block size of input
7485 @cindex input block size
7486 Set the input block size to @var{bytes}.
7487 This makes @command{dd} read @var{bytes} per block.
7489 @item obs=@var{bytes}
7491 @cindex block size of output
7492 @cindex output block size
7493 Set the output block size to @var{bytes}.
7494 This makes @command{dd} write @var{bytes} per block.
7496 @item bs=@var{bytes}
7499 Set both input and output block sizes to @var{bytes}.
7500 This makes @command{dd} read and write @var{bytes} per block,
7501 overriding any @samp{ibs} and @samp{obs} settings.
7503 @item cbs=@var{bytes}
7505 @cindex block size of conversion
7506 @cindex conversion block size
7507 @cindex fixed-length records, converting to variable-length
7508 @cindex variable-length records, converting to fixed-length
7509 Set the conversion block size to @var{bytes}.
7510 When converting variable-length records to fixed-length ones
7511 (@option{conv=block}) or the reverse (@option{conv=unblock}),
7512 use @var{bytes} as the fixed record length.
7514 @item skip=@var{blocks}
7516 Skip @var{blocks} @samp{ibs}-byte blocks in the input file before copying.
7518 @item seek=@var{blocks}
7520 Skip @var{blocks} @samp{obs}-byte blocks in the output file before copying.
7522 @item count=@var{blocks}
7524 Copy @var{blocks} @samp{ibs}-byte blocks from the input file, instead
7525 of everything until the end of the file.
7527 @item conv=@var{conversion}[,@var{conversion}]@dots{}
7529 Convert the file as specified by the @var{conversion} argument(s).
7530 (No spaces around any comma(s).)
7537 @opindex ascii@r{, converting to}
7538 Convert @acronym{EBCDIC} to @acronym{ASCII},
7539 using the conversion table specified by @acronym{POSIX}.
7540 This provides a 1:1 translation for all 256 bytes.
7543 @opindex ebcdic@r{, converting to}
7544 Convert @acronym{ASCII} to @acronym{EBCDIC}.
7545 This is the inverse of the @samp{ascii} conversion.
7548 @opindex alternate ebcdic@r{, converting to}
7549 Convert @acronym{ASCII} to alternate @acronym{EBCDIC},
7550 using the alternate conversion table specified by @acronym{POSIX}.
7551 This is not a 1:1 translation, but reflects common historical practice
7552 for @samp{~}, @samp{[}, and @samp{]}.
7554 The @samp{ascii}, @samp{ebcdic}, and @samp{ibm} conversions are
7558 @opindex block @r{(space-padding)}
7559 For each line in the input, output @samp{cbs} bytes, replacing the
7560 input newline with a space and padding with spaces as necessary.
7564 Replace trailing spaces in each @samp{cbs}-sized input block with a
7567 The @samp{block} and @samp{unblock} conversions are mutually exclusive.
7570 @opindex lcase@r{, converting to}
7571 Change uppercase letters to lowercase.
7574 @opindex ucase@r{, converting to}
7575 Change lowercase letters to uppercase.
7577 The @samp{lcase} and @samp{ucase} conversions are mutually exclusive.
7580 @opindex swab @r{(byte-swapping)}
7581 @cindex byte-swapping
7582 Swap every pair of input bytes. @sc{gnu} @command{dd}, unlike others, works
7583 when an odd number of bytes are read---the last byte is simply copied
7584 (since there is nothing to swap it with).
7588 @cindex read errors, ignoring
7589 Continue after read errors.
7593 @cindex creating output file, avoiding
7594 Do not create the output file; the output file must already exist.
7598 @cindex creating output file, requiring
7599 Fail if the output file already exists; @command{dd} must create the
7602 The @samp{excl} and @samp{nocreat} conversions are mutually exclusive.
7606 @cindex truncating output file, avoiding
7607 Do not truncate the output file.
7610 @opindex sync @r{(padding with nulls)}
7611 Pad every input block to size of @samp{ibs} with trailing zero bytes.
7612 When used with @samp{block} or @samp{unblock}, pad with spaces instead of
7617 @cindex synchronized data writes, before finishing
7618 Synchronize output data just before finishing. This forces a physical
7619 write of output data.
7623 @cindex synchronized data and metadata writes, before finishing
7624 Synchronize output data and metadata just before finishing. This
7625 forces a physical write of output data and metadata.
7629 @item iflag=@var{flag}[,@var{flag}]@dots{}
7631 Access the input file using the flags specified by the @var{flag}
7632 argument(s). (No spaces around any comma(s).)
7634 @item oflag=@var{flag}[,@var{flag}]@dots{}
7636 Access the output file using the flags specified by the @var{flag}
7637 argument(s). (No spaces around any comma(s).)
7639 Here are the flags. Not every flag is supported on every operating
7646 @cindex appending to the output file
7647 Write in append mode, so that even if some other process is writing to
7648 this file, every @command{dd} write will append to the current
7649 contents of the file. This flag makes sense only for output.
7650 If you combine this flag with the @samp{of=@var{file}} operand,
7651 you should also specify @samp{conv=notrunc} unless you want the
7652 output file to be truncated before being appended to.
7657 Use direct I/O for data, avoiding the buffer cache.
7661 @cindex directory I/O
7663 Fail unless the file is a directory. Most operating systems do not
7664 allow I/O to a directory, so this flag has limited utility.
7668 @cindex synchronized data reads
7669 Use synchronized I/O for data. For the output file, this forces a
7670 physical write of output data on each write. For the input file,
7671 this flag can matter when reading from a remote file that has been
7672 written to synchronously by some other process. Metadata (e.g.,
7673 last-access and last-modified time) is not necessarily synchronized.
7677 @cindex synchronized data and metadata I/O
7678 Use synchronized I/O for both data and metadata.
7682 @cindex nonblocking I/O
7683 Use non-blocking I/O.
7688 Do not update the file's access time.
7689 Some older file systems silently ignore this flag, so it is a good
7690 idea to test it on your files before relying on it.
7694 @cindex controlling terminal
7695 Do not assign the file to be a controlling terminal for @command{dd}.
7696 This has no effect when the file is not a terminal.
7697 On many hosts (e.g., @acronym{GNU}/Linux hosts), this option has no effect
7702 @cindex symbolic links, following
7703 Do not follow symbolic links.
7708 Fail if the file has multiple hard links.
7713 Use binary I/O. This option has an effect only on nonstandard
7714 platforms that distinguish binary from text I/O.
7719 Use text I/O. Like @samp{binary}, this option has no effect on
7724 Read full blocks from input if possible. read() may return early
7725 if a full block is not available, so retry until data is available
7726 or end of file is reached. This flag can be used only for the iflag option.
7730 These flags are not supported on all systems, and @samp{dd} rejects
7731 attempts to use them when they are not supported. When reading from
7732 standard input or writing to standard output, the @samp{nofollow} and
7733 @samp{noctty} flags should not be specified, and the other flags
7734 (e.g., @samp{nonblock}) can affect how other processes behave with the
7735 affected file descriptors, even after @command{dd} exits.
7739 @cindex multipliers after numbers
7740 The numeric-valued strings above (@var{bytes} and @var{blocks}) can be
7741 followed by a multiplier: @samp{b}=512, @samp{c}=1,
7742 @samp{w}=2, @samp{x@var{m}}=@var{m}, or any of the
7743 standard block size suffixes like @samp{k}=1024 (@pxref{Block size}).
7745 Use different @command{dd} invocations to use different block sizes for
7746 skipping and I/O@. For example, the following shell commands copy data
7747 in 512 KiB blocks between a disk and a tape, but do not save or restore a
7748 4 KiB label at the start of the disk:
7751 disk=/dev/rdsk/c0t1d0s2
7754 # Copy all but the label from disk to tape.
7755 (dd bs=4k skip=1 count=0 && dd bs=512k) <$disk >$tape
7757 # Copy from tape back to disk, but leave the disk label alone.
7758 (dd bs=4k seek=1 count=0 && dd bs=512k) <$tape >$disk
7761 Sending an @samp{INFO} signal to a running @command{dd}
7762 process makes it print I/O statistics to standard error
7763 and then resume copying. In the example below,
7764 @command{dd} is run in the background to copy 10 million blocks.
7765 The @command{kill} command makes it output intermediate I/O statistics,
7766 and when @command{dd} completes normally or is killed by the
7767 @code{SIGINT} signal, it outputs the final statistics.
7770 $ dd if=/dev/zero of=/dev/null count=10MB & pid=$!
7771 $ kill -s INFO $pid; wait $pid
7772 3385223+0 records in
7773 3385223+0 records out
7774 1733234176 bytes (1.7 GB) copied, 6.42173 seconds, 270 MB/s
7775 10000000+0 records in
7776 10000000+0 records out
7777 5120000000 bytes (5.1 GB) copied, 18.913 seconds, 271 MB/s
7780 @vindex POSIXLY_CORRECT
7781 On systems lacking the @samp{INFO} signal @command{dd} responds to the
7782 @samp{USR1} signal instead, unless the @env{POSIXLY_CORRECT}
7783 environment variable is set.
7788 @node install invocation
7789 @section @command{install}: Copy files and set attributes
7792 @cindex copying files and setting attributes
7794 @command{install} copies files while setting their file mode bits and, if
7795 possible, their owner and group. Synopses:
7798 install [@var{option}]@dots{} [-T] @var{source} @var{dest}
7799 install [@var{option}]@dots{} @var{source}@dots{} @var{directory}
7800 install [@var{option}]@dots{} -t @var{directory} @var{source}@dots{}
7801 install [@var{option}]@dots{} -d @var{directory}@dots{}
7806 If two file names are given, @command{install} copies the first file to the
7810 If the @option{--target-directory} (@option{-t}) option is given, or
7811 failing that if the last file is a directory and the
7812 @option{--no-target-directory} (@option{-T}) option is not given,
7813 @command{install} copies each @var{source} file to the specified
7814 directory, using the @var{source}s' names.
7817 If the @option{--directory} (@option{-d}) option is given,
7818 @command{install} creates each @var{directory} and any missing parent
7819 directories. Parent directories are created with mode
7820 @samp{u=rwx,go=rx} (755), regardless of the @option{-m} option or the
7821 current umask. @xref{Directory Setuid and Setgid}, for how the
7822 set-user-ID and set-group-ID bits of parent directories are inherited.
7825 @cindex Makefiles, installing programs in
7826 @command{install} is similar to @command{cp}, but allows you to control the
7827 attributes of destination files. It is typically used in Makefiles to
7828 copy programs into their destination directories. It refuses to copy
7829 files onto themselves.
7831 The program accepts the following options. Also see @ref{Common options}.
7839 Ignored; for compatibility with old Unix versions of @command{install}.
7843 Create any missing parent directories of @var{dest},
7844 then copy @var{source} to @var{dest}.
7845 This option is ignored if a destination directory is specified
7846 via @option{--target-directory=DIR}.
7851 @opindex --directory
7852 @cindex directories, creating with given attributes
7853 @cindex parent directories, creating missing
7854 @cindex leading directories, creating missing
7855 Create any missing parent directories, giving them the default
7856 attributes. Then create each given directory, setting their owner,
7857 group and mode as given on the command line or to the defaults.
7859 @item -g @var{group}
7860 @itemx --group=@var{group}
7863 @cindex group ownership of installed files, setting
7864 Set the group ownership of installed files or directories to
7865 @var{group}. The default is the process's current group. @var{group}
7866 may be either a group name or a numeric group ID.
7869 @itemx --mode=@var{mode}
7872 @cindex permissions of installed files, setting
7873 Set the file mode bits for the installed file or directory to @var{mode},
7874 which can be either an octal number, or a symbolic mode as in
7875 @command{chmod}, with @samp{a=} (no access allowed to anyone) as the
7876 point of departure (@pxref{File permissions}).
7877 The default mode is @samp{u=rwx,go=rx,a-s}---read, write, and
7878 execute for the owner, read and execute for group and other, and with
7879 set-user-ID and set-group-ID disabled.
7880 This default is not quite the same as @samp{755}, since it disables
7881 instead of preserving set-user-ID and set-group-ID on directories.
7882 @xref{Directory Setuid and Setgid}.
7884 @item -o @var{owner}
7885 @itemx --owner=@var{owner}
7888 @cindex ownership of installed files, setting
7889 @cindex appropriate privileges
7890 @vindex root @r{as default owner}
7891 If @command{install} has appropriate privileges (is run as root), set the
7892 ownership of installed files or directories to @var{owner}. The default
7893 is @code{root}. @var{owner} may be either a user name or a numeric user
7897 @itemx --preserve-timestamps
7899 @opindex --preserve-timestamps
7900 @cindex timestamps of installed files, preserving
7901 Set the time of last access and the time of last modification of each
7902 installed file to match those of each corresponding original file.
7903 When a file is installed without this option, its last access and
7904 last modification times are both set to the time of installation.
7905 This option is useful if you want to use the last modification times
7906 of installed files to keep track of when they were last built as opposed
7907 to when they were last installed.
7913 @cindex symbol table information, stripping
7914 @cindex stripping symbol table information
7915 Strip the symbol tables from installed binary executables.
7921 @optNoTargetDirectory
7927 Print the name of each file before copying it.
7935 @section @command{mv}: Move (rename) files
7939 @command{mv} moves or renames files (or directories). Synopses:
7942 mv [@var{option}]@dots{} [-T] @var{source} @var{dest}
7943 mv [@var{option}]@dots{} @var{source}@dots{} @var{directory}
7944 mv [@var{option}]@dots{} -t @var{directory} @var{source}@dots{}
7949 If two file names are given, @command{mv} moves the first file to the
7953 If the @option{--target-directory} (@option{-t}) option is given, or
7954 failing that if the last file is a directory and the
7955 @option{--no-target-directory} (@option{-T}) option is not given,
7956 @command{mv} moves each @var{source} file to the specified
7957 directory, using the @var{source}s' names.
7960 @command{mv} can move any type of file from one file system to another.
7961 Prior to version @code{4.0} of the fileutils,
7962 @command{mv} could move only regular files between file systems.
7963 For example, now @command{mv} can move an entire directory hierarchy
7964 including special device files from one partition to another. It first
7965 uses some of the same code that's used by @code{cp -a} to copy the
7966 requested directories and files, then (assuming the copy succeeded)
7967 it removes the originals. If the copy fails, then the part that was
7968 copied to the destination partition is removed. If you were to copy
7969 three directories from one partition to another and the copy of the first
7970 directory succeeded, but the second didn't, the first would be left on
7971 the destination partition and the second and third would be left on the
7974 @cindex prompting, and @command{mv}
7975 If a destination file exists but is normally unwritable, standard input
7976 is a terminal, and the @option{-f} or @option{--force} option is not given,
7977 @command{mv} prompts the user for whether to replace the file. (You might
7978 own the file, or have write permission on its directory.) If the
7979 response is not affirmative, the file is skipped.
7981 @emph{Warning}: Avoid specifying a source name with a trailing slash,
7982 when it might be a symlink to a directory.
7983 Otherwise, @command{mv} may do something very surprising, since
7984 its behavior depends on the underlying rename system call.
7985 On modern Linux systems, it fails with @code{errno=ENOTDIR}.
7986 However, on other systems (at least FreeBSD 6.1 and Solaris 10) it silently
7987 renames not the symlink but rather the directory referenced by the symlink.
7988 @xref{Trailing slashes}.
7990 The program accepts the following options. Also see @ref{Common options}.
8000 @cindex prompts, omitting
8001 Do not prompt the user before removing a destination file.
8004 @itemx --interactive
8006 @opindex --interactive
8007 @cindex prompts, forcing
8008 Prompt whether to overwrite each existing destination file, regardless
8010 If the response is not affirmative, the file is skipped.
8012 @itemx @w{@kbd{--reply}=@var{how}}
8014 @cindex interactivity
8015 @c FIXME: remove in 2008
8016 @strong{Deprecated: to be removed in 2008.}@*
8017 Specifying @option{--reply=yes} is equivalent to using @option{--force}.
8018 Specify @option{--reply=no} to make @command{mv} act as if @samp{no} were
8019 given as a response to every prompt about a destination file.
8020 Specify @option{--reply=query} to make @command{mv} prompt the user
8021 about each existing destination file.
8022 Note that @option{--reply=no} has an effect only when @command{mv} would prompt
8023 without @option{-i} or equivalent, i.e., when a destination file exists and is
8024 not writable, standard input is a terminal, and no @option{-f} (or equivalent)
8025 option is specified.
8031 @cindex newer files, moving only
8032 Do not move a non-directory that has an existing destination with the
8033 same or newer modification time.
8034 If the move is across file system boundaries, the comparison is to the
8035 source time stamp truncated to the resolutions of the destination file
8036 system and of the system calls used to update time stamps; this avoids
8037 duplicate work if several @samp{mv -u} commands are executed with the
8038 same source and destination.
8044 Print the name of each file before moving it.
8046 @optStripTrailingSlashes
8052 @optNoTargetDirectory
8060 @section @command{rm}: Remove files or directories
8063 @cindex removing files or directories
8065 @command{rm} removes each given @var{file}. By default, it does not remove
8066 directories. Synopsis:
8069 rm [@var{option}]@dots{} [@var{file}]@dots{}
8072 @cindex prompting, and @command{rm}
8073 If the @option{-I} or @option{--interactive=once} option is given,
8074 and there are more than three files or the @option{-r}, @option{-R},
8075 or @option{--recursive} are given, then @command{rm} prompts the user
8076 for whether to proceed with the entire operation. If the response is
8077 not affirmative, the entire command is aborted.
8079 Otherwise, if a file is unwritable, standard input is a terminal, and
8080 the @option{-f} or @option{--force} option is not given, or the
8081 @option{-i} or @option{--interactive=always} option @emph{is} given,
8082 @command{rm} prompts the user for whether to remove the file.
8083 If the response is not affirmative, the file is skipped.
8085 Any attempt to remove a file whose last file name component is
8086 @file{.} or @file{..} is rejected without any prompting.
8088 @emph{Warning}: If you use @command{rm} to remove a file, it is usually
8089 possible to recover the contents of that file. If you want more assurance
8090 that the contents are truly unrecoverable, consider using @command{shred}.
8092 The program accepts the following options. Also see @ref{Common options}.
8100 Ignore nonexistent files and never prompt the user.
8101 Ignore any previous @option{--interactive} (@option{-i}) option.
8105 Prompt whether to remove each file.
8106 If the response is not affirmative, the file is skipped.
8107 Ignore any previous @option{--force} (@option{-f}) option.
8108 Equivalent to @option{--interactive=always}.
8112 Prompt once whether to proceed with the command, if more than three
8113 files are named or if a recursive removal is requested. Ignore any
8114 previous @option{--force} (@option{-f}) option. Equivalent to
8115 @option{--interactive=once}.
8117 @itemx --interactive [=@var{when}]
8118 @opindex --interactive
8119 Specify when to issue an interactive prompt. @var{when} may be
8123 @vindex never @r{interactive option}
8124 - Do not prompt at all.
8126 @vindex once @r{interactive option}
8127 - Prompt once if more than three files are named or if a recursive
8128 removal is requested. Equivalent to @option{-I}.
8130 @vindex always @r{interactive option}
8131 - Prompt for every file being removed. Equivalent to @option{-i}.
8133 @option{--interactive} with no @var{when} is equivalent to
8134 @option{--interactive=always}.
8136 @itemx --one-file-system
8137 @opindex --one-file-system
8138 @cindex one file system, restricting @command{rm} to
8139 When removing a hierarchy recursively, skip any directory that is on a
8140 file system different from that of the corresponding command line argument.
8142 This option is useful when removing a build ``chroot'' hierarchy,
8143 which normally contains no valuable data. However, it is not uncommon
8144 to bind-mount @file{/home} into such a hierarchy, to make it easier to
8145 use one's start-up file. The catch is that it's easy to forget to
8146 unmount @file{/home}. Then, when you use @command{rm -rf} to remove
8147 your normally throw-away chroot, that command will remove everything
8148 under @file{/home}, too.
8149 Use the @option{--one-file-system} option, and it will
8150 warn about and skip directories on other file systems.
8151 Of course, this will not save your @file{/home} if it and your
8152 chroot happen to be on the same file system.
8154 @itemx --preserve-root
8155 @opindex --preserve-root
8156 @cindex root directory, disallow recursive destruction
8157 Fail upon any attempt to remove the root directory, @file{/},
8158 when used with the @option{--recursive} option.
8159 This is the default behavior.
8160 @xref{Treating / specially}.
8162 @itemx --no-preserve-root
8163 @opindex --no-preserve-root
8164 @cindex root directory, allow recursive destruction
8165 Do not treat @file{/} specially when removing recursively.
8166 This option is not recommended unless you really want to
8167 remove all the files on your computer.
8168 @xref{Treating / specially}.
8175 @opindex --recursive
8176 @cindex directories, removing (recursively)
8177 Remove the listed directories and their contents recursively.
8183 Print the name of each file before removing it.
8187 @cindex files beginning with @samp{-}, removing
8188 @cindex @samp{-}, removing files beginning with
8189 One common question is how to remove files whose names begin with a
8190 @samp{-}. @sc{gnu} @command{rm}, like every program that uses the @code{getopt}
8191 function to parse its arguments, lets you use the @samp{--} option to
8192 indicate that all following arguments are non-options. To remove a file
8193 called @file{-f} in the current directory, you could type either:
8206 @opindex - @r{and Unix @command{rm}}
8207 The Unix @command{rm} program's use of a single @samp{-} for this purpose
8208 predates the development of the getopt standard syntax.
8213 @node shred invocation
8214 @section @command{shred}: Remove files more securely
8217 @cindex data, erasing
8218 @cindex erasing data
8220 @command{shred} overwrites devices or files, to help prevent even
8221 very expensive hardware from recovering the data.
8223 Ordinarily when you remove a file (@pxref{rm invocation}), the data is
8224 not actually destroyed. Only the index listing where the file is
8225 stored is destroyed, and the storage is made available for reuse.
8226 There are undelete utilities that will attempt to reconstruct the index
8227 and can bring the file back if the parts were not reused.
8229 On a busy system with a nearly-full drive, space can get reused in a few
8230 seconds. But there is no way to know for sure. If you have sensitive
8231 data, you may want to be sure that recovery is not possible by actually
8232 overwriting the file with non-sensitive data.
8234 However, even after doing that, it is possible to take the disk back
8235 to a laboratory and use a lot of sensitive (and expensive) equipment
8236 to look for the faint ``echoes'' of the original data underneath the
8237 overwritten data. If the data has only been overwritten once, it's not
8240 The best way to remove something irretrievably is to destroy the media
8241 it's on with acid, melt it down, or the like. For cheap removable media
8242 like floppy disks, this is the preferred method. However, hard drives
8243 are expensive and hard to melt, so the @command{shred} utility tries
8244 to achieve a similar effect non-destructively.
8246 This uses many overwrite passes, with the data patterns chosen to
8247 maximize the damage they do to the old data. While this will work on
8248 floppies, the patterns are designed for best effect on hard drives.
8249 For more details, see the source code and Peter Gutmann's paper
8250 @uref{http://www.cs.auckland.ac.nz/~pgut001/pubs/secure_del.html,
8251 @cite{Secure Deletion of Data from Magnetic and Solid-State Memory}},
8252 from the proceedings of the Sixth @acronym{USENIX} Security Symposium (San Jose,
8253 California, July 22--25, 1996).
8255 @strong{Please note} that @command{shred} relies on a very important assumption:
8256 that the file system overwrites data in place. This is the traditional
8257 way to do things, but many modern file system designs do not satisfy this
8258 assumption. Exceptions include:
8263 Log-structured or journaled file systems, such as those supplied with
8264 AIX and Solaris, and JFS, ReiserFS, XFS, Ext3 (in @code{data=journal} mode),
8265 BFS, NTFS, etc.@: when they are configured to journal @emph{data}.
8268 File systems that write redundant data and carry on even if some writes
8269 fail, such as RAID-based file systems.
8272 File systems that make snapshots, such as Network Appliance's NFS server.
8275 File systems that cache in temporary locations, such as NFS version 3
8279 Compressed file systems.
8282 In the particular case of ext3 file systems, the above disclaimer applies (and
8283 @command{shred} is thus of limited effectiveness) only in @code{data=journal}
8284 mode, which journals file data in addition to just metadata. In both
8285 the @code{data=ordered} (default) and @code{data=writeback} modes,
8286 @command{shred} works as usual. Ext3 journaling modes can be changed
8287 by adding the @code{data=something} option to the mount options for a
8288 particular file system in the @file{/etc/fstab} file, as documented in
8289 the mount man page (man mount).
8291 If you are not sure how your file system operates, then you should assume
8292 that it does not overwrite data in place, which means that shred cannot
8293 reliably operate on regular files in your file system.
8295 Generally speaking, it is more reliable to shred a device than a file,
8296 since this bypasses the problem of file system design mentioned above.
8297 However, even shredding devices is not always completely reliable. For
8298 example, most disks map out bad sectors invisibly to the application; if
8299 the bad sectors contain sensitive data, @command{shred} won't be able to
8302 @command{shred} makes no attempt to detect or report this problem, just as
8303 it makes no attempt to do anything about backups. However, since it is
8304 more reliable to shred devices than files, @command{shred} by default does
8305 not truncate or remove the output file. This default is more suitable
8306 for devices, which typically cannot be truncated and should not be
8309 Finally, consider the risk of backups and mirrors.
8310 File system backups and remote mirrors may contain copies of the
8311 file that cannot be removed, and that will allow a shredded file
8312 to be recovered later. So if you keep any data you may later want
8313 to destroy using @command{shred}, be sure that it is not backed up or mirrored.
8316 shred [@var{option}]@dots{} @var{file}[@dots{}]
8319 The program accepts the following options. Also see @ref{Common options}.
8327 @cindex force deletion
8328 Override file permissions if necessary to allow overwriting.
8331 @itemx -n @var{NUMBER}
8332 @itemx --iterations=@var{NUMBER}
8333 @opindex -n @var{NUMBER}
8334 @opindex --iterations=@var{NUMBER}
8335 @cindex iterations, selecting the number of
8336 By default, @command{shred} uses 25 passes of overwrite. This is enough
8337 for all of the useful overwrite patterns to be used at least once.
8338 You can reduce this to save time, or increase it if you have a lot of
8341 @item --random-source=@var{file}
8342 @opindex --random-source
8343 @cindex random source for shredding
8344 Use @var{file} as a source of random data used to overwrite and to
8345 choose pass ordering. @xref{Random sources}.
8347 @item -s @var{BYTES}
8348 @itemx --size=@var{BYTES}
8349 @opindex -s @var{BYTES}
8350 @opindex --size=@var{BYTES}
8351 @cindex size of file to shred
8352 Shred the first @var{BYTES} bytes of the file. The default is to shred
8353 the whole file. @var{BYTES} can be followed by a size specification like
8354 @samp{K}, @samp{M}, or @samp{G} to specify a multiple. @xref{Block size}.
8360 @cindex removing files after shredding
8361 After shredding a file, truncate it (if possible) and then remove it.
8362 If a file has multiple links, only the named links will be removed.
8368 Display to standard error all status updates as sterilization proceeds.
8374 By default, @command{shred} rounds the size of a regular file up to the next
8375 multiple of the file system block size to fully erase the last block of the file.
8376 Use @option{--exact} to suppress that behavior.
8377 Thus, by default if you shred a 10-byte regular file on a system with 512-byte
8378 blocks, the resulting file will be 512 bytes long. With this option,
8379 shred does not increase the apparent size of the file.
8385 Normally, the last pass that @command{shred} writes is made up of
8386 random data. If this would be conspicuous on your hard drive (for
8387 example, because it looks like encrypted data), or you just think
8388 it's tidier, the @option{--zero} option adds an additional overwrite pass with
8389 all zero bits. This is in addition to the number of passes specified
8390 by the @option{--iterations} option.
8394 You might use the following command to erase all trace of the
8395 file system you'd created on the floppy disk in your first drive.
8396 That command takes about 20 minutes to erase a ``1.44MB'' (actually
8400 shred --verbose /dev/fd0
8403 Similarly, to erase all data on a selected partition of
8404 your hard disk, you could give a command like this:
8407 shred --verbose /dev/sda5
8410 A @var{file} of @samp{-} denotes standard output.
8411 The intended use of this is to shred a removed temporary file.
8415 i=`tempfile -m 0600`
8418 echo "Hello, world" >&3
8423 However, the command @samp{shred - >file} does not shred the contents
8424 of @var{file}, since the shell truncates @var{file} before invoking
8425 @command{shred}. Use the command @samp{shred file} or (if using a
8426 Bourne-compatible shell) the command @samp{shred - 1<>file} instead.
8431 @node Special file types
8432 @chapter Special file types
8434 @cindex special file types
8435 @cindex file types, special
8437 This chapter describes commands which create special types of files (and
8438 @command{rmdir}, which removes directories, one special file type).
8440 @cindex special file types
8442 Although Unix-like operating systems have markedly fewer special file
8443 types than others, not @emph{everything} can be treated only as the
8444 undifferentiated byte stream of @dfn{normal files}. For example, when a
8445 file is created or removed, the system must record this information,
8446 which it does in a @dfn{directory}---a special type of file. Although
8447 you can read directories as normal files, if you're curious, in order
8448 for the system to do its job it must impose a structure, a certain
8449 order, on the bytes of the file. Thus it is a ``special'' type of file.
8451 Besides directories, other special file types include named pipes
8452 (FIFOs), symbolic links, sockets, and so-called @dfn{special files}.
8455 * link invocation:: Make a hard link via the link syscall
8456 * ln invocation:: Make links between files.
8457 * mkdir invocation:: Make directories.
8458 * mkfifo invocation:: Make FIFOs (named pipes).
8459 * mknod invocation:: Make block or character special files.
8460 * readlink invocation:: Print the referent of a symbolic link.
8461 * rmdir invocation:: Remove empty directories.
8462 * unlink invocation:: Remove files via the unlink syscall
8466 @node link invocation
8467 @section @command{link}: Make a hard link via the link syscall
8470 @cindex links, creating
8471 @cindex hard links, creating
8472 @cindex creating links (hard only)
8474 @command{link} creates a single hard link at a time.
8475 It is a minimalist interface to the system-provided
8476 @code{link} function. @xref{Hard Links, , , libc,
8477 The GNU C Library Reference Manual}.
8478 It avoids the bells and whistles of the more commonly-used
8479 @command{ln} command (@pxref{ln invocation}).
8483 link @var{filename} @var{linkname}
8486 @var{filename} must specify an existing file, and @var{linkname}
8487 must specify a nonexistent entry in an existing directory.
8488 @command{link} simply calls @code{link (@var{filename}, @var{linkname})}
8491 On a @acronym{GNU} system, this command acts like @samp{ln --directory
8492 --no-target-directory @var{filename} @var{linkname}}. However, the
8493 @option{--directory} and @option{--no-target-directory} options are
8494 not specified by @acronym{POSIX}, and the @command{link} command is
8495 more portable in practice.
8501 @section @command{ln}: Make links between files
8504 @cindex links, creating
8505 @cindex hard links, creating
8506 @cindex symbolic (soft) links, creating
8507 @cindex creating links (hard or soft)
8509 @cindex file systems and hard links
8510 @command{ln} makes links between files. By default, it makes hard links;
8511 with the @option{-s} option, it makes symbolic (or @dfn{soft}) links.
8515 ln [@var{option}]@dots{} [-T] @var{target} @var{linkname}
8516 ln [@var{option}]@dots{} @var{target}
8517 ln [@var{option}]@dots{} @var{target}@dots{} @var{directory}
8518 ln [@var{option}]@dots{} -t @var{directory} @var{target}@dots{}
8524 If two file names are given, @command{ln} creates a link to the first
8525 file from the second.
8528 If one @var{target} is given, @command{ln} creates a link to that file
8529 in the current directory.
8532 If the @option{--target-directory} (@option{-t}) option is given, or
8533 failing that if the last file is a directory and the
8534 @option{--no-target-directory} (@option{-T}) option is not given,
8535 @command{ln} creates a link to each @var{target} file in the specified
8536 directory, using the @var{target}s' names.
8540 Normally @command{ln} does not remove existing files. Use the
8541 @option{--force} (@option{-f}) option to remove them unconditionally,
8542 the @option{--interactive} (@option{-i}) option to remove them
8543 conditionally, and the @option{--backup} (@option{-b}) option to
8546 @cindex hard link, defined
8547 @cindex inode, and hard links
8548 A @dfn{hard link} is another name for an existing file; the link and the
8549 original are indistinguishable. Technically speaking, they share the
8550 same inode, and the inode contains all the information about a
8551 file---indeed, it is not incorrect to say that the inode @emph{is} the
8552 file. On all existing implementations, you cannot make a hard link to
8553 a directory, and hard links cannot cross file system boundaries. (These
8554 restrictions are not mandated by @acronym{POSIX}, however.)
8556 @cindex dereferencing symbolic links
8557 @cindex symbolic link, defined
8558 @dfn{Symbolic links} (@dfn{symlinks} for short), on the other hand, are
8559 a special file type (which not all kernels support: System V release 3
8560 (and older) systems lack symlinks) in which the link file actually
8561 refers to a different file, by name. When most operations (opening,
8562 reading, writing, and so on) are passed the symbolic link file, the
8563 kernel automatically @dfn{dereferences} the link and operates on the
8564 target of the link. But some operations (e.g., removing) work on the
8565 link file itself, rather than on its target. @xref{Symbolic Links,,,
8566 libc, The GNU C Library Reference Manual}.
8568 The program accepts the following options. Also see @ref{Common options}.
8579 @opindex --directory
8580 @cindex hard links to directories
8581 Allow users with appropriate privileges to attempt to make hard links
8583 However, note that this will probably fail due to
8584 system restrictions, even for the super-user.
8590 Remove existing destination files.
8593 @itemx --interactive
8595 @opindex --interactive
8596 @cindex prompting, and @command{ln}
8597 Prompt whether to remove existing destination files.
8600 @itemx --no-dereference
8602 @opindex --no-dereference
8603 Do not treat the last operand specially when it is a symbolic link to
8604 a directory. Instead, treat it as if it were a normal file.
8606 When the destination is an actual directory (not a symlink to one),
8607 there is no ambiguity. The link is created in that directory.
8608 But when the specified destination is a symlink to a directory,
8609 there are two ways to treat the user's request. @command{ln} can
8610 treat the destination just as it would a normal directory and create
8611 the link in it. On the other hand, the destination can be viewed as a
8612 non-directory---as the symlink itself. In that case, @command{ln}
8613 must delete or backup that symlink before creating the new link.
8614 The default is to treat a destination that is a symlink to a directory
8615 just like a directory.
8617 This option is weaker than the @option{--no-target-directory}
8618 (@option{-T}) option, so it has no effect if both options are given.
8624 Make symbolic links instead of hard links. This option merely produces
8625 an error message on systems that do not support symbolic links.
8631 @optNoTargetDirectory
8637 Print the name of each file after linking it successfully.
8648 # Create link ../a pointing to a in that directory.
8649 # Not really useful because it points to itself.
8654 # Change to the target before creating symlinks to avoid being confused.
8660 # Hard coded file names don't move well.
8661 ln -s $(pwd)/a /some/dir/
8665 # Relative file names survive directory moves and also
8666 # work across networked file systems.
8667 ln -s afile anotherfile
8668 ln -s ../adir/afile yetanotherfile
8672 @node mkdir invocation
8673 @section @command{mkdir}: Make directories
8676 @cindex directories, creating
8677 @cindex creating directories
8679 @command{mkdir} creates directories with the specified names. Synopsis:
8682 mkdir [@var{option}]@dots{} @var{name}@dots{}
8685 @command{mkdir} creates each directory @var{name} in the order given.
8686 It reports an error if @var{name} already exists, unless the
8687 @option{-p} option is given and @var{name} is a directory.
8689 The program accepts the following options. Also see @ref{Common options}.
8694 @itemx --mode=@var{mode}
8697 @cindex modes of created directories, setting
8698 Set the file permission bits of created directories to @var{mode},
8699 which uses the same syntax as
8700 in @command{chmod} and uses @samp{a=rwx} (read, write and execute allowed for
8701 everyone) for the point of the departure. @xref{File permissions}.
8703 Normally the directory has the desired file mode bits at the moment it
8704 is created. As a @acronym{GNU} extension, @var{mode} may also mention
8705 special mode bits, but in this case there may be a temporary window
8706 during which the directory exists but its special mode bits are
8707 incorrect. @xref{Directory Setuid and Setgid}, for how the
8708 set-user-ID and set-group-ID bits of directories are inherited unless
8709 overridden in this way.
8715 @cindex parent directories, creating
8716 Make any missing parent directories for each argument, setting their
8717 file permission bits to the umask modified by @samp{u+wx}. Ignore
8718 existing parent directories, and do not change their file permission
8721 To set the file permission bits of any newly-created parent
8722 directories to a value that includes @samp{u+wx}, you can set the
8723 umask before invoking @command{mkdir}. For example, if the shell
8724 command @samp{(umask u=rwx,go=rx; mkdir -p P/Q)} creates the parent
8725 @file{P} it sets the parent's permission bits to @samp{u=rwx,go=rx}.
8726 To set a parent's special mode bits as well, you can invoke
8727 @command{chmod} after @command{mkdir}. @xref{Directory Setuid and
8728 Setgid}, for how the set-user-ID and set-group-ID bits of
8729 newly-created parent directories are inherited.
8735 Print a message for each created directory. This is most useful with
8742 @node mkfifo invocation
8743 @section @command{mkfifo}: Make FIFOs (named pipes)
8746 @cindex FIFOs, creating
8747 @cindex named pipes, creating
8748 @cindex creating FIFOs (named pipes)
8750 @command{mkfifo} creates FIFOs (also called @dfn{named pipes}) with the
8751 specified names. Synopsis:
8754 mkfifo [@var{option}] @var{name}@dots{}
8757 A @dfn{FIFO} is a special file type that permits independent processes
8758 to communicate. One process opens the FIFO file for writing, and
8759 another for reading, after which data can flow as with the usual
8760 anonymous pipe in shells or elsewhere.
8762 The program accepts the following option. Also see @ref{Common options}.
8767 @itemx --mode=@var{mode}
8770 @cindex modes of created FIFOs, setting
8771 Set the mode of created FIFOs to @var{mode}, which is symbolic as in
8772 @command{chmod} and uses @samp{a=rw} (read and write allowed for everyone)
8773 for the point of departure. @var{mode} should specify only file
8774 permission bits. @xref{File permissions}.
8781 @node mknod invocation
8782 @section @command{mknod}: Make block or character special files
8785 @cindex block special files, creating
8786 @cindex character special files, creating
8788 @command{mknod} creates a FIFO, character special file, or block special
8789 file with the specified name. Synopsis:
8792 mknod [@var{option}]@dots{} @var{name} @var{type} [@var{major} @var{minor}]
8795 @cindex special files
8796 @cindex block special files
8797 @cindex character special files
8798 Unlike the phrase ``special file type'' above, the term @dfn{special
8799 file} has a technical meaning on Unix: something that can generate or
8800 receive data. Usually this corresponds to a physical piece of hardware,
8801 e.g., a printer or a disk. (These files are typically created at
8802 system-configuration time.) The @command{mknod} command is what creates
8803 files of this type. Such devices can be read either a character at a
8804 time or a ``block'' (many characters) at a time, hence we say there are
8805 @dfn{block special} files and @dfn{character special} files.
8807 The arguments after @var{name} specify the type of file to make:
8812 @opindex p @r{for FIFO file}
8816 @opindex b @r{for block special file}
8817 for a block special file
8820 @c Don't document the `u' option -- it's just a synonym for `c'.
8821 @c Do *any* versions of mknod still use it?
8823 @opindex c @r{for character special file}
8824 @c @opindex u @r{for character special file}
8825 for a character special file
8829 When making a block or character special file, the major and minor
8830 device numbers must be given after the file type.
8831 If a major or minor device number begins with @samp{0x} or @samp{0X},
8832 it is interpreted as hexadecimal; otherwise, if it begins with @samp{0},
8833 as octal; otherwise, as decimal.
8835 The program accepts the following option. Also see @ref{Common options}.
8840 @itemx --mode=@var{mode}
8843 Set the mode of created files to @var{mode}, which is symbolic as in
8844 @command{chmod} and uses @samp{a=rw} as the point of departure.
8845 @var{mode} should specify only file permission bits.
8846 @xref{File permissions}.
8853 @node readlink invocation
8854 @section @command{readlink}: Print the referent of a symbolic link
8857 @cindex displaying value of a symbolic link
8859 @command{readlink} may work in one of two supported modes:
8865 @command{readlink} outputs the value of the given symbolic link.
8866 If @command{readlink} is invoked with an argument other than the name
8867 of a symbolic link, it produces no output and exits with a nonzero exit code.
8869 @item Canonicalize mode
8871 @command{readlink} outputs the absolute name of the given file which contains
8872 no @file{.}, @file{..} components nor any repeated separators
8873 (@file{/}) or symbolic links.
8878 readlink [@var{option}] @var{file}
8881 By default, @command{readlink} operates in readlink mode.
8883 The program accepts the following options. Also see @ref{Common options}.
8888 @itemx --canonicalize
8890 @opindex --canonicalize
8891 Activate canonicalize mode.
8892 If any component of the file name except the last one is missing or unavailable,
8893 @command{readlink} produces no output and exits with a nonzero exit code.
8896 @itemx --canonicalize-existing
8898 @opindex --canonicalize-existing
8899 Activate canonicalize mode.
8900 If any component is missing or unavailable, @command{readlink} produces
8901 no output and exits with a nonzero exit code.
8904 @itemx --canonicalize-missing
8906 @opindex --canonicalize-missing
8907 Activate canonicalize mode.
8908 If any component is missing or unavailable, @command{readlink} treats it
8914 @opindex --no-newline
8915 Do not output the trailing newline.
8925 Suppress most error messages.
8931 Report error messages.
8935 The @command{readlink} utility first appeared in OpenBSD 2.1.
8940 @node rmdir invocation
8941 @section @command{rmdir}: Remove empty directories
8944 @cindex removing empty directories
8945 @cindex directories, removing empty
8947 @command{rmdir} removes empty directories. Synopsis:
8950 rmdir [@var{option}]@dots{} @var{directory}@dots{}
8953 If any @var{directory} argument does not refer to an existing empty
8954 directory, it is an error.
8956 The program accepts the following options. Also see @ref{Common options}.
8960 @item --ignore-fail-on-non-empty
8961 @opindex --ignore-fail-on-non-empty
8962 @cindex directory deletion, ignoring failures
8963 Ignore each failure to remove a directory that is solely because
8964 the directory is non-empty.
8970 @cindex parent directories, removing
8971 Remove @var{directory}, then try to remove each component of @var{directory}.
8972 So, for example, @samp{rmdir -p a/b/c} is similar to @samp{rmdir a/b/c a/b a}.
8973 As such, it fails if any of those directories turns out not to be empty.
8974 Use the @option{--ignore-fail-on-non-empty} option to make it so such
8975 a failure does not evoke a diagnostic and does not cause @command{rmdir} to
8976 exit unsuccessfully.
8982 @cindex directory deletion, reporting
8983 Give a diagnostic for each successful removal.
8984 @var{directory} is removed.
8988 @xref{rm invocation}, for how to remove non-empty directories (recursively).
8993 @node unlink invocation
8994 @section @command{unlink}: Remove files via the unlink syscall
8997 @cindex removing files or directories (via the unlink syscall)
8999 @command{unlink} deletes a single specified file name.
9000 It is a minimalist interface to the system-provided
9001 @code{unlink} function. @xref{Deleting Files, , , libc,
9002 The GNU C Library Reference Manual}. Synopsis:
9003 It avoids the bells and whistles of the more commonly-used
9004 @command{rm} command (@pxref{rm invocation}).
9007 unlink @var{filename}
9010 On some systems @code{unlink} can be used to delete the name of a
9011 directory. On others, it can be used that way only by a privileged user.
9012 In the GNU system @code{unlink} can never delete the name of a directory.
9014 The @command{unlink} command honors the @option{--help} and
9015 @option{--version} options. To remove a file whose name begins with
9016 @samp{-}, prefix the name with @samp{./}, e.g., @samp{unlink ./--help}.
9021 @node Changing file attributes
9022 @chapter Changing file attributes
9024 @cindex changing file attributes
9025 @cindex file attributes, changing
9026 @cindex attributes, file
9028 A file is not merely its contents, a name, and a file type
9029 (@pxref{Special file types}). A file also has an owner (a user ID), a
9030 group (a group ID), permissions (what the owner can do with the file,
9031 what people in the group can do, and what everyone else can do), various
9032 timestamps, and other information. Collectively, we call these a file's
9035 These commands change file attributes.
9038 * chgrp invocation:: Change file groups.
9039 * chmod invocation:: Change access permissions.
9040 * chown invocation:: Change file owners and groups.
9041 * touch invocation:: Change file timestamps.
9045 @node chown invocation
9046 @section @command{chown}: Change file owner and group
9049 @cindex file ownership, changing
9050 @cindex group ownership, changing
9051 @cindex changing file ownership
9052 @cindex changing group ownership
9054 @command{chown} changes the user and/or group ownership of each given @var{file}
9055 to @var{new-owner} or to the user and group of an existing reference file.
9059 chown [@var{option}]@dots{} @{@var{new-owner} | --reference=@var{ref_file}@} @var{file}@dots{}
9062 If used, @var{new-owner} specifies the new owner and/or group as follows
9063 (with no embedded white space):
9066 [@var{owner}] [ : [@var{group}] ]
9073 If only an @var{owner} (a user name or numeric user ID) is given, that
9074 user is made the owner of each given file, and the files' group is not
9077 @item owner@samp{:}group
9078 If the @var{owner} is followed by a colon and a @var{group} (a
9079 group name or numeric group ID), with no spaces between them, the group
9080 ownership of the files is changed as well (to @var{group}).
9083 If a colon but no group name follows @var{owner}, that user is
9084 made the owner of the files and the group of the files is changed to
9085 @var{owner}'s login group.
9088 If the colon and following @var{group} are given, but the owner
9089 is omitted, only the group of the files is changed; in this case,
9090 @command{chown} performs the same function as @command{chgrp}.
9093 If only a colon is given, or if @var{new-owner} is empty, neither the
9094 owner nor the group is changed.
9098 If @var{owner} or @var{group} is intended to represent a numeric user
9099 or group ID, then you may specify it with a leading @samp{+}.
9100 @xref{Disambiguating names and IDs}.
9102 Some older scripts may still use @samp{.} in place of the @samp{:} separator.
9103 @acronym{POSIX} 1003.1-2001 (@pxref{Standards conformance}) does not
9104 require support for that, but for backward compatibility @acronym{GNU}
9105 @command{chown} supports @samp{.} so long as no ambiguity results.
9106 New scripts should avoid the use of @samp{.} because it is not
9107 portable, and because it has undesirable results if the entire
9108 @var{owner@samp{.}group} happens to identify a user whose name
9111 The @command{chown} command sometimes clears the set-user-ID or
9112 set-group-ID permission bits. This behavior depends on the policy and
9113 functionality of the underlying @code{chown} system call, which may
9114 make system-dependent file mode modifications outside the control of
9115 the @command{chown} command. For example, the @command{chown} command
9116 might not affect those bits when invoked by a user with appropriate
9117 privileges, or when the
9118 bits signify some function other than executable permission (e.g.,
9120 When in doubt, check the underlying system behavior.
9122 The program accepts the following options. Also see @ref{Common options}.
9130 @cindex changed owners, verbosely describing
9131 Verbosely describe the action for each @var{file} whose ownership
9140 @cindex error messages, omitting
9141 Do not print error messages about files whose ownership cannot be
9144 @itemx @w{@kbd{--from}=@var{old-owner}}
9146 @cindex symbolic links, changing owner
9147 Change a @var{file}'s ownership only if it has current attributes specified
9148 by @var{old-owner}. @var{old-owner} has the same form as @var{new-owner}
9150 This option is useful primarily from a security standpoint in that
9151 it narrows considerably the window of potential abuse.
9152 For example, to reflect a user ID numbering change for one user's files
9153 without an option like this, @code{root} might run
9156 find / -owner OLDUSER -print0 | xargs -0 chown -h NEWUSER
9159 But that is dangerous because the interval between when the @command{find}
9160 tests the existing file's owner and when the @command{chown} is actually run
9162 One way to narrow the gap would be to invoke chown for each file
9166 find / -owner OLDUSER -exec chown -h NEWUSER @{@} \;
9169 But that is very slow if there are many affected files.
9170 With this option, it is safer (the gap is narrower still)
9171 though still not perfect:
9174 chown -h -R --from=OLDUSER NEWUSER /
9178 @opindex --dereference
9179 @cindex symbolic links, changing owner
9181 Do not act on symbolic links themselves but rather on what they point to.
9182 This is the default.
9185 @itemx --no-dereference
9187 @opindex --no-dereference
9188 @cindex symbolic links, changing owner
9190 Act on symbolic links themselves instead of what they point to.
9191 This mode relies on the @code{lchown} system call.
9192 On systems that do not provide the @code{lchown} system call,
9193 @command{chown} fails when a file specified on the command line
9195 By default, no diagnostic is issued for symbolic links encountered
9196 during a recursive traversal, but see @option{--verbose}.
9198 @itemx --preserve-root
9199 @opindex --preserve-root
9200 @cindex root directory, disallow recursive modification
9201 Fail upon any attempt to recursively change the root directory, @file{/}.
9202 Without @option{--recursive}, this option has no effect.
9203 @xref{Treating / specially}.
9205 @itemx --no-preserve-root
9206 @opindex --no-preserve-root
9207 @cindex root directory, allow recursive modification
9208 Cancel the effect of any preceding @option{--preserve-root} option.
9209 @xref{Treating / specially}.
9211 @item --reference=@var{ref_file}
9212 @opindex --reference
9213 Change the user and group of each @var{file} to be the same as those of
9214 @var{ref_file}. If @var{ref_file} is a symbolic link, do not use the
9215 user and group of the symbolic link, but rather those of the file it
9222 Output a diagnostic for every file processed.
9223 If a symbolic link is encountered during a recursive traversal
9224 on a system without the @code{lchown} system call, and @option{--no-dereference}
9225 is in effect, then issue a diagnostic saying neither the symbolic link nor
9226 its referent is being changed.
9231 @opindex --recursive
9232 @cindex recursively changing file ownership
9233 Recursively change ownership of directories and their contents.
9236 @xref{Traversing symlinks}.
9239 @xref{Traversing symlinks}.
9242 @xref{Traversing symlinks}.
9251 # Change the owner of /u to "root".
9254 # Likewise, but also change its group to "staff".
9257 # Change the owner of /u and subfiles to "root".
9262 @node chgrp invocation
9263 @section @command{chgrp}: Change group ownership
9266 @cindex group ownership, changing
9267 @cindex changing group ownership
9269 @command{chgrp} changes the group ownership of each given @var{file}
9270 to @var{group} (which can be either a group name or a numeric group ID)
9271 or to the group of an existing reference file. Synopsis:
9274 chgrp [@var{option}]@dots{} @{@var{group} | --reference=@var{ref_file}@} @var{file}@dots{}
9277 If @var{group} is intended to represent a
9278 numeric group ID, then you may specify it with a leading @samp{+}.
9279 @xref{Disambiguating names and IDs}.
9281 The program accepts the following options. Also see @ref{Common options}.
9289 @cindex changed files, verbosely describing
9290 Verbosely describe the action for each @var{file} whose group actually
9299 @cindex error messages, omitting
9300 Do not print error messages about files whose group cannot be
9304 @opindex --dereference
9305 @cindex symbolic links, changing owner
9307 Do not act on symbolic links themselves but rather on what they point to.
9308 This is the default.
9311 @itemx --no-dereference
9313 @opindex --no-dereference
9314 @cindex symbolic links, changing group
9316 Act on symbolic links themselves instead of what they point to.
9317 This mode relies on the @code{lchown} system call.
9318 On systems that do not provide the @code{lchown} system call,
9319 @command{chgrp} fails when a file specified on the command line
9321 By default, no diagnostic is issued for symbolic links encountered
9322 during a recursive traversal, but see @option{--verbose}.
9324 @itemx --preserve-root
9325 @opindex --preserve-root
9326 @cindex root directory, disallow recursive modification
9327 Fail upon any attempt to recursively change the root directory, @file{/}.
9328 Without @option{--recursive}, this option has no effect.
9329 @xref{Treating / specially}.
9331 @itemx --no-preserve-root
9332 @opindex --no-preserve-root
9333 @cindex root directory, allow recursive modification
9334 Cancel the effect of any preceding @option{--preserve-root} option.
9335 @xref{Treating / specially}.
9337 @item --reference=@var{ref_file}
9338 @opindex --reference
9339 Change the group of each @var{file} to be the same as that of
9340 @var{ref_file}. If @var{ref_file} is a symbolic link, do not use the
9341 group of the symbolic link, but rather that of the file it refers to.
9347 Output a diagnostic for every file processed.
9348 If a symbolic link is encountered during a recursive traversal
9349 on a system without the @code{lchown} system call, and @option{--no-dereference}
9350 is in effect, then issue a diagnostic saying neither the symbolic link nor
9351 its referent is being changed.
9356 @opindex --recursive
9357 @cindex recursively changing group ownership
9358 Recursively change the group ownership of directories and their contents.
9361 @xref{Traversing symlinks}.
9364 @xref{Traversing symlinks}.
9367 @xref{Traversing symlinks}.
9376 # Change the group of /u to "staff".
9379 # Change the group of /u and subfiles to "staff".
9384 @node chmod invocation
9385 @section @command{chmod}: Change access permissions
9388 @cindex changing access permissions
9389 @cindex access permissions, changing
9390 @cindex permissions, changing access
9392 @command{chmod} changes the access permissions of the named files. Synopsis:
9395 chmod [@var{option}]@dots{} @{@var{mode} | --reference=@var{ref_file}@} @var{file}@dots{}
9398 @cindex symbolic links, permissions of
9399 @command{chmod} never changes the permissions of symbolic links, since
9400 the @command{chmod} system call cannot change their permissions.
9401 This is not a problem since the permissions of symbolic links are
9402 never used. However, for each symbolic link listed on the command
9403 line, @command{chmod} changes the permissions of the pointed-to file.
9404 In contrast, @command{chmod} ignores symbolic links encountered during
9405 recursive directory traversals.
9407 A successful use of @command{chmod} clears the set-group-ID bit of a
9408 regular file if the file's group ID does not match the user's
9409 effective group ID or one of the user's supplementary group IDs,
9410 unless the user has appropriate privileges. Additional restrictions
9411 may cause the set-user-ID and set-group-ID bits of @var{mode} or
9412 @var{ref_file} to be ignored. This behavior depends on the policy and
9413 functionality of the underlying @code{chmod} system call. When in
9414 doubt, check the underlying system behavior.
9416 If used, @var{mode} specifies the new file mode bits.
9417 For details, see the section on @ref{File permissions}.
9418 If you really want @var{mode} to have a leading @samp{-}, you should
9419 use @option{--} first, e.g., @samp{chmod -- -w file}. Typically,
9420 though, @samp{chmod a-w file} is preferable, and @command{chmod -w
9421 file} (without the @option{--}) complains if it behaves differently
9422 from what @samp{chmod a-w file} would do.
9424 The program accepts the following options. Also see @ref{Common options}.
9432 Verbosely describe the action for each @var{file} whose permissions
9441 @cindex error messages, omitting
9442 Do not print error messages about files whose permissions cannot be
9445 @itemx --preserve-root
9446 @opindex --preserve-root
9447 @cindex root directory, disallow recursive modification
9448 Fail upon any attempt to recursively change the root directory, @file{/}.
9449 Without @option{--recursive}, this option has no effect.
9450 @xref{Treating / specially}.
9452 @itemx --no-preserve-root
9453 @opindex --no-preserve-root
9454 @cindex root directory, allow recursive modification
9455 Cancel the effect of any preceding @option{--preserve-root} option.
9456 @xref{Treating / specially}.
9462 Verbosely describe the action or non-action taken for every @var{file}.
9464 @item --reference=@var{ref_file}
9465 @opindex --reference
9466 Change the mode of each @var{file} to be the same as that of @var{ref_file}.
9467 @xref{File permissions}.
9468 If @var{ref_file} is a symbolic link, do not use the mode
9469 of the symbolic link, but rather that of the file it refers to.
9474 @opindex --recursive
9475 @cindex recursively changing access permissions
9476 Recursively change permissions of directories and their contents.
9483 @node touch invocation
9484 @section @command{touch}: Change file timestamps
9487 @cindex changing file timestamps
9488 @cindex file timestamps, changing
9489 @cindex timestamps, changing file
9491 @command{touch} changes the access and/or modification times of the
9492 specified files. Synopsis:
9495 touch [@var{option}]@dots{} @var{file}@dots{}
9498 @cindex empty files, creating
9499 Any @var{file} argument that does not exist is created empty.
9501 A @var{file} argument string of @samp{-} is handled specially and
9502 causes @command{touch} to change the times of the file associated with
9505 @cindex permissions, for changing file timestamps
9506 If changing both the access and modification times to the current
9507 time, @command{touch} can change the timestamps for files that the user
9508 running it does not own but has write permission for. Otherwise, the
9509 user must own the files.
9511 Although @command{touch} provides options for changing two of the times---the
9512 times of last access and modification---of a file, there is actually
9513 a third one as well: the inode change time. This is often referred to
9514 as a file's @code{ctime}.
9515 The inode change time represents the time when the file's meta-information
9516 last changed. One common example of this is when the permissions of a
9517 file change. Changing the permissions doesn't access the file, so
9518 the atime doesn't change, nor does it modify the file, so the mtime
9519 doesn't change. Yet, something about the file itself has changed,
9520 and this must be noted somewhere. This is the job of the ctime field.
9521 This is necessary, so that, for example, a backup program can make a
9522 fresh copy of the file, including the new permissions value.
9523 Another operation that modifies a file's ctime without affecting
9524 the others is renaming. In any case, it is not possible, in normal
9525 operations, for a user to change the ctime field to a user-specified value.
9528 Time stamps assume the time zone rules specified by the @env{TZ}
9529 environment variable, or by the system default rules if @env{TZ} is
9530 not set. @xref{TZ Variable,, Specifying the Time Zone with @env{TZ},
9531 libc, The GNU C Library Reference Manual}.
9532 You can avoid ambiguities during
9533 daylight saving transitions by using @sc{utc} time stamps.
9535 The program accepts the following options. Also see @ref{Common options}.
9541 @itemx --time=access
9545 @opindex atime@r{, changing}
9546 @opindex access @r{time, changing}
9547 @opindex use @r{time, changing}
9548 Change the access time only.
9553 @opindex --no-create
9554 Do not create files that do not exist.
9557 @itemx --date=@var{time}
9561 Use @var{time} instead of the current time. It can contain month names,
9562 time zones, @samp{am} and @samp{pm}, @samp{yesterday}, etc. For
9563 example, @option{--date="2004-02-27 14:19:13.489392193 +0530"}
9564 specifies the instant of time that is 489,392,193 nanoseconds after
9565 February 27, 2004 at 2:19:13 PM in a time zone that is 5 hours and 30
9566 minutes east of @acronym{UTC}. @xref{Date input formats}.
9567 File systems that do not support high-resolution time stamps
9568 silently ignore any excess precision here.
9572 @cindex BSD @command{touch} compatibility
9573 Ignored; for compatibility with BSD versions of @command{touch}.
9577 @itemx --time=modify
9580 @opindex mtime@r{, changing}
9581 @opindex modify @r{time, changing}
9582 Change the modification time only.
9585 @itemx --reference=@var{file}
9587 @opindex --reference
9588 Use the times of the reference @var{file} instead of the current time.
9589 If this option is combined with the @option{--date=@var{time}}
9590 (@option{-d @var{time}}) option, the reference @var{file}'s time is
9591 the origin for any relative @var{time}s given, but is otherwise ignored.
9592 For example, @samp{-r foo -d '-5 seconds'} specifies a time stamp
9593 equal to five seconds before the corresponding time stamp for @file{foo}.
9595 @item -t [[@var{CC}]@var{YY}]@var{MMDDhhmm}[.@var{ss}]
9596 Use the argument (optional four-digit or two-digit years, months,
9597 days, hours, minutes, optional seconds) instead of the current time.
9598 If the year is specified with only two digits, then @var{CC}
9599 is 20 for years in the range 0 @dots{} 68, and 19 for years in
9600 69 @dots{} 99. If no digits of the year are specified,
9601 the argument is interpreted as a date in the current year.
9605 @vindex _POSIX2_VERSION
9606 On older systems, @command{touch} supports an obsolete syntax, as follows.
9607 If no timestamp is given with any of the @option{-d}, @option{-r}, or
9608 @option{-t} options, and if there are two or more @var{file}s and the
9609 first @var{file} is of the form @samp{@var{MMDDhhmm}[@var{YY}]} and this
9610 would be a valid argument to the @option{-t} option (if the @var{YY}, if
9611 any, were moved to the front), and if the represented year
9612 is in the range 1969--1999, that argument is interpreted as the time
9613 for the other files instead of as a file name.
9614 This obsolete behavior can be enabled or disabled with the
9615 @env{_POSIX2_VERSION} environment variable (@pxref{Standards
9616 conformance}), but portable scripts should avoid commands whose
9617 behavior depends on this variable.
9618 For example, use @samp{touch ./12312359 main.c} or @samp{touch -t
9619 12312359 main.c} rather than the ambiguous @samp{touch 12312359 main.c}.
9629 No disk can hold an infinite amount of data. These commands report
9630 how much disk storage is in use or available, report other file and
9631 file status information, and write buffers to disk.
9634 * df invocation:: Report file system disk space usage.
9635 * du invocation:: Estimate file space usage.
9636 * stat invocation:: Report file or file system status.
9637 * sync invocation:: Synchronize memory and disk.
9638 * truncate invocation:: Shrink or extend the size of a file.
9643 @section @command{df}: Report file system disk space usage
9646 @cindex file system disk usage
9647 @cindex disk usage by file system
9649 @command{df} reports the amount of disk space used and available on
9650 file systems. Synopsis:
9653 df [@var{option}]@dots{} [@var{file}]@dots{}
9656 With no arguments, @command{df} reports the space used and available on all
9657 currently mounted file systems (of all types). Otherwise, @command{df}
9658 reports on the file system containing each argument @var{file}.
9660 Normally the disk space is printed in units of
9661 1024 bytes, but this can be overridden (@pxref{Block size}).
9662 Non-integer quantities are rounded up to the next higher unit.
9664 @cindex disk device file
9665 @cindex device file, disk
9666 If an argument @var{file} is a disk device file containing a mounted
9667 file system, @command{df} shows the space available on that file system
9668 rather than on the file system containing the device node (i.e., the root
9669 file system). @sc{gnu} @command{df} does not attempt to determine the disk usage
9670 on unmounted file systems, because on most kinds of systems doing so
9671 requires extremely nonportable intimate knowledge of file system
9674 The program accepts the following options. Also see @ref{Common options}.
9682 @cindex automounter file systems
9683 @cindex ignore file systems
9684 Include in the listing dummy file systems, which
9685 are omitted by default. Such file systems are typically special-purpose
9686 pseudo-file-systems, such as automounter entries.
9689 @itemx --block-size=@var{size}
9691 @opindex --block-size
9692 @cindex file system sizes
9693 Scale sizes by @var{size} before printing them (@pxref{Block size}).
9694 For example, @option{-BG} prints sizes in units of 1,073,741,824 bytes.
9700 Equivalent to @option{--si}.
9707 List inode usage information instead of block usage. An inode (short
9708 for index node) contains information about a file such as its owner,
9709 permissions, timestamps, and location on the disk.
9713 @cindex kibibytes for file system sizes
9714 Print sizes in 1024-byte blocks, overriding the default block size
9715 (@pxref{Block size}).
9716 This option is equivalent to @option{--block-size=1K}.
9722 @cindex file system types, limiting output to certain
9723 Limit the listing to local file systems. By default, remote file systems
9728 @cindex file system space, retrieving old data more quickly
9729 Do not invoke the @code{sync} system call before getting any usage data.
9730 This may make @command{df} run significantly faster on systems with many
9731 disks, but on some systems (notably SunOS) the results may be slightly
9732 out of date. This is the default.
9735 @itemx --portability
9737 @opindex --portability
9738 @cindex one-line output format
9739 @cindex @acronym{POSIX} output format
9740 @cindex portable output format
9741 @cindex output format, portable
9742 Use the @acronym{POSIX} output format. This is like the default format except
9747 The information about each file system is always printed on exactly
9748 one line; a mount device is never put on a line by itself. This means
9749 that if the mount device name is more than 20 characters long (e.g., for
9750 some network mounts), the columns are misaligned.
9753 The labels in the header output line are changed to conform to @acronym{POSIX}.
9756 The default block size and output format are unaffected by the
9757 @env{DF_BLOCK_SIZE}, @env{BLOCK_SIZE} and @env{BLOCKSIZE} environment
9758 variables. However, the default block size is still affected by
9759 @env{POSIXLY_CORRECT}: it is 512 if @env{POSIXLY_CORRECT} is set, 1024
9760 otherwise. @xref{Block size}.
9767 @cindex file system space, retrieving current data more slowly
9768 Invoke the @code{sync} system call before getting any usage data. On
9769 some systems (notably SunOS), doing this yields more up to date results,
9770 but in general this option makes @command{df} much slower, especially when
9771 there are many or very busy file systems.
9773 @item -t @var{fstype}
9774 @itemx --type=@var{fstype}
9777 @cindex file system types, limiting output to certain
9778 Limit the listing to file systems of type @var{fstype}. Multiple
9779 file system types can be specified by giving multiple @option{-t} options.
9780 By default, nothing is omitted.
9785 @opindex --print-type
9786 @cindex file system types, printing
9787 Print each file system's type. The types printed here are the same ones
9788 you can include or exclude with @option{-t} and @option{-x}. The particular
9789 types printed are whatever is supported by the system. Here are some of
9790 the common names (this list is certainly not exhaustive):
9795 @cindex @acronym{NFS} file system type
9796 An @acronym{NFS} file system, i.e., one mounted over a network from another
9797 machine. This is the one type name which seems to be used uniformly by
9800 @item 4.2@r{, }ufs@r{, }efs@dots{}
9801 @cindex Linux file system types
9802 @cindex local file system types
9803 @opindex 4.2 @r{file system type}
9804 @opindex ufs @r{file system type}
9805 @opindex efs @r{file system type}
9806 A file system on a locally-mounted hard disk. (The system might even
9807 support more than one type here; Linux does.)
9809 @item hsfs@r{, }cdfs
9810 @cindex CD-ROM file system type
9811 @cindex High Sierra file system
9812 @opindex hsfs @r{file system type}
9813 @opindex cdfs @r{file system type}
9814 A file system on a CD-ROM drive. HP-UX uses @samp{cdfs}, most other
9815 systems use @samp{hsfs} (@samp{hs} for ``High Sierra'').
9818 @cindex PC file system
9819 @cindex DOS file system
9820 @cindex MS-DOS file system
9821 @cindex diskette file system
9823 An MS-DOS file system, usually on a diskette.
9827 @item -x @var{fstype}
9828 @itemx --exclude-type=@var{fstype}
9830 @opindex --exclude-type
9831 Limit the listing to file systems not of type @var{fstype}.
9832 Multiple file system types can be eliminated by giving multiple
9833 @option{-x} options. By default, no file system types are omitted.
9836 Ignored; for compatibility with System V versions of @command{df}.
9841 Failure includes the case where no output is generated, so you can
9842 inspect the exit status of a command like @samp{df -t ext3 -t reiserfs
9843 @var{dir}} to test whether @var{dir} is on a file system of type
9844 @samp{ext3} or @samp{reiserfs}.
9848 @section @command{du}: Estimate file space usage
9851 @cindex file space usage
9852 @cindex disk usage for files
9854 @command{du} reports the amount of disk space used by the specified files
9855 and for each subdirectory (of directory arguments). Synopsis:
9858 du [@var{option}]@dots{} [@var{file}]@dots{}
9861 With no arguments, @command{du} reports the disk space for the current
9862 directory. Normally the disk space is printed in units of
9863 1024 bytes, but this can be overridden (@pxref{Block size}).
9864 Non-integer quantities are rounded up to the next higher unit.
9866 If two or more hard links point to the same file, only one of the hard
9867 links is counted. The @var{file} argument order affects which links
9868 are counted, and changing the argument order may change the numbers
9869 that @command{du} outputs.
9871 The program accepts the following options. Also see @ref{Common options}.
9879 Show counts for all files, not just directories.
9881 @itemx --apparent-size
9882 @opindex --apparent-size
9883 Print apparent sizes, rather than disk usage. The apparent size of a
9884 file is the number of bytes reported by @code{wc -c} on regular files,
9885 or more generally, @code{ls -l --block-size=1} or @code{stat --format=%s}.
9886 For example, a file containing the word @samp{zoo} with no newline would,
9887 of course, have an apparent size of 3. Such a small file may require
9888 anywhere from 0 to 16 KiB or more of disk space, depending on
9889 the type and configuration of the file system on which the file resides.
9890 However, a sparse file created with this command:
9893 dd bs=1 seek=2GiB if=/dev/null of=big
9897 has an apparent size of 2 GiB, yet on most modern
9898 systems, it actually uses almost no disk space.
9904 Equivalent to @code{--apparent-size --block-size=1}.
9907 @itemx --block-size=@var{size}
9909 @opindex --block-size
9911 Scale sizes by @var{size} before printing them (@pxref{Block size}).
9912 For example, @option{-BG} prints sizes in units of 1,073,741,824 bytes.
9918 @cindex grand total of disk space
9919 Print a grand total of all arguments after all arguments have
9920 been processed. This can be used to find out the total disk usage of
9921 a given set of files or directories.
9924 @itemx --dereference-args
9926 @opindex --dereference-args
9927 Dereference symbolic links that are command line arguments.
9928 Does not affect other symbolic links. This is helpful for finding
9929 out the disk usage of directories, such as @file{/usr/tmp}, which
9930 are often symbolic links.
9932 @c --files0-from=FILE
9933 @filesZeroFromOption{du,, with the @option{--total} (@option{-c}) option}
9939 Currently, @option{-H} is the same as @option{--si},
9940 except that @option{-H} evokes a warning.
9941 This option will be changed to be equivalent to
9942 @option{--dereference-args} (@option{-D}).
9946 @cindex kibibytes for file sizes
9947 Print sizes in 1024-byte blocks, overriding the default block size
9948 (@pxref{Block size}).
9949 This option is equivalent to @option{--block-size=1K}.
9952 @itemx --count-links
9954 @opindex --count-links
9955 @cindex hard links, counting in @command{du}
9956 Count the size of all files, even if they have appeared already (as a
9960 @itemx --dereference
9962 @opindex --dereference
9963 @cindex symbolic links, dereferencing in @command{du}
9964 Dereference symbolic links (show the disk space used by the file
9965 or directory that the link points to instead of the space used by
9970 @cindex mebibytes for file sizes
9971 Print sizes in 1,048,576-byte blocks, overriding the default block size
9972 (@pxref{Block size}).
9973 This option is equivalent to @option{--block-size=1M}.
9976 @itemx --no-dereference
9978 @opindex --no-dereference
9979 @cindex symbolic links, dereferencing in @command{du}
9980 For each symbolic links encountered by @command{du},
9981 consider the disk space used by the symbolic link.
9983 @item --max-depth=@var{DEPTH}
9984 @opindex --max-depth=@var{DEPTH}
9985 @cindex limiting output of @command{du}
9986 Show the total for each directory (and file if --all) that is at
9987 most MAX_DEPTH levels down from the root of the hierarchy. The root
9988 is at level 0, so @code{du --max-depth=0} is equivalent to @code{du -s}.
9994 @cindex output null-byte-terminated lines
9995 Output a null byte at the end of each line, rather than a newline.
9996 This option enables other programs to parse the output of @command{du}
9997 even when that output would contain file names with embedded newlines.
10004 @opindex --summarize
10005 Display only a total for each argument.
10008 @itemx --separate-dirs
10010 @opindex --separate-dirs
10011 Normally, in the output of @command{du} (when not using @option{--summarize}),
10012 the size listed next to a directory name, @var{d}, represents the sum
10013 of sizes of all entries beneath @var{d} as well as the size of @var{d} itself.
10014 With @option{--separate-dirs}, the size reported for a directory name,
10015 @var{d}, is merely the @code{stat.st_size}-derived size of the directory
10020 @cindex last modified dates, displaying in @command{du}
10021 Show time of the most recent modification of any file in the directory,
10022 or any of its subdirectories.
10024 @itemx --time=ctime
10025 @itemx --time=status
10028 @opindex ctime@r{, show the most recent}
10029 @opindex status time@r{, show the most recent}
10030 @opindex use time@r{, show the most recent}
10031 Show the most recent status change time (the @samp{ctime} in the inode) of
10032 any file in the directory, instead of the modification time.
10034 @itemx --time=atime
10035 @itemx --time=access
10037 @opindex atime@r{, show the most recent}
10038 @opindex access time@r{, show the most recent}
10039 Show the most recent access time (the @samp{atime} in the inode) of
10040 any file in the directory, instead of the modification time.
10042 @item --time-style=@var{style}
10043 @opindex --time-style
10045 List timestamps in style @var{style}. This option has an effect only if
10046 the @option{--time} option is also specified. The @var{style} should
10047 be one of the following:
10050 @item +@var{format}
10052 List timestamps using @var{format}, where @var{format} is interpreted
10053 like the format argument of @command{date} (@pxref{date invocation}).
10054 For example, @option{--time-style="+%Y-%m-%d %H:%M:%S"} causes
10055 @command{du} to list timestamps like @samp{2002-03-30 23:45:56}. As
10056 with @command{date}, @var{format}'s interpretation is affected by the
10057 @env{LC_TIME} locale category.
10060 List timestamps in full using @acronym{ISO} 8601 date, time, and time zone
10061 format with nanosecond precision, e.g., @samp{2002-03-30
10062 23:45:56.477817180 -0700}. This style is equivalent to
10063 @samp{+%Y-%m-%d %H:%M:%S.%N %z}.
10066 List @acronym{ISO} 8601 date and time in minutes, e.g.,
10067 @samp{2002-03-30 23:45}. These timestamps are shorter than
10068 @samp{full-iso} timestamps, and are usually good enough for everyday
10069 work. This style is equivalent to @samp{+%Y-%m-%d %H:%M}.
10072 List @acronym{ISO} 8601 dates for timestamps, e.g., @samp{2002-03-30}.
10073 This style is equivalent to @samp{+%Y-%m-%d}.
10077 You can specify the default value of the @option{--time-style} option
10078 with the environment variable @env{TIME_STYLE}; if @env{TIME_STYLE} is not set
10079 the default style is @samp{long-iso}. For compatibility with @command{ls},
10080 if @env{TIME_STYLE} begins with @samp{+} and contains a newline,
10081 the newline and any later characters are ignored; if @env{TIME_STYLE}
10082 begins with @samp{posix-} the @samp{posix-} is ignored; and if
10083 @env{TIME_STYLE} is @samp{locale} it is ignored.
10086 @itemx --one-file-system
10088 @opindex --one-file-system
10089 @cindex one file system, restricting @command{du} to
10090 Skip directories that are on different file systems from the one that
10091 the argument being processed is on.
10093 @item --exclude=@var{PATTERN}
10094 @opindex --exclude=@var{PATTERN}
10095 @cindex excluding files from @command{du}
10096 When recursing, skip subdirectories or files matching @var{PATTERN}.
10097 For example, @code{du --exclude='*.o'} excludes files whose names
10100 @item -X @var{FILE}
10101 @itemx --exclude-from=@var{FILE}
10102 @opindex -X @var{FILE}
10103 @opindex --exclude-from=@var{FILE}
10104 @cindex excluding files from @command{du}
10105 Like @option{--exclude}, except take the patterns to exclude from @var{FILE},
10106 one per line. If @var{FILE} is @samp{-}, take the patterns from standard
10111 @cindex NFS mounts from BSD to HP-UX
10112 On BSD systems, @command{du} reports sizes that are half the correct
10113 values for files that are NFS-mounted from HP-UX systems. On HP-UX
10114 systems, it reports sizes that are twice the correct values for
10115 files that are NFS-mounted from BSD systems. This is due to a flaw
10116 in HP-UX; it also affects the HP-UX @command{du} program.
10121 @node stat invocation
10122 @section @command{stat}: Report file or file system status
10125 @cindex file status
10126 @cindex file system status
10128 @command{stat} displays information about the specified file(s). Synopsis:
10131 stat [@var{option}]@dots{} [@var{file}]@dots{}
10134 With no option, @command{stat} reports all information about the given files.
10135 But it also can be used to report the information of the file systems the
10136 given files are located on. If the files are links, @command{stat} can
10137 also give information about the files the links point to.
10143 @itemx --dereference
10145 @opindex --dereference
10146 @cindex symbolic links, dereferencing in @command{stat}
10147 Change how @command{stat} treats symbolic links.
10148 With this option, @command{stat} acts on the file referenced
10149 by each symbolic link argument.
10150 Without it, @command{stat} acts on any symbolic link argument directly.
10153 @itemx --file-system
10155 @opindex --file-system
10156 @cindex file systems
10157 Report information about the file systems where the given files are located
10158 instead of information about the files themselves.
10161 @itemx --format=@var{format}
10163 @opindex --format=@var{format}
10164 @cindex output format
10165 Use @var{format} rather than the default format.
10166 @var{format} is automatically newline-terminated, so
10167 running a command like the following with two or more @var{file}
10168 operands produces a line of output for each operand:
10170 $ stat --format=%d:%i / /usr
10175 @itemx --printf=@var{format}
10176 @opindex --printf=@var{format}
10177 @cindex output format
10178 Use @var{format} rather than the default format.
10179 Like @option{--format}, but interpret backslash escapes,
10180 and do not output a mandatory trailing newline.
10181 If you want a newline, include @samp{\n} in the @var{format}.
10182 Here's how you would use @option{--printf} to print the device
10183 and inode numbers of @file{/} and @file{/usr}:
10185 $ stat --printf='%d:%i\n' / /usr
10194 @cindex terse output
10195 Print the information in terse form, suitable for parsing by other programs.
10197 The valid format sequences for files are:
10200 @item %a - Access rights in octal
10201 @item %A - Access rights in human readable form
10202 @item %b - Number of blocks allocated (see @samp{%B})
10203 @item %B - The size in bytes of each block reported by @samp{%b}
10204 @item %d - Device number in decimal
10205 @item %D - Device number in hex
10206 @item %f - Raw mode in hex
10207 @item %F - File type
10208 @item %g - Group ID of owner
10209 @item %G - Group name of owner
10210 @item %h - Number of hard links
10211 @item %i - Inode number
10212 @item %n - File name
10213 @item %N - Quoted file name with dereference if symbolic link
10214 @item %o - I/O block size
10215 @item %s - Total size, in bytes
10216 @item %t - Major device type in hex
10217 @item %T - Minor device type in hex
10218 @item %u - User ID of owner
10219 @item %U - User name of owner
10220 @item %x - Time of last access
10221 @item %X - Time of last access as seconds since Epoch
10222 @item %y - Time of last modification
10223 @item %Y - Time of last modification as seconds since Epoch
10224 @item %z - Time of last change
10225 @item %Z - Time of last change as seconds since Epoch
10228 The valid format sequences for file systems are:
10231 @item %a - Free blocks available to non-super-user
10232 @item %b - Total data blocks in file system
10233 @item %c - Total file nodes in file system
10234 @item %d - Free file nodes in file system
10235 @item %f - Free blocks in file system
10236 @item %i - File System ID in hex
10237 @item %l - Maximum length of file names
10238 @item %n - File name
10239 @item %s - Block size (for faster transfers)
10240 @item %S - Fundamental block size (for block counts)
10241 @item %t - Type in hex
10242 @item %T - Type in human readable form
10246 Time stamps are listed according to the time zone rules specified by
10247 the @env{TZ} environment variable, or by the system default rules if
10248 @env{TZ} is not set. @xref{TZ Variable,, Specifying the Time Zone
10249 with @env{TZ}, libc, The GNU C Library Reference Manual}.
10255 @node sync invocation
10256 @section @command{sync}: Synchronize data on disk with memory
10259 @cindex synchronize disk and memory
10261 @cindex superblock, writing
10262 @cindex inodes, written buffered
10263 @command{sync} writes any data buffered in memory out to disk. This can
10264 include (but is not limited to) modified superblocks, modified inodes,
10265 and delayed reads and writes. This must be implemented by the kernel;
10266 The @command{sync} program does nothing but exercise the @code{sync} system
10269 @cindex crashes and corruption
10270 The kernel keeps data in memory to avoid doing (relatively slow) disk
10271 reads and writes. This improves performance, but if the computer
10272 crashes, data may be lost or the file system corrupted as a
10273 result. The @command{sync} command ensures everything in memory
10274 is written to disk.
10276 Any arguments are ignored, except for a lone @option{--help} or
10277 @option{--version} (@pxref{Common options}).
10282 @node truncate invocation
10283 @section @command{truncate}: Shrink or extend the size of a file
10286 @cindex truncating, file sizes
10288 @command{truncate} shrinks or extends the size of each @var{file} to the
10289 specified size. Synopsis:
10292 truncate @var{option}@dots{} @var{file}@dots{}
10295 @cindex files, creating
10296 Any @var{file} that does not exist is created.
10298 @cindex sparse files, creating
10299 @cindex holes, creating files with
10300 If a @var{file} is larger than the specified size, the extra data is lost.
10301 If a @var{file} is shorter, it is extended and the extended part (or hole)
10302 reads as zero bytes.
10304 The program accepts the following options. Also see @ref{Common options}.
10311 @opindex --no-create
10312 Do not create files that do not exist.
10317 @opindex --io-blocks
10318 Treat @var{size} as number of I/O blocks of the @var{FILE} rather than bytes.
10320 @item -r @var{rfile}
10321 @itemx --reference=@var{rfile}
10323 @opindex --reference
10324 Set the size of each @var{file} to the same size as @var{rfile}.
10326 @item -s @var{size}
10327 @itemx --size=@var{size}
10330 Set the size of each @var{file} to this @var{size}.
10331 @var{size} is a number which may be followed by one of these
10332 multiplicative suffixes:
10334 @samp{KB} => 1000 (KiloBytes)
10335 @samp{K} => 1024 (KibiBytes)
10336 @samp{MB} => 1000*1000 (MegaBytes)
10337 @samp{M} => 1024*1024 (MebiBytes)
10339 and so on for @samp{G}, @samp{T}, @samp{P}, @samp{E}, @samp{Z}, and @samp{Y}.
10341 @var{size} may also be prefixed by one of the following to adjust
10342 the size of each @var{file} based on their current size:
10344 @samp{+} => extend by
10345 @samp{-} => reduce by
10346 @samp{<} => at most
10347 @samp{>} => at least
10348 @samp{/} => round down to multiple of
10349 @samp{%} => round up to multiple of
10357 @node Printing text
10358 @chapter Printing text
10360 @cindex printing text, commands for
10361 @cindex commands for printing text
10363 This section describes commands that display text strings.
10366 * echo invocation:: Print a line of text.
10367 * printf invocation:: Format and print data.
10368 * yes invocation:: Print a string until interrupted.
10372 @node echo invocation
10373 @section @command{echo}: Print a line of text
10376 @cindex displaying text
10377 @cindex printing text
10378 @cindex text, displaying
10379 @cindex arbitrary text, displaying
10381 @command{echo} writes each given @var{string} to standard output, with a
10382 space between each and a newline after the last one. Synopsis:
10385 echo [@var{option}]@dots{} [@var{string}]@dots{}
10388 The program accepts the following options. Also see @ref{Common options}.
10389 Options must precede operands, and the normally-special argument
10390 @samp{--} has no special meaning and is treated like any other
10396 Do not output the trailing newline.
10400 @cindex backslash escapes
10401 Enable interpretation of the following backslash-escaped characters in
10410 suppress trailing newline
10424 the eight-bit value that is the octal number @var{nnn}
10425 (zero to three octal digits)
10427 the eight-bit value that is the octal number @var{nnn}
10428 (one to three octal digits)
10430 the eight-bit value that is the hexadecimal number @var{hh}
10431 (one or two hexadecimal digits)
10436 @cindex backslash escapes
10437 Disable interpretation of backslash escapes in each @var{string}.
10438 This is the default. If @option{-e} and @option{-E} are both
10439 specified, the last one given takes effect.
10443 @vindex POSIXLY_CORRECT
10444 If the @env{POSIXLY_CORRECT} environment variable is set, then when
10445 @command{echo}'s first argument is not @option{-n} it outputs
10446 option-like arguments instead of treating them as options. For
10447 example, @code{echo -ne hello} outputs @samp{-ne hello} instead of
10448 plain @samp{hello}.
10450 @acronym{POSIX} does not require support for any options, and says
10451 that the behavior of @command{echo} is implementation-defined if any
10452 @var{string} contains a backslash or if the first argument is
10453 @option{-n}. Portable programs can use the @command{printf} command
10454 if they need to omit trailing newlines or output control characters or
10455 backslashes. @xref{printf invocation}.
10460 @node printf invocation
10461 @section @command{printf}: Format and print data
10464 @command{printf} does formatted printing of text. Synopsis:
10467 printf @var{format} [@var{argument}]@dots{}
10470 @command{printf} prints the @var{format} string, interpreting @samp{%}
10471 directives and @samp{\} escapes to format numeric and string arguments
10472 in a way that is mostly similar to the C @samp{printf} function.
10473 @xref{Output Conversion Syntax,, @command{printf} format directives,
10474 libc, The GNU C Library Reference Manual}, for details.
10475 The differences are as follows:
10480 The @var{format} argument is reused as necessary to convert all the
10481 given @var{argument}s. For example, the command @samp{printf %s a b}
10485 Missing @var{argument}s are treated as null strings or as zeros,
10486 depending on whether the context expects a string or a number. For
10487 example, the command @samp{printf %sx%d} prints @samp{x0}.
10491 An additional escape, @samp{\c}, causes @command{printf} to produce no
10492 further output. For example, the command @samp{printf 'A%sC\cD%sF' B
10493 E} prints @samp{ABC}.
10496 The hexadecimal escape sequence @samp{\x@var{hh}} has at most two
10497 digits, as opposed to C where it can have an unlimited number of
10498 digits. For example, the command @samp{printf '\x07e'} prints two
10499 bytes, whereas the C statement @samp{printf ("\x07e")} prints just
10504 @command{printf} has an additional directive, @samp{%b}, which prints its
10505 argument string with @samp{\} escapes interpreted in the same way as in
10506 the @var{format} string, except that octal escapes are of the form
10507 @samp{\0@var{ooo}} where @var{ooo} is 0 to 3 octal digits.
10508 If a precision is also given, it limits the number of bytes printed
10509 from the converted string.
10512 Numeric arguments must be single C constants, possibly with leading
10513 @samp{+} or @samp{-}. For example, @samp{printf %.4d -3} outputs
10517 @vindex POSIXLY_CORRECT
10518 If the leading character of a numeric argument is @samp{"} or @samp{'}
10519 then its value is the numeric value of the immediately following
10520 character. Any remaining characters are silently ignored if the
10521 @env{POSIXLY_CORRECT} environment variable is set; otherwise, a
10522 warning is printed. For example, @samp{printf "%d" "'a"} outputs
10523 @samp{97} on hosts that use the @acronym{ASCII} character set, since
10524 @samp{a} has the numeric value 97 in @acronym{ASCII}.
10529 A floating-point argument must use a period before any fractional
10530 digits, but is printed according to the @env{LC_NUMERIC} category of the
10531 current locale. For example, in a locale whose radix character is a
10532 comma, the command @samp{printf %g 3.14} outputs @samp{3,14} whereas
10533 the command @samp{printf %g 3,14} is an error.
10537 @command{printf} interprets @samp{\@var{ooo}} in @var{format} as an octal number
10538 (if @var{ooo} is 1 to 3 octal digits) specifying a character to print,
10539 and @samp{\x@var{hh}} as a hexadecimal number (if @var{hh} is 1 to 2 hex
10540 digits) specifying a character to print.
10545 @cindex ISO/IEC 10646
10547 @command{printf} interprets two character syntaxes introduced in
10548 @acronym{ISO} C 99:
10549 @samp{\u} for 16-bit Unicode (@acronym{ISO}/@acronym{IEC} 10646)
10550 characters, specified as
10551 four hexadecimal digits @var{hhhh}, and @samp{\U} for 32-bit Unicode
10552 characters, specified as eight hexadecimal digits @var{hhhhhhhh}.
10553 @command{printf} outputs the Unicode characters
10554 according to the @env{LC_CTYPE} locale. Unicode characters in the ranges
10555 U+0000...U+009F, U+D800...U+DFFF cannot be specified by this syntax, except
10556 for U+0024 ($), U+0040 (@@), and U+0060 (@`).
10558 The processing of @samp{\u} and @samp{\U} requires a full-featured
10559 @code{iconv} facility. It is activated on systems with glibc 2.2 (or newer),
10560 or when @code{libiconv} is installed prior to this package. Otherwise
10561 @samp{\u} and @samp{\U} will print as-is.
10563 The only options are a lone @option{--help} or
10564 @option{--version}. @xref{Common options}.
10565 Options must precede operands.
10567 The Unicode character syntaxes are useful for writing strings in a locale
10568 independent way. For example, a string containing the Euro currency symbol
10571 $ /usr/local/bin/printf '\u20AC 14.95'
10575 will be output correctly in all locales supporting the Euro symbol
10576 (@acronym{ISO}-8859-15, UTF-8, and others). Similarly, a Chinese string
10579 $ /usr/local/bin/printf '\u4e2d\u6587'
10583 will be output correctly in all Chinese locales (GB2312, BIG5, UTF-8, etc).
10585 Note that in these examples, the full name of @command{printf} has been
10586 given, to distinguish it from the GNU @code{bash} built-in function
10589 For larger strings, you don't need to look up the hexadecimal code
10590 values of each character one by one. @acronym{ASCII} characters mixed with \u
10591 escape sequences is also known as the JAVA source file encoding. You can
10592 use GNU recode 3.5c (or newer) to convert strings to this encoding. Here
10593 is how to convert a piece of text into a shell script which will output
10594 this text in a locale-independent way:
10597 $ LC_CTYPE=zh_CN.big5 /usr/local/bin/printf \
10598 '\u4e2d\u6587\n' > sample.txt
10599 $ recode BIG5..JAVA < sample.txt \
10600 | sed -e "s|^|/usr/local/bin/printf '|" -e "s|$|\\\\n'|" \
10607 @node yes invocation
10608 @section @command{yes}: Print a string until interrupted
10611 @cindex repeated output of a string
10613 @command{yes} prints the command line arguments, separated by spaces and
10614 followed by a newline, forever until it is killed. If no arguments are
10615 given, it prints @samp{y} followed by a newline forever until killed.
10617 Upon a write error, @command{yes} exits with status @samp{1}.
10619 The only options are a lone @option{--help} or @option{--version}.
10620 To output an argument that begins with
10621 @samp{-}, precede it with @option{--}, e.g., @samp{yes -- --help}.
10622 @xref{Common options}.
10626 @chapter Conditions
10629 @cindex commands for exit status
10630 @cindex exit status commands
10632 This section describes commands that are primarily useful for their exit
10633 status, rather than their output. Thus, they are often used as the
10634 condition of shell @code{if} statements, or as the last command in a
10638 * false invocation:: Do nothing, unsuccessfully.
10639 * true invocation:: Do nothing, successfully.
10640 * test invocation:: Check file types and compare values.
10641 * expr invocation:: Evaluate expressions.
10645 @node false invocation
10646 @section @command{false}: Do nothing, unsuccessfully
10649 @cindex do nothing, unsuccessfully
10650 @cindex failure exit status
10651 @cindex exit status of @command{false}
10653 @command{false} does nothing except return an exit status of 1, meaning
10654 @dfn{failure}. It can be used as a place holder in shell scripts
10655 where an unsuccessful command is needed.
10656 In most modern shells, @command{false} is a built-in command, so when
10657 you use @samp{false} in a script, you're probably using the built-in
10658 command, not the one documented here.
10660 @command{false} honors the @option{--help} and @option{--version} options.
10662 This version of @command{false} is implemented as a C program, and is thus
10663 more secure and faster than a shell script implementation, and may safely
10664 be used as a dummy shell for the purpose of disabling accounts.
10666 Note that @command{false} (unlike all other programs documented herein)
10667 exits unsuccessfully, even when invoked with
10668 @option{--help} or @option{--version}.
10670 Portable programs should not assume that the exit status of
10671 @command{false} is 1, as it is greater than 1 on some
10672 non-@acronym{GNU} hosts.
10675 @node true invocation
10676 @section @command{true}: Do nothing, successfully
10679 @cindex do nothing, successfully
10681 @cindex successful exit
10682 @cindex exit status of @command{true}
10684 @command{true} does nothing except return an exit status of 0, meaning
10685 @dfn{success}. It can be used as a place holder in shell scripts
10686 where a successful command is needed, although the shell built-in
10687 command @code{:} (colon) may do the same thing faster.
10688 In most modern shells, @command{true} is a built-in command, so when
10689 you use @samp{true} in a script, you're probably using the built-in
10690 command, not the one documented here.
10692 @command{true} honors the @option{--help} and @option{--version} options.
10694 Note, however, that it is possible to cause @command{true}
10695 to exit with nonzero status: with the @option{--help} or @option{--version}
10696 option, and with standard
10697 output already closed or redirected to a file that evokes an I/O error.
10698 For example, using a Bourne-compatible shell:
10701 $ ./true --version >&-
10702 ./true: write error: Bad file number
10703 $ ./true --version > /dev/full
10704 ./true: write error: No space left on device
10707 This version of @command{true} is implemented as a C program, and is thus
10708 more secure and faster than a shell script implementation, and may safely
10709 be used as a dummy shell for the purpose of disabling accounts.
10711 @node test invocation
10712 @section @command{test}: Check file types and compare values
10715 @cindex check file types
10716 @cindex compare values
10717 @cindex expression evaluation
10719 @command{test} returns a status of 0 (true) or 1 (false) depending on the
10720 evaluation of the conditional expression @var{expr}. Each part of the
10721 expression must be a separate argument.
10723 @command{test} has file status checks, string operators, and numeric
10724 comparison operators.
10726 @command{test} has an alternate form that uses opening and closing
10727 square brackets instead a leading @samp{test}. For example, instead
10728 of @samp{test -d /}, you can write @samp{[ -d / ]}. The square
10729 brackets must be separate arguments; for example, @samp{[-d /]} does
10730 not have the desired effect. Since @samp{test @var{expr}} and @samp{[
10731 @var{expr} ]} have the same meaning, only the former form is discussed
10737 test @var{expression}
10739 [ @var{expression} ]
10744 @cindex conflicts with shell built-ins
10745 @cindex built-in shell commands, conflicts with
10746 Because most shells have a built-in @command{test} command, using an
10747 unadorned @command{test} in a script or interactively may get you
10748 different functionality than that described here.
10750 If @var{expression} is omitted, @command{test} returns false.
10751 If @var{expression} is a single argument,
10752 @command{test} returns false if the argument is null and true otherwise. The argument
10753 can be any string, including strings like @samp{-d}, @samp{-1},
10754 @samp{--}, @samp{--help}, and @samp{--version} that most other
10755 programs would treat as options. To get help and version information,
10756 invoke the commands @samp{[ --help} and @samp{[ --version}, without
10757 the usual closing brackets. @xref{Common options}.
10759 @cindex exit status of @command{test}
10763 0 if the expression is true,
10764 1 if the expression is false,
10765 2 if an error occurred.
10769 * File type tests:: -[bcdfhLpSt]
10770 * Access permission tests:: -[gkruwxOG]
10771 * File characteristic tests:: -e -s -nt -ot -ef
10772 * String tests:: -z -n = !=
10773 * Numeric tests:: -eq -ne -lt -le -gt -ge
10774 * Connectives for test:: ! -a -o
10778 @node File type tests
10779 @subsection File type tests
10781 @cindex file type tests
10783 These options test for particular types of files. (Everything's a file,
10784 but not all files are the same!)
10788 @item -b @var{file}
10790 @cindex block special check
10791 True if @var{file} exists and is a block special device.
10793 @item -c @var{file}
10795 @cindex character special check
10796 True if @var{file} exists and is a character special device.
10798 @item -d @var{file}
10800 @cindex directory check
10801 True if @var{file} exists and is a directory.
10803 @item -f @var{file}
10805 @cindex regular file check
10806 True if @var{file} exists and is a regular file.
10808 @item -h @var{file}
10809 @itemx -L @var{file}
10812 @cindex symbolic link check
10813 True if @var{file} exists and is a symbolic link.
10814 Unlike all other file-related tests, this test does not dereference
10815 @var{file} if it is a symbolic link.
10817 @item -p @var{file}
10819 @cindex named pipe check
10820 True if @var{file} exists and is a named pipe.
10822 @item -S @var{file}
10824 @cindex socket check
10825 True if @var{file} exists and is a socket.
10829 @cindex terminal check
10830 True if @var{fd} is a file descriptor that is associated with a
10836 @node Access permission tests
10837 @subsection Access permission tests
10839 @cindex access permission tests
10840 @cindex permission tests
10842 These options test for particular access permissions.
10846 @item -g @var{file}
10848 @cindex set-group-ID check
10849 True if @var{file} exists and has its set-group-ID bit set.
10851 @item -k @var{file}
10853 @cindex sticky bit check
10854 True if @var{file} exists and has its @dfn{sticky} bit set.
10856 @item -r @var{file}
10858 @cindex readable file check
10859 True if @var{file} exists and read permission is granted.
10861 @item -u @var{file}
10863 @cindex set-user-ID check
10864 True if @var{file} exists and has its set-user-ID bit set.
10866 @item -w @var{file}
10868 @cindex writable file check
10869 True if @var{file} exists and write permission is granted.
10871 @item -x @var{file}
10873 @cindex executable file check
10874 True if @var{file} exists and execute permission is granted
10875 (or search permission, if it is a directory).
10877 @item -O @var{file}
10879 @cindex owned by effective user ID check
10880 True if @var{file} exists and is owned by the current effective user ID.
10882 @item -G @var{file}
10884 @cindex owned by effective group ID check
10885 True if @var{file} exists and is owned by the current effective group ID.
10889 @node File characteristic tests
10890 @subsection File characteristic tests
10892 @cindex file characteristic tests
10894 These options test other file characteristics.
10898 @item -e @var{file}
10900 @cindex existence-of-file check
10901 True if @var{file} exists.
10903 @item -s @var{file}
10905 @cindex nonempty file check
10906 True if @var{file} exists and has a size greater than zero.
10908 @item @var{file1} -nt @var{file2}
10910 @cindex newer-than file check
10911 True if @var{file1} is newer (according to modification date) than
10912 @var{file2}, or if @var{file1} exists and @var{file2} does not.
10914 @item @var{file1} -ot @var{file2}
10916 @cindex older-than file check
10917 True if @var{file1} is older (according to modification date) than
10918 @var{file2}, or if @var{file2} exists and @var{file1} does not.
10920 @item @var{file1} -ef @var{file2}
10922 @cindex same file check
10923 @cindex hard link check
10924 True if @var{file1} and @var{file2} have the same device and inode
10925 numbers, i.e., if they are hard links to each other.
10931 @subsection String tests
10933 @cindex string tests
10935 These options test string characteristics. You may need to quote
10936 @var{string} arguments for the shell. For example:
10942 The quotes here prevent the wrong arguments from being passed to
10943 @command{test} if @samp{$V} is empty or contains special characters.
10947 @item -z @var{string}
10949 @cindex zero-length string check
10950 True if the length of @var{string} is zero.
10952 @item -n @var{string}
10953 @itemx @var{string}
10955 @cindex nonzero-length string check
10956 True if the length of @var{string} is nonzero.
10958 @item @var{string1} = @var{string2}
10960 @cindex equal string check
10961 True if the strings are equal.
10963 @item @var{string1} != @var{string2}
10965 @cindex not-equal string check
10966 True if the strings are not equal.
10971 @node Numeric tests
10972 @subsection Numeric tests
10974 @cindex numeric tests
10975 @cindex arithmetic tests
10977 Numeric relational operators. The arguments must be entirely numeric
10978 (possibly negative), or the special expression @w{@code{-l @var{string}}},
10979 which evaluates to the length of @var{string}.
10983 @item @var{arg1} -eq @var{arg2}
10984 @itemx @var{arg1} -ne @var{arg2}
10985 @itemx @var{arg1} -lt @var{arg2}
10986 @itemx @var{arg1} -le @var{arg2}
10987 @itemx @var{arg1} -gt @var{arg2}
10988 @itemx @var{arg1} -ge @var{arg2}
10995 These arithmetic binary operators return true if @var{arg1} is equal,
10996 not-equal, less-than, less-than-or-equal, greater-than, or
10997 greater-than-or-equal than @var{arg2}, respectively.
11004 test -1 -gt -2 && echo yes
11006 test -l abc -gt 1 && echo yes
11009 @error{} test: integer expression expected before -eq
11013 @node Connectives for test
11014 @subsection Connectives for @command{test}
11016 @cindex logical connectives
11017 @cindex connectives, logical
11019 The usual logical connectives.
11025 True if @var{expr} is false.
11027 @item @var{expr1} -a @var{expr2}
11029 @cindex logical and operator
11030 @cindex and operator
11031 True if both @var{expr1} and @var{expr2} are true.
11033 @item @var{expr1} -o @var{expr2}
11035 @cindex logical or operator
11036 @cindex or operator
11037 True if either @var{expr1} or @var{expr2} is true.
11042 @node expr invocation
11043 @section @command{expr}: Evaluate expressions
11046 @cindex expression evaluation
11047 @cindex evaluation of expressions
11049 @command{expr} evaluates an expression and writes the result on standard
11050 output. Each token of the expression must be a separate argument.
11052 Operands are either integers or strings. Integers consist of one or
11053 more decimal digits, with an optional leading @samp{-}.
11054 @command{expr} converts
11055 anything appearing in an operand position to an integer or a string
11056 depending on the operation being applied to it.
11058 Strings are not quoted for @command{expr} itself, though you may need to
11059 quote them to protect characters with special meaning to the shell,
11060 e.g., spaces. However, regardless of whether it is quoted, a string
11061 operand should not be a parenthesis or any of @command{expr}'s
11062 operators like @code{+}, so you cannot safely pass an arbitrary string
11063 @code{$str} to expr merely by quoting it to the shell. One way to
11064 work around this is to use the @sc{gnu} extension @code{+},
11065 (e.g., @code{+ "$str" = foo}); a more portable way is to use
11066 @code{@w{" $str"}} and to adjust the rest of the expression to take
11067 the leading space into account (e.g., @code{@w{" $str" = " foo"}}).
11069 You should not pass a negative integer or a string with leading
11070 @samp{-} as @command{expr}'s first argument, as it might be
11071 misinterpreted as an option; this can be avoided by parenthesization.
11072 Also, portable scripts should not use a string operand that happens to
11073 take the form of an integer; this can be worked around by inserting
11074 leading spaces as mentioned above.
11076 @cindex parentheses for grouping
11077 Operators may be given as infix symbols or prefix keywords. Parentheses
11078 may be used for grouping in the usual manner. You must quote
11079 parentheses and many operators to avoid the shell evaluating them,
11082 The only options are @option{--help} and @option{--version}. @xref{Common
11083 options}. Options must precede operands.
11085 @cindex exit status of @command{expr}
11089 0 if the expression is neither null nor 0,
11090 1 if the expression is null or 0,
11091 2 if the expression is invalid,
11092 3 if an internal error occurred (e.g., arithmetic overflow).
11096 * String expressions:: + : match substr index length
11097 * Numeric expressions:: + - * / %
11098 * Relations for expr:: | & < <= = == != >= >
11099 * Examples of expr:: Examples.
11103 @node String expressions
11104 @subsection String expressions
11106 @cindex string expressions
11107 @cindex expressions, string
11109 @command{expr} supports pattern matching and other string operators. These
11110 have higher precedence than both the numeric and relational operators (in
11111 the next sections).
11115 @item @var{string} : @var{regex}
11116 @cindex pattern matching
11117 @cindex regular expression matching
11118 @cindex matching patterns
11119 Perform pattern matching. The arguments are converted to strings and the
11120 second is considered to be a (basic, a la GNU @code{grep}) regular
11121 expression, with a @code{^} implicitly prepended. The first argument is
11122 then matched against this regular expression.
11124 If the match succeeds and @var{regex} uses @samp{\(} and @samp{\)}, the
11125 @code{:} expression returns the part of @var{string} that matched the
11126 subexpression; otherwise, it returns the number of characters matched.
11128 If the match fails, the @code{:} operator returns the null string if
11129 @samp{\(} and @samp{\)} are used in @var{regex}, otherwise 0.
11131 @kindex \( @r{regexp operator}
11132 Only the first @samp{\( @dots{} \)} pair is relevant to the return
11133 value; additional pairs are meaningful only for grouping the regular
11134 expression operators.
11136 @kindex \+ @r{regexp operator}
11137 @kindex \? @r{regexp operator}
11138 @kindex \| @r{regexp operator}
11139 In the regular expression, @code{\+}, @code{\?}, and @code{\|} are
11140 operators which respectively match one or more, zero or one, or separate
11141 alternatives. SunOS and other @command{expr}'s treat these as regular
11142 characters. (@acronym{POSIX} allows either behavior.)
11143 @xref{Top, , Regular Expression Library, regex, Regex}, for details of
11144 regular expression syntax. Some examples are in @ref{Examples of expr}.
11146 @item match @var{string} @var{regex}
11148 An alternative way to do pattern matching. This is the same as
11149 @w{@samp{@var{string} : @var{regex}}}.
11151 @item substr @var{string} @var{position} @var{length}
11153 Returns the substring of @var{string} beginning at @var{position}
11154 with length at most @var{length}. If either @var{position} or
11155 @var{length} is negative, zero, or non-numeric, returns the null string.
11157 @item index @var{string} @var{charset}
11159 Returns the first position in @var{string} where the first character in
11160 @var{charset} was found. If no character in @var{charset} is found in
11161 @var{string}, return 0.
11163 @item length @var{string}
11165 Returns the length of @var{string}.
11167 @item + @var{token}
11169 Interpret @var{token} as a string, even if it is a keyword like @var{match}
11170 or an operator like @code{/}.
11171 This makes it possible to test @code{expr length + "$x"} or
11172 @code{expr + "$x" : '.*/\(.\)'} and have it do the right thing even if
11173 the value of @var{$x} happens to be (for example) @code{/} or @code{index}.
11174 This operator is a @acronym{GNU} extension. Portable shell scripts should use
11175 @code{@w{" $token"} : @w{' \(.*\)'}} instead of @code{+ "$token"}.
11179 To make @command{expr} interpret keywords as strings, you must use the
11180 @code{quote} operator.
11183 @node Numeric expressions
11184 @subsection Numeric expressions
11186 @cindex numeric expressions
11187 @cindex expressions, numeric
11189 @command{expr} supports the usual numeric operators, in order of increasing
11190 precedence. These numeric operators have lower precedence than the
11191 string operators described in the previous section, and higher precedence
11192 than the connectives (next section).
11200 @cindex subtraction
11201 Addition and subtraction. Both arguments are converted to integers;
11202 an error occurs if this cannot be done.
11208 @cindex multiplication
11211 Multiplication, division, remainder. Both arguments are converted to
11212 integers; an error occurs if this cannot be done.
11217 @node Relations for expr
11218 @subsection Relations for @command{expr}
11220 @cindex connectives, logical
11221 @cindex logical connectives
11222 @cindex relations, numeric or string
11224 @command{expr} supports the usual logical connectives and relations. These
11225 have lower precedence than the string and numeric operators
11226 (previous sections). Here is the list, lowest-precedence operator first.
11232 @cindex logical or operator
11233 @cindex or operator
11234 Returns its first argument if that is neither null nor zero, otherwise
11235 its second argument if it is neither null nor zero, otherwise 0. It
11236 does not evaluate its second argument if its first argument is neither
11241 @cindex logical and operator
11242 @cindex and operator
11243 Return its first argument if neither argument is null or zero, otherwise
11244 0. It does not evaluate its second argument if its first argument is
11247 @item < <= = == != >= >
11254 @cindex comparison operators
11256 Compare the arguments and return 1 if the relation is true, 0 otherwise.
11257 @code{==} is a synonym for @code{=}. @command{expr} first tries to convert
11258 both arguments to integers and do a numeric comparison; if either
11259 conversion fails, it does a lexicographic comparison using the character
11260 collating sequence specified by the @env{LC_COLLATE} locale.
11265 @node Examples of expr
11266 @subsection Examples of using @command{expr}
11268 @cindex examples of @command{expr}
11269 Here are a few examples, including quoting for shell metacharacters.
11271 To add 1 to the shell variable @code{foo}, in Bourne-compatible shells:
11274 foo=`expr $foo + 1`
11277 To print the non-directory part of the file name stored in
11278 @code{$fname}, which need not contain a @code{/}:
11281 expr $fname : '.*/\(.*\)' '|' $fname
11284 An example showing that @code{\+} is an operator:
11292 expr abc : 'a\(.\)c'
11294 expr index abcdef cz
11297 @error{} expr: syntax error
11298 expr index quote index a
11304 @chapter Redirection
11306 @cindex redirection
11307 @cindex commands for redirection
11309 Unix shells commonly provide several forms of @dfn{redirection}---ways
11310 to change the input source or output destination of a command. But one
11311 useful redirection is performed by a separate command, not by the shell;
11312 it's described here.
11315 * tee invocation:: Redirect output to multiple files or processes.
11319 @node tee invocation
11320 @section @command{tee}: Redirect output to multiple files or processes
11323 @cindex pipe fitting
11324 @cindex destinations, multiple output
11325 @cindex read from stdin and write to stdout and files
11327 The @command{tee} command copies standard input to standard output and also
11328 to any files given as arguments. This is useful when you want not only
11329 to send some data down a pipe, but also to save a copy. Synopsis:
11332 tee [@var{option}]@dots{} [@var{file}]@dots{}
11335 If a file being written to does not already exist, it is created. If a
11336 file being written to already exists, the data it previously contained
11337 is overwritten unless the @option{-a} option is used.
11339 A @var{file} of @samp{-} causes @command{tee} to send another copy of
11340 input to standard output, but this is typically not that useful as the
11341 copies are interleaved.
11343 The program accepts the following options. Also see @ref{Common options}.
11350 Append standard input to the given files rather than overwriting
11354 @itemx --ignore-interrupts
11356 @opindex --ignore-interrupts
11357 Ignore interrupt signals.
11361 The @command{tee} command is useful when you happen to be transferring a large
11362 amount of data and also want to summarize that data without reading
11363 it a second time. For example, when you are downloading a DVD image,
11364 you often want to verify its signature or checksum right away.
11365 The inefficient way to do it is simply:
11368 wget http://example.com/some.iso && sha1sum some.iso
11371 One problem with the above is that it makes you wait for the
11372 download to complete before starting the time-consuming SHA1 computation.
11373 Perhaps even more importantly, the above requires reading
11374 the DVD image a second time (the first was from the network).
11376 The efficient way to do it is to interleave the download
11377 and SHA1 computation. Then, you'll get the checksum for
11378 free, because the entire process parallelizes so well:
11381 # slightly contrived, to demonstrate process substitution
11382 wget -O - http://example.com/dvd.iso \
11383 | tee >(sha1sum > dvd.sha1) > dvd.iso
11386 That makes @command{tee} write not just to the expected output file,
11387 but also to a pipe running @command{sha1sum} and saving the final
11388 checksum in a file named @file{dvd.sha1}.
11390 Note, however, that this example relies on a feature of modern shells
11391 called @dfn{process substitution}
11392 (the @samp{>(command)} syntax, above;
11393 @xref{Process Substitution,,Process Substitution, bashref,
11394 The Bash Reference Manual}.),
11395 so it works with @command{zsh}, @command{bash}, and @command{ksh},
11396 but not with @command{/bin/sh}. So if you write code like this
11397 in a shell script, be sure to start the script with @samp{#!/bin/bash}.
11399 Since the above example writes to one file and one process,
11400 a more conventional and portable use of @command{tee} is even better:
11403 wget -O - http://example.com/dvd.iso \
11404 | tee dvd.iso | sha1sum > dvd.sha1
11407 You can extend this example to make @command{tee} write to two processes,
11408 computing MD5 and SHA1 checksums in parallel. In this case,
11409 process substitution is required:
11412 wget -O - http://example.com/dvd.iso \
11413 | tee >(sha1sum > dvd.sha1) \
11414 >(md5sum > dvd.md5) \
11418 This technique is also useful when you want to make a @emph{compressed}
11419 copy of the contents of a pipe.
11420 Consider a tool to graphically summarize disk usage data from @samp{du -ak}.
11421 For a large hierarchy, @samp{du -ak} can run for a long time,
11422 and can easily produce terabytes of data, so you won't want to
11423 rerun the command unnecessarily. Nor will you want to save
11424 the uncompressed output.
11426 Doing it the inefficient way, you can't even start the GUI
11427 until after you've compressed all of the @command{du} output:
11430 du -ak | gzip -9 > /tmp/du.gz
11431 gzip -d /tmp/du.gz | xdiskusage -a
11434 With @command{tee} and process substitution, you start the GUI
11435 right away and eliminate the decompression completely:
11438 du -ak | tee >(gzip -9 > /tmp/du.gz) | xdiskusage -a
11441 Finally, if you regularly create more than one type of
11442 compressed tarball at once, for example when @code{make dist} creates
11443 both @command{gzip}-compressed and @command{bzip2}-compressed tarballs,
11444 there may be a better way.
11445 Typical @command{automake}-generated @file{Makefile} rules create
11446 the two compressed tar archives with commands in sequence, like this
11447 (slightly simplified):
11450 tardir=your-pkg-M.N
11451 tar chof - "$tardir" | gzip -9 -c > your-pkg-M.N.tar.gz
11452 tar chof - "$tardir" | bzip2 -9 -c > your-pkg-M.N.tar.bz2
11455 However, if the hierarchy you are archiving and compressing is larger
11456 than a couple megabytes, and especially if you are using a multi-processor
11457 system with plenty of memory, then you can do much better by reading the
11458 directory contents only once and running the compression programs in parallel:
11461 tardir=your-pkg-M.N
11462 tar chof - "$tardir" \
11463 | tee >(gzip -9 -c > your-pkg-M.N.tar.gz) \
11464 | bzip2 -9 -c > your-pkg-M.N.tar.bz2
11470 @node File name manipulation
11471 @chapter File name manipulation
11473 @cindex file name manipulation
11474 @cindex manipulation of file names
11475 @cindex commands for file name manipulation
11477 This section describes commands that manipulate file names.
11480 * basename invocation:: Strip directory and suffix from a file name.
11481 * dirname invocation:: Strip non-directory suffix from a file name.
11482 * pathchk invocation:: Check file name portability.
11486 @node basename invocation
11487 @section @command{basename}: Strip directory and suffix from a file name
11490 @cindex strip directory and suffix from file names
11491 @cindex directory, stripping from file names
11492 @cindex suffix, stripping from file names
11493 @cindex file names, stripping directory and suffix
11494 @cindex leading directory components, stripping
11496 @command{basename} removes any leading directory components from
11497 @var{name}. Synopsis:
11500 basename @var{name} [@var{suffix}]
11503 If @var{suffix} is specified and is identical to the end of @var{name},
11504 it is removed from @var{name} as well. Note that since trailing slashes
11505 are removed prior to suffix matching, @var{suffix} will do nothing if it
11506 contains slashes. @command{basename} prints the result on standard
11509 @c This test is used both here and in the section on dirname.
11510 @macro basenameAndDirname
11511 Together, @command{basename} and @command{dirname} are designed such
11512 that if @samp{ls "$name"} succeeds, then the command sequence @samp{cd
11513 "$(dirname "$name")"; ls "$(basename "$name")"} will, too. This works
11514 for everything except file names containing a trailing newline.
11516 @basenameAndDirname
11518 @acronym{POSIX} allows the implementation to define the results if
11519 @var{name} is empty or @samp{//}. In the former case, @acronym{GNU}
11520 @command{basename} returns the empty string. In the latter case, the
11521 result is @samp{//} on platforms where @var{//} is distinct from
11522 @var{/}, and @samp{/} on platforms where there is no difference.
11524 The only options are @option{--help} and @option{--version}. @xref{Common
11525 options}. Options must precede operands.
11533 basename /usr/bin/sort
11536 basename include/stdio.h .h
11540 @node dirname invocation
11541 @section @command{dirname}: Strip non-directory suffix from a file name
11544 @cindex directory components, printing
11545 @cindex stripping non-directory suffix
11546 @cindex non-directory suffix, stripping
11548 @command{dirname} prints all but the final slash-delimited component of
11549 a string (presumably a file name). Synopsis:
11555 If @var{name} is a single component, @command{dirname} prints @samp{.}
11556 (meaning the current directory).
11558 @basenameAndDirname
11560 @acronym{POSIX} allows the implementation to define the results if
11561 @var{name} is @samp{//}. With @acronym{GNU} @command{dirname}, the
11562 result is @samp{//} on platforms where @var{//} is distinct from
11563 @var{/}, and @samp{/} on platforms where there is no difference.
11565 The only options are @option{--help} and @option{--version}. @xref{Common
11573 # Output "/usr/bin".
11574 dirname /usr/bin/sort
11581 @node pathchk invocation
11582 @section @command{pathchk}: Check file name portability
11585 @cindex file names, checking validity and portability
11586 @cindex valid file names, checking for
11587 @cindex portable file names, checking for
11589 @command{pathchk} checks portability of file names. Synopsis:
11592 pathchk [@var{option}]@dots{} @var{name}@dots{}
11595 For each @var{name}, @command{pathchk} prints a message if any of
11596 these conditions is true:
11600 One of the existing directories in @var{name} does not have search
11601 (execute) permission,
11603 The length of @var{name} is larger than the maximum supported by the
11606 The length of one component of @var{name} is longer than
11607 its file system's maximum.
11610 A nonexistent @var{name} is not an error, so long a file with that
11611 name could be created under the above conditions.
11613 The program accepts the following options. Also see @ref{Common options}.
11614 Options must precede operands.
11620 Instead of performing checks based on the underlying file system,
11621 print a message if any of these conditions is true:
11625 A file name is empty.
11628 The length of a file name or one of its components exceeds the
11629 @acronym{POSIX} minimum limits for portability.
11632 A file name contains a character outside the portable file name
11633 character set, namely, the ASCII letters and digits, @samp{-},
11634 @samp{.}, @samp{/}, and @samp{_}.
11639 Print a message if a file name is empty, or if it contains a component
11640 that begins with @samp{-}.
11642 @item --portability
11643 @opindex --portability
11644 Print a message if a file name is not portable to all @acronym{POSIX}
11645 hosts. This option is equivalent to @samp{-p -P}.
11649 @cindex exit status of @command{pathchk}
11653 0 if all specified file names passed all checks,
11658 @node Working context
11659 @chapter Working context
11661 @cindex working context
11662 @cindex commands for printing the working context
11664 This section describes commands that display or alter the context in
11665 which you are working: the current directory, the terminal settings, and
11666 so forth. See also the user-related commands in the next section.
11669 * pwd invocation:: Print working directory.
11670 * stty invocation:: Print or change terminal characteristics.
11671 * printenv invocation:: Print environment variables.
11672 * tty invocation:: Print file name of terminal on standard input.
11676 @node pwd invocation
11677 @section @command{pwd}: Print working directory
11680 @cindex print name of current directory
11681 @cindex current working directory, printing
11682 @cindex working directory, printing
11684 @cindex symbolic links and @command{pwd}
11685 @command{pwd} prints the fully resolved name of the current directory.
11686 That is, all components of the printed name will be actual directory
11687 names---none will be symbolic links.
11689 @cindex conflicts with shell built-ins
11690 @cindex built-in shell commands, conflicts with
11691 Because most shells have a built-in @command{pwd} command, using an
11692 unadorned @command{pwd} in a script or interactively may get you
11693 different functionality than that described here.
11695 The only options are a lone @option{--help} or
11696 @option{--version}. @xref{Common options}.
11701 @node stty invocation
11702 @section @command{stty}: Print or change terminal characteristics
11705 @cindex change or print terminal settings
11706 @cindex terminal settings
11707 @cindex line settings of terminal
11709 @command{stty} prints or changes terminal characteristics, such as baud rate.
11713 stty [@var{option}] [@var{setting}]@dots{}
11714 stty [@var{option}]
11717 If given no line settings, @command{stty} prints the baud rate, line
11718 discipline number (on systems that support it), and line settings
11719 that have been changed from the values set by @samp{stty sane}.
11720 By default, mode reading and setting are performed on the tty line
11721 connected to standard input, although this can be modified by the
11722 @option{--file} option.
11724 @command{stty} accepts many non-option arguments that change aspects of
11725 the terminal line operation, as described below.
11727 The program accepts the following options. Also see @ref{Common options}.
11734 Print all current settings in human-readable form. This option may not
11735 be used in combination with any line settings.
11737 @item -F @var{device}
11738 @itemx --file=@var{device}
11741 Set the line opened by the file name specified in @var{device} instead of
11742 the tty line connected to standard input. This option is necessary
11743 because opening a @acronym{POSIX} tty requires use of the @code{O_NONDELAY} flag to
11744 prevent a @acronym{POSIX} tty from blocking until the carrier detect line is high if
11745 the @code{clocal} flag is not set. Hence, it is not always possible
11746 to allow the shell to open the device in the traditional manner.
11752 @cindex machine-readable @command{stty} output
11753 Print all current settings in a form that can be used as an argument to
11754 another @command{stty} command to restore the current settings. This option
11755 may not be used in combination with any line settings.
11759 Many settings can be turned off by preceding them with a @samp{-}.
11760 Such arguments are marked below with ``May be negated'' in their
11761 description. The descriptions themselves refer to the positive
11762 case, that is, when @emph{not} negated (unless stated otherwise,
11765 Some settings are not available on all @acronym{POSIX} systems, since they use
11766 extensions. Such arguments are marked below with ``Non-@acronym{POSIX}'' in their
11767 description. On non-@acronym{POSIX} systems, those or other settings also may not
11768 be available, but it's not feasible to document all the variations: just
11774 * Control:: Control settings
11775 * Input:: Input settings
11776 * Output:: Output settings
11777 * Local:: Local settings
11778 * Combination:: Combination settings
11779 * Characters:: Special characters
11780 * Special:: Special settings
11785 @subsection Control settings
11787 @cindex control settings
11793 @cindex two-way parity
11794 Generate parity bit in output and expect parity bit in input.
11800 @cindex even parity
11801 Set odd parity (even if negated). May be negated.
11808 @cindex character size
11809 @cindex eight-bit characters
11810 Set character size to 5, 6, 7, or 8 bits.
11815 Send a hangup signal when the last process closes the tty. May be
11821 Use two stop bits per character (one if negated). May be negated.
11825 Allow input to be received. May be negated.
11829 @cindex modem control
11830 Disable modem control signals. May be negated.
11834 @cindex hardware flow control
11835 @cindex flow control, hardware
11836 @cindex RTS/CTS flow control
11837 Enable RTS/CTS flow control. Non-@acronym{POSIX}. May be negated.
11842 @subsection Input settings
11844 @cindex input settings
11849 @cindex breaks, ignoring
11850 Ignore break characters. May be negated.
11854 @cindex breaks, cause interrupts
11855 Make breaks cause an interrupt signal. May be negated.
11859 @cindex parity, ignoring
11860 Ignore characters with parity errors. May be negated.
11864 @cindex parity errors, marking
11865 Mark parity errors (with a 255-0-character sequence). May be negated.
11869 Enable input parity checking. May be negated.
11873 @cindex eight-bit input
11874 Clear high (8th) bit of input characters. May be negated.
11878 @cindex newline, translating to return
11879 Translate newline to carriage return. May be negated.
11883 @cindex return, ignoring
11884 Ignore carriage return. May be negated.
11888 @cindex return, translating to newline
11889 Translate carriage return to newline. May be negated.
11893 @cindex input encoding, UTF-8
11894 Assume input characters are UTF-8 encoded. May be negated.
11898 @kindex C-s/C-q flow control
11899 @cindex XON/XOFF flow control
11900 Enable XON/XOFF flow control (that is, @kbd{CTRL-S}/@kbd{CTRL-Q}). May
11907 @cindex software flow control
11908 @cindex flow control, software
11909 Enable sending of @code{stop} character when the system input buffer
11910 is almost full, and @code{start} character when it becomes almost
11911 empty again. May be negated.
11915 @cindex uppercase, translating to lowercase
11916 Translate uppercase characters to lowercase. Non-@acronym{POSIX}. May be
11921 Allow any character to restart output (only the start character
11922 if negated). Non-@acronym{POSIX}. May be negated.
11926 @cindex beeping at input buffer full
11927 Enable beeping and not flushing input buffer if a character arrives
11928 when the input buffer is full. Non-@acronym{POSIX}. May be negated.
11933 @subsection Output settings
11935 @cindex output settings
11936 These arguments specify output-related operations.
11941 Postprocess output. May be negated.
11945 @cindex lowercase, translating to output
11946 Translate lowercase characters to uppercase. Non-@acronym{POSIX}. May be
11951 @cindex return, translating to newline
11952 Translate carriage return to newline. Non-@acronym{POSIX}. May be negated.
11956 @cindex newline, translating to crlf
11957 Translate newline to carriage return-newline. Non-@acronym{POSIX}. May be
11962 Do not print carriage returns in the first column. Non-@acronym{POSIX}.
11967 Newline performs a carriage return. Non-@acronym{POSIX}. May be negated.
11971 @cindex pad instead of timing for delaying
11972 Use fill (padding) characters instead of timing for delays. Non-@acronym{POSIX}.
11977 @cindex pad character
11978 Use delete characters for fill instead of null characters. Non-@acronym{POSIX}.
11984 Newline delay style. Non-@acronym{POSIX}.
11991 Carriage return delay style. Non-@acronym{POSIX}.
11997 @opindex tab@var{n}
11998 Horizontal tab delay style. Non-@acronym{POSIX}.
12003 Backspace delay style. Non-@acronym{POSIX}.
12008 Vertical tab delay style. Non-@acronym{POSIX}.
12013 Form feed delay style. Non-@acronym{POSIX}.
12018 @subsection Local settings
12020 @cindex local settings
12025 Enable @code{interrupt}, @code{quit}, and @code{suspend} special
12026 characters. May be negated.
12030 Enable @code{erase}, @code{kill}, @code{werase}, and @code{rprnt}
12031 special characters. May be negated.
12035 Enable non-@acronym{POSIX} special characters. May be negated.
12039 Echo input characters. May be negated.
12045 Echo @code{erase} characters as backspace-space-backspace. May be
12050 @cindex newline echoing after @code{kill}
12051 Echo a newline after a @code{kill} character. May be negated.
12055 @cindex newline, echoing
12056 Echo newline even if not echoing other characters. May be negated.
12060 @cindex flushing, disabling
12061 Disable flushing after @code{interrupt} and @code{quit} special
12062 characters. May be negated.
12066 @cindex case translation
12067 Enable input and output of uppercase characters by preceding their
12068 lowercase equivalents with @samp{\}, when @code{icanon} is set.
12069 Non-@acronym{POSIX}. May be negated.
12073 @cindex background jobs, stopping at terminal write
12074 Stop background jobs that try to write to the terminal. Non-@acronym{POSIX}.
12081 Echo erased characters backward, between @samp{\} and @samp{/}.
12082 Non-@acronym{POSIX}. May be negated.
12088 @cindex control characters, using @samp{^@var{c}}
12089 @cindex hat notation for control characters
12090 Echo control characters in hat notation (@samp{^@var{c}}) instead
12091 of literally. Non-@acronym{POSIX}. May be negated.
12097 Echo the @code{kill} special character by erasing each character on
12098 the line as indicated by the @code{echoprt} and @code{echoe} settings,
12099 instead of by the @code{echoctl} and @code{echok} settings. Non-@acronym{POSIX}.
12105 @subsection Combination settings
12107 @cindex combination settings
12108 Combination settings:
12115 Same as @code{parenb -parodd cs7}. May be negated. If negated, same
12116 as @code{-parenb cs8}.
12120 Same as @code{parenb parodd cs7}. May be negated. If negated, same
12121 as @code{-parenb cs8}.
12125 Same as @code{-icrnl -onlcr}. May be negated. If negated, same as
12126 @code{icrnl -inlcr -igncr onlcr -ocrnl -onlret}.
12130 Reset the @code{erase} and @code{kill} special characters to their default
12137 @c This is too long to write inline.
12139 cread -ignbrk brkint -inlcr -igncr icrnl -ixoff
12140 -iuclc -ixany imaxbel opost -olcuc -ocrnl onlcr
12141 -onocr -onlret -ofill -ofdel nl0 cr0 tab0 bs0 vt0
12142 ff0 isig icanon iexten echo echoe echok -echonl
12143 -noflsh -xcase -tostop -echoprt echoctl echoke
12147 and also sets all special characters to their default values.
12151 Same as @code{brkint ignpar istrip icrnl ixon opost isig icanon}, plus
12152 sets the @code{eof} and @code{eol} characters to their default values
12153 if they are the same as the @code{min} and @code{time} characters.
12154 May be negated. If negated, same as @code{raw}.
12161 -ignbrk -brkint -ignpar -parmrk -inpck -istrip
12162 -inlcr -igncr -icrnl -ixon -ixoff -iuclc -ixany
12163 -imaxbel -opost -isig -icanon -xcase min 1 time 0
12167 May be negated. If negated, same as @code{cooked}.
12171 Same as @option{-icanon}. May be negated. If negated, same as
12176 @cindex eight-bit characters
12177 Same as @code{-parenb -istrip cs8}. May be negated. If negated,
12178 same as @code{parenb istrip cs7}.
12182 Same as @option{-parenb -istrip -opost cs8}. May be negated.
12183 If negated, same as @code{parenb istrip opost cs7}.
12187 Same as @option{-ixany}. Non-@acronym{POSIX}. May be negated.
12191 Same as @code{tab0}. Non-@acronym{POSIX}. May be negated. If negated, same
12198 Same as @code{xcase iuclc olcuc}. Non-@acronym{POSIX}. May be negated.
12202 Same as @code{echoe echoctl echoke}.
12206 Same as @code{echoe echoctl echoke -ixany intr ^C erase ^? kill C-u}.
12211 @subsection Special characters
12213 @cindex special characters
12214 @cindex characters, special
12216 The special characters' default values vary from system to system.
12217 They are set with the syntax @samp{name value}, where the names are
12218 listed below and the value can be given either literally, in hat
12219 notation (@samp{^@var{c}}), or as an integer which may start with
12220 @samp{0x} to indicate hexadecimal, @samp{0} to indicate octal, or
12221 any other digit to indicate decimal.
12223 @cindex disabling special characters
12224 @kindex u@r{, and disabling special characters}
12225 For GNU stty, giving a value of @code{^-} or @code{undef} disables that
12226 special character. (This is incompatible with Ultrix @command{stty},
12227 which uses a value of @samp{u} to disable a special character. GNU
12228 @command{stty} treats a value @samp{u} like any other, namely to set that
12229 special character to @key{U}.)
12235 Send an interrupt signal.
12239 Send a quit signal.
12243 Erase the last character typed.
12247 Erase the current line.
12251 Send an end of file (terminate the input).
12259 Alternate character to end the line. Non-@acronym{POSIX}.
12263 Switch to a different shell layer. Non-@acronym{POSIX}.
12267 Restart the output after stopping it.
12275 Send a terminal stop signal.
12279 Send a terminal stop signal after flushing the input. Non-@acronym{POSIX}.
12283 Redraw the current line. Non-@acronym{POSIX}.
12287 Erase the last word typed. Non-@acronym{POSIX}.
12291 Enter the next character typed literally, even if it is a special
12292 character. Non-@acronym{POSIX}.
12297 @subsection Special settings
12299 @cindex special settings
12304 Set the minimum number of characters that will satisfy a read until
12305 the time value has expired, when @option{-icanon} is set.
12309 Set the number of tenths of a second before reads time out if the minimum
12310 number of characters have not been read, when @option{-icanon} is set.
12312 @item ispeed @var{n}
12314 Set the input speed to @var{n}.
12316 @item ospeed @var{n}
12318 Set the output speed to @var{n}.
12322 Tell the tty kernel driver that the terminal has @var{n} rows. Non-@acronym{POSIX}.
12325 @itemx columns @var{n}
12328 Tell the kernel that the terminal has @var{n} columns. Non-@acronym{POSIX}.
12334 Print the number of rows and columns that the kernel thinks the
12335 terminal has. (Systems that don't support rows and columns in the kernel
12336 typically use the environment variables @env{LINES} and @env{COLUMNS}
12337 instead; however, GNU @command{stty} does not know anything about them.)
12338 Non-@acronym{POSIX}.
12342 Use line discipline @var{n}. Non-@acronym{POSIX}.
12346 Print the terminal speed.
12349 @cindex baud rate, setting
12350 @c FIXME: Is this still true that the baud rate can't be set
12351 @c higher than 38400?
12352 Set the input and output speeds to @var{n}. @var{n} can be one
12353 of: 0 50 75 110 134 134.5 150 200 300 600 1200 1800 2400 4800 9600
12354 19200 38400 @code{exta} @code{extb}. @code{exta} is the same as
12355 19200; @code{extb} is the same as 38400. 0 hangs up the line if
12356 @option{-clocal} is set.
12360 @node printenv invocation
12361 @section @command{printenv}: Print all or some environment variables
12364 @cindex printing all or some environment variables
12365 @cindex environment variables, printing
12367 @command{printenv} prints environment variable values. Synopsis:
12370 printenv [@var{option}] [@var{variable}]@dots{}
12373 If no @var{variable}s are specified, @command{printenv} prints the value of
12374 every environment variable. Otherwise, it prints the value of each
12375 @var{variable} that is set, and nothing for those that are not set.
12377 The only options are a lone @option{--help} or @option{--version}.
12378 @xref{Common options}.
12380 @cindex exit status of @command{printenv}
12384 0 if all variables specified were found
12385 1 if at least one specified variable was not found
12386 2 if a write error occurred
12390 @node tty invocation
12391 @section @command{tty}: Print file name of terminal on standard input
12394 @cindex print terminal file name
12395 @cindex terminal file name, printing
12397 @command{tty} prints the file name of the terminal connected to its standard
12398 input. It prints @samp{not a tty} if standard input is not a terminal.
12402 tty [@var{option}]@dots{}
12405 The program accepts the following option. Also see @ref{Common options}.
12415 Print nothing; only return an exit status.
12419 @cindex exit status of @command{tty}
12423 0 if standard input is a terminal
12424 1 if standard input is not a terminal
12425 2 if given incorrect arguments
12426 3 if a write error occurs
12430 @node User information
12431 @chapter User information
12433 @cindex user information, commands for
12434 @cindex commands for printing user information
12436 This section describes commands that print user-related information:
12437 logins, groups, and so forth.
12440 * id invocation:: Print user identity.
12441 * logname invocation:: Print current login name.
12442 * whoami invocation:: Print effective user ID.
12443 * groups invocation:: Print group names a user is in.
12444 * users invocation:: Print login names of users currently logged in.
12445 * who invocation:: Print who is currently logged in.
12449 @node id invocation
12450 @section @command{id}: Print user identity
12453 @cindex real user and group IDs, printing
12454 @cindex effective user and group IDs, printing
12455 @cindex printing real and effective user and group IDs
12457 @command{id} prints information about the given user, or the process
12458 running it if no user is specified. Synopsis:
12461 id [@var{option}]@dots{} [@var{username}]
12464 By default, it prints the real user ID, real group ID, effective user ID
12465 if different from the real user ID, effective group ID if different from
12466 the real group ID, and supplemental group IDs.
12468 Each of these numeric values is preceded by an identifying string and
12469 followed by the corresponding user or group name in parentheses.
12471 The options cause @command{id} to print only part of the above information.
12472 Also see @ref{Common options}.
12479 Print only the group ID.
12485 Print only the group ID and the supplementary groups.
12491 Print the user or group name instead of the ID number. Requires
12492 @option{-u}, @option{-g}, or @option{-G}.
12498 Print the real, instead of effective, user or group ID. Requires
12499 @option{-u}, @option{-g}, or @option{-G}.
12505 Print only the user ID.
12511 @macro primaryAndSupplementaryGroups{cmd,arg}
12512 Primary and supplementary groups for a process are normally inherited
12513 from its parent and are usually unchanged since login. This means
12514 that if you change the group database after logging in, @command{\cmd\}
12515 will not reflect your changes within your existing login session.
12516 Running @command{\cmd\} with a \arg\ causes the user and group
12517 database to be consulted afresh, and so will give a different result.
12519 @primaryAndSupplementaryGroups{id,user argument}
12521 @node logname invocation
12522 @section @command{logname}: Print current login name
12525 @cindex printing user's login name
12526 @cindex login name, printing
12527 @cindex user name, printing
12530 @command{logname} prints the calling user's name, as found in a
12531 system-maintained file (often @file{/var/run/utmp} or
12532 @file{/etc/utmp}), and exits with a status of 0. If there is no entry
12533 for the calling process, @command{logname} prints
12534 an error message and exits with a status of 1.
12536 The only options are @option{--help} and @option{--version}. @xref{Common
12542 @node whoami invocation
12543 @section @command{whoami}: Print effective user ID
12546 @cindex effective user ID, printing
12547 @cindex printing the effective user ID
12549 @command{whoami} prints the user name associated with the current
12550 effective user ID. It is equivalent to the command @samp{id -un}.
12552 The only options are @option{--help} and @option{--version}. @xref{Common
12558 @node groups invocation
12559 @section @command{groups}: Print group names a user is in
12562 @cindex printing groups a user is in
12563 @cindex supplementary groups, printing
12565 @command{groups} prints the names of the primary and any supplementary
12566 groups for each given @var{username}, or the current process if no names
12567 are given. If more than one name is given, the name of each user is
12569 the list of that user's groups and the user name is separated from the
12570 group list by a colon. Synopsis:
12573 groups [@var{username}]@dots{}
12576 The group lists are equivalent to the output of the command @samp{id -Gn}.
12578 @primaryAndSupplementaryGroups{groups,list of users}
12580 The only options are @option{--help} and @option{--version}. @xref{Common
12586 @node users invocation
12587 @section @command{users}: Print login names of users currently logged in
12590 @cindex printing current usernames
12591 @cindex usernames, printing current
12593 @cindex login sessions, printing users with
12594 @command{users} prints on a single line a blank-separated list of user
12595 names of users currently logged in to the current host. Each user name
12596 corresponds to a login session, so if a user has more than one login
12597 session, that user's name will appear the same number of times in the
12606 With no @var{file} argument, @command{users} extracts its information from
12607 a system-maintained file (often @file{/var/run/utmp} or
12608 @file{/etc/utmp}). If a file argument is given, @command{users} uses
12609 that file instead. A common choice is @file{/var/log/wtmp}.
12611 The only options are @option{--help} and @option{--version}. @xref{Common
12617 @node who invocation
12618 @section @command{who}: Print who is currently logged in
12621 @cindex printing current user information
12622 @cindex information, about current users
12624 @command{who} prints information about users who are currently logged on.
12628 @command{who} [@var{option}] [@var{file}] [am i]
12631 @cindex terminal lines, currently used
12633 @cindex remote hostname
12634 If given no non-option arguments, @command{who} prints the following
12635 information for each user currently logged on: login name, terminal
12636 line, login time, and remote hostname or X display.
12640 If given one non-option argument, @command{who} uses that instead of
12641 a default system-maintained file (often @file{/var/run/utmp} or
12642 @file{/etc/utmp}) as the name of the file containing the record of
12643 users logged on. @file{/var/log/wtmp} is commonly given as an argument
12644 to @command{who} to look at who has previously logged on.
12648 If given two non-option arguments, @command{who} prints only the entry
12649 for the user running it (determined from its standard input), preceded
12650 by the hostname. Traditionally, the two arguments given are @samp{am
12651 i}, as in @samp{who am i}.
12654 Time stamps are listed according to the time zone rules specified by
12655 the @env{TZ} environment variable, or by the system default rules if
12656 @env{TZ} is not set. @xref{TZ Variable,, Specifying the Time Zone
12657 with @env{TZ}, libc, The GNU C Library Reference Manual}.
12659 The program accepts the following options. Also see @ref{Common options}.
12667 Same as @samp{-b -d --login -p -r -t -T -u}.
12673 Print the date and time of last system boot.
12679 Print information corresponding to dead processes.
12685 Print column headings.
12689 Same as @samp{who am i}.
12695 Print only the login names and the number of users logged on.
12696 Overrides all other options.
12700 Ignored; for compatibility with other versions of @command{who}.
12705 After the login time, print the number of hours and minutes that the
12706 user has been idle. @samp{.} means the user was active in the last minute.
12707 @samp{old} means the user has been idle for more than 24 hours.
12713 List only the entries that correspond to processes via which the
12714 system is waiting for a user to login. The user name is always @samp{LOGIN}.
12718 Attempt to canonicalize hostnames found in utmp through a DNS lookup. This
12719 is not the default because it can cause significant delays on systems with
12720 automatic dial-up internet access.
12726 Print a line of column headings.
12732 List active processes spawned by init.
12737 @opindex --runlevel
12738 Print the current (and maybe previous) run-level of the init process.
12744 Print last system clock change.
12755 @opindex --writable
12756 @cindex message status
12757 @pindex write@r{, allowed}
12758 After each login name print a character indicating the user's message status:
12761 @samp{+} allowing @code{write} messages
12762 @samp{-} disallowing @code{write} messages
12763 @samp{?} cannot find terminal device
12771 @node System context
12772 @chapter System context
12774 @cindex system context
12775 @cindex context, system
12776 @cindex commands for system context
12778 This section describes commands that print or change system-wide
12782 * arch invocation:: Print machine hardware name.
12783 * date invocation:: Print or set system date and time.
12784 * uname invocation:: Print system information.
12785 * hostname invocation:: Print or set system name.
12786 * hostid invocation:: Print numeric host identifier.
12790 @node date invocation
12791 @section @command{date}: Print or set system date and time
12794 @cindex time, printing or setting
12795 @cindex printing the current time
12800 date [@var{option}]@dots{} [+@var{format}]
12801 date [-u|--utc|--universal] @c this avoids a newline in the output
12802 [ MMDDhhmm[[CC]YY][.ss] ]
12806 Invoking @command{date} with no @var{format} argument is equivalent to invoking
12807 it with a default format that depends on the @env{LC_TIME} locale category.
12808 In the default C locale, this format is @samp{'+%a %b %e %H:%M:%S %Z %Y'},
12809 so the output looks like @samp{Thu Mar @ 3 13:47:51 PST 2005}.
12812 Normally, @command{date} uses the time zone rules indicated by the
12813 @env{TZ} environment variable, or the system default rules if @env{TZ}
12814 is not set. @xref{TZ Variable,, Specifying the Time Zone with
12815 @env{TZ}, libc, The GNU C Library Reference Manual}.
12817 @findex strftime @r{and @command{date}}
12818 @cindex time formats
12819 @cindex formatting times
12820 If given an argument that starts with a @samp{+}, @command{date} prints the
12821 current date and time (or the date and time specified by the
12822 @option{--date} option, see below) in the format defined by that argument,
12823 which is similar to that of the @code{strftime} function. Except for
12824 conversion specifiers, which start with @samp{%}, characters in the
12825 format string are printed unchanged. The conversion specifiers are
12831 * Time conversion specifiers:: %[HIklMNpPrRsSTXzZ]
12832 * Date conversion specifiers:: %[aAbBcCdDeFgGhjmuUVwWxyY]
12833 * Literal conversion specifiers:: %[%nt]
12834 * Padding and other flags:: Pad with zeros, spaces, etc.
12835 * Setting the time:: Changing the system clock.
12836 * Options for date:: Instead of the current time.
12838 * Date input formats:: Specifying date strings.
12840 * Examples of date:: Examples.
12843 @node Time conversion specifiers
12844 @subsection Time conversion specifiers
12846 @cindex time conversion specifiers
12847 @cindex conversion specifiers, time
12849 @command{date} conversion specifiers related to times.
12853 hour (@samp{00}@dots{}@samp{23})
12855 hour (@samp{01}@dots{}@samp{12})
12857 hour (@samp{ 0}@dots{}@samp{23}).
12858 This is a @acronym{GNU} extension.
12860 hour (@samp{ 1}@dots{}@samp{12}).
12861 This is a @acronym{GNU} extension.
12863 minute (@samp{00}@dots{}@samp{59})
12865 nanoseconds (@samp{000000000}@dots{}@samp{999999999}).
12866 This is a @acronym{GNU} extension.
12868 locale's equivalent of either @samp{AM} or @samp{PM};
12869 blank in many locales.
12870 Noon is treated as @samp{PM} and midnight as @samp{AM}.
12872 like @samp{%p}, except lower case.
12873 This is a @acronym{GNU} extension.
12875 locale's 12-hour clock time (e.g., @samp{11:11:04 PM})
12877 24-hour hour and minute. Same as @samp{%H:%M}.
12878 This is a @acronym{GNU} extension.
12880 @cindex epoch, seconds since
12881 @cindex seconds since the epoch
12882 @cindex beginning of time
12883 seconds since the epoch, i.e., since 1970-01-01 00:00:00 UTC.
12884 Leap seconds are not counted unless leap second support is available.
12885 @xref{%s-examples}, for examples.
12886 This is a @acronym{GNU} extension.
12888 second (@samp{00}@dots{}@samp{60}).
12889 This may be @samp{60} if leap seconds are supported.
12891 24-hour hour, minute, and second. Same as @samp{%H:%M:%S}.
12893 locale's time representation (e.g., @samp{23:13:48})
12895 @w{@acronym{RFC} 2822/@acronym{ISO} 8601} style numeric time zone
12896 (e.g., @samp{-0600} or @samp{+0530}), or nothing if no
12897 time zone is determinable. This value reflects the numeric time zone
12898 appropriate for the current time, using the time zone rules specified
12899 by the @env{TZ} environment variable.
12900 The time (and optionally, the time zone rules) can be overridden
12901 by the @option{--date} option.
12902 This is a @acronym{GNU} extension.
12904 @w{@acronym{RFC} 3339/@acronym{ISO} 8601} style numeric time zone with
12905 @samp{:} (e.g., @samp{-06:00} or @samp{+05:30}), or nothing if no time
12906 zone is determinable.
12907 This is a @acronym{GNU} extension.
12909 Numeric time zone to the nearest second with @samp{:} (e.g.,
12910 @samp{-06:00:00} or @samp{+05:30:00}), or nothing if no time zone is
12912 This is a @acronym{GNU} extension.
12914 Numeric time zone with @samp{:} using the minimum necessary precision
12915 (e.g., @samp{-06}, @samp{+05:30}, or @samp{-04:56:02}), or nothing if
12916 no time zone is determinable.
12917 This is a @acronym{GNU} extension.
12919 alphabetic time zone abbreviation (e.g., @samp{EDT}), or nothing if no
12920 time zone is determinable. See @samp{%z} for how it is determined.
12924 @node Date conversion specifiers
12925 @subsection Date conversion specifiers
12927 @cindex date conversion specifiers
12928 @cindex conversion specifiers, date
12930 @command{date} conversion specifiers related to dates.
12934 locale's abbreviated weekday name (e.g., @samp{Sun})
12936 locale's full weekday name, variable length (e.g., @samp{Sunday})
12938 locale's abbreviated month name (e.g., @samp{Jan})
12940 locale's full month name, variable length (e.g., @samp{January})
12942 locale's date and time (e.g., @samp{Thu Mar @ 3 23:05:25 2005})
12944 century. This is like @samp{%Y}, except the last two digits are omitted.
12945 For example, it is @samp{20} if @samp{%Y} is @samp{2000},
12946 and is @samp{-0} if @samp{%Y} is @samp{-001}.
12947 It is normally at least two characters, but it may be more.
12949 day of month (e.g., @samp{01})
12951 date; same as @samp{%m/%d/%y}
12953 day of month, space padded; same as @samp{%_d}
12955 full date in @acronym{ISO} 8601 format; same as @samp{%Y-%m-%d}.
12956 This is a good choice for a date format, as it is standard and
12957 is easy to sort in the usual case where years are in the range
12959 This is a @acronym{GNU} extension.
12961 year corresponding to the @acronym{ISO} week number, but without the century
12962 (range @samp{00} through @samp{99}). This has the same format and value
12963 as @samp{%y}, except that if the @acronym{ISO} week number (see
12965 to the previous or next year, that year is used instead.
12966 This is a @acronym{GNU} extension.
12968 year corresponding to the @acronym{ISO} week number. This has the
12969 same format and value as @samp{%Y}, except that if the @acronym{ISO}
12971 @samp{%V}) belongs to the previous or next year, that year is used
12973 It is normally useful only if @samp{%V} is also used;
12974 for example, the format @samp{%G-%m-%d} is probably a mistake,
12975 since it combines the ISO week number year with the conventional month and day.
12976 This is a @acronym{GNU} extension.
12980 day of year (@samp{001}@dots{}@samp{366})
12982 month (@samp{01}@dots{}@samp{12})
12984 day of week (@samp{1}@dots{}@samp{7}) with @samp{1} corresponding to Monday
12986 week number of year, with Sunday as the first day of the week
12987 (@samp{00}@dots{}@samp{53}).
12988 Days in a new year preceding the first Sunday are in week zero.
12990 @acronym{ISO} week number, that is, the
12991 week number of year, with Monday as the first day of the week
12992 (@samp{01}@dots{}@samp{53}).
12993 If the week containing January 1 has four or more days in
12994 the new year, then it is considered week 1; otherwise, it is week 53 of
12995 the previous year, and the next week is week 1. (See the @acronym{ISO} 8601
12998 day of week (@samp{0}@dots{}@samp{6}) with 0 corresponding to Sunday
13000 week number of year, with Monday as first day of week
13001 (@samp{00}@dots{}@samp{53}).
13002 Days in a new year preceding the first Monday are in week zero.
13004 locale's date representation (e.g., @samp{12/31/99})
13006 last two digits of year (@samp{00}@dots{}@samp{99})
13008 year. This is normally at least four characters, but it may be more.
13009 Year @samp{0000} precedes year @samp{0001}, and year @samp{-001}
13010 precedes year @samp{0000}.
13014 @node Literal conversion specifiers
13015 @subsection Literal conversion specifiers
13017 @cindex literal conversion specifiers
13018 @cindex conversion specifiers, literal
13020 @command{date} conversion specifiers that produce literal strings.
13032 @node Padding and other flags
13033 @subsection Padding and other flags
13035 @cindex numeric field padding
13036 @cindex padding of numeric fields
13037 @cindex fields, padding numeric
13039 Unless otherwise specified, @command{date} normally pads numeric fields
13040 with zeros, so that, for
13041 example, numeric months are always output as two digits.
13042 Seconds since the epoch are not padded, though,
13043 since there is no natural width for them.
13045 As a @acronym{GNU} extension, @command{date} recognizes any of the
13046 following optional flags after the @samp{%}:
13050 (hyphen) Do not pad the field; useful if the output is intended for
13053 (underscore) Pad with spaces; useful if you need a fixed
13054 number of characters in the output, but zeros are too distracting.
13056 (zero) Pad with zeros even if the conversion specifier
13057 would normally pad with spaces.
13059 Use upper case characters if possible.
13061 Use opposite case characters if possible.
13062 A field that is normally upper case becomes lower case, and vice versa.
13066 Here are some examples of padding:
13069 date +%d/%m -d "Feb 1"
13071 date +%-d/%-m -d "Feb 1"
13073 date +%_d/%_m -d "Feb 1"
13077 As a @acronym{GNU} extension, you can specify the field width
13078 (after any flag, if present) as a decimal number. If the natural size of the
13079 output is of the field has less than the specified number of characters,
13080 the result is written right adjusted and padded to the given
13081 size. For example, @samp{%9B} prints the right adjusted month name in
13082 a field of width 9.
13084 An optional modifier can follow the optional flag and width
13085 specification. The modifiers are:
13089 Use the locale's alternate representation for date and time. This
13090 modifier applies to the @samp{%c}, @samp{%C}, @samp{%x}, @samp{%X},
13091 @samp{%y} and @samp{%Y} conversion specifiers. In a Japanese locale, for
13092 example, @samp{%Ex} might yield a date format based on the Japanese
13096 Use the locale's alternate numeric symbols for numbers. This modifier
13097 applies only to numeric conversion specifiers.
13100 If the format supports the modifier but no alternate representation
13101 is available, it is ignored.
13104 @node Setting the time
13105 @subsection Setting the time
13107 @cindex setting the time
13108 @cindex time setting
13109 @cindex appropriate privileges
13111 If given an argument that does not start with @samp{+}, @command{date} sets
13112 the system clock to the date and time specified by that argument (as
13113 described below). You must have appropriate privileges to set the
13114 system clock. The @option{--date} and @option{--set} options may not be
13115 used with such an argument. The @option{--universal} option may be used
13116 with such an argument to indicate that the specified date and time are
13117 relative to Coordinated Universal Time rather than to the local time
13120 The argument must consist entirely of digits, which have the following
13133 first two digits of year (optional)
13135 last two digits of year (optional)
13140 The @option{--set} option also sets the system clock; see the next section.
13143 @node Options for date
13144 @subsection Options for @command{date}
13146 @cindex @command{date} options
13147 @cindex options for @command{date}
13149 The program accepts the following options. Also see @ref{Common options}.
13153 @item -d @var{datestr}
13154 @itemx --date=@var{datestr}
13157 @cindex parsing date strings
13158 @cindex date strings, parsing
13159 @cindex arbitrary date strings, parsing
13162 @opindex next @var{day}
13163 @opindex last @var{day}
13164 Display the date and time specified in @var{datestr} instead of the
13165 current date and time. @var{datestr} can be in almost any common
13166 format. It can contain month names, time zones, @samp{am} and @samp{pm},
13167 @samp{yesterday}, etc. For example, @option{--date="2004-02-27
13168 14:19:13.489392193 +0530"} specifies the instant of time that is
13169 489,392,193 nanoseconds after February 27, 2004 at 2:19:13 PM in a
13170 time zone that is 5 hours and 30 minutes east of @acronym{UTC}.@*
13171 @xref{Date input formats}.
13173 @item -f @var{datefile}
13174 @itemx --file=@var{datefile}
13177 Parse each line in @var{datefile} as with @option{-d} and display the
13178 resulting date and time. If @var{datefile} is @samp{-}, use standard
13179 input. This is useful when you have many dates to process, because the
13180 system overhead of starting up the @command{date} executable many times can
13183 @item -r @var{file}
13184 @itemx --reference=@var{file}
13186 @opindex --reference
13187 Display the date and time of the last modification of @var{file},
13188 instead of the current date and time.
13195 @opindex --rfc-2822
13196 Display the date and time using the format @samp{%a, %d %b %Y %H:%M:%S
13197 %z}, evaluated in the C locale so abbreviations are always in English.
13201 Fri, 09 Sep 2005 13:51:39 -0700
13204 This format conforms to
13205 @uref{ftp://ftp.rfc-editor.org/in-notes/rfc2822.txt, Internet
13206 @acronym{RFCs} 2822} and
13207 @uref{ftp://ftp.rfc-editor.org/in-notes/rfc822.txt, 822}, the
13208 current and previous standards for Internet email.
13210 @item --rfc-3339=@var{timespec}
13211 @opindex --rfc-3339=@var{timespec}
13212 Display the date using a format specified by
13213 @uref{ftp://ftp.rfc-editor.org/in-notes/rfc3339.txt, Internet
13214 @acronym{RFC} 3339}. This is a subset of the @acronym{ISO} 8601
13215 format, except that it also permits applications to use a space rather
13216 than a @samp{T} to separate dates from times. Unlike the other
13217 standard formats, @acronym{RFC} 3339 format is always suitable as
13218 input for the @option{--date} (@option{-d}) and @option{--file}
13219 (@option{-f}) options, regardless of the current locale.
13221 The argument @var{timespec} specifies how much of the time to include.
13222 It can be one of the following:
13226 Print just the full-date, e.g., @samp{2005-09-14}.
13227 This is equivalent to the format @samp{%Y-%m-%d}.
13230 Print the full-date and full-time separated by a space, e.g.,
13231 @samp{2005-09-14 00:56:06+05:30}. The output ends with a numeric
13232 time-offset; here the @samp{+05:30} means that local time is five
13233 hours and thirty minutes east of @acronym{UTC}. This is equivalent to
13234 the format @samp{%Y-%m-%d %H:%M:%S%:z}.
13237 Like @samp{seconds}, but also print nanoseconds, e.g.,
13238 @samp{2005-09-14 00:56:06.998458565+05:30}.
13239 This is equivalent to the format @samp{%Y-%m-%d %H:%M:%S.%N%:z}.
13243 @item -s @var{datestr}
13244 @itemx --set=@var{datestr}
13247 Set the date and time to @var{datestr}. See @option{-d} above.
13254 @opindex --universal
13255 @cindex Coordinated Universal Time
13257 @cindex Greenwich Mean Time
13260 Use Coordinated Universal Time (@acronym{UTC}) by operating as if the
13261 @env{TZ} environment variable were set to the string @samp{UTC0}.
13263 Universal Time is often called ``Greenwich Mean Time'' (@sc{gmt}) for
13264 historical reasons.
13268 @node Examples of date
13269 @subsection Examples of @command{date}
13271 @cindex examples of @command{date}
13273 Here are a few examples. Also see the documentation for the @option{-d}
13274 option in the previous section.
13279 To print the date of the day before yesterday:
13282 date --date='2 days ago'
13286 To print the date of the day three months and one day hence:
13289 date --date='3 months 1 day'
13293 To print the day of year of Christmas in the current year:
13296 date --date='25 Dec' +%j
13300 To print the current full month name and the day of the month:
13306 But this may not be what you want because for the first nine days of
13307 the month, the @samp{%d} expands to a zero-padded two-digit field,
13308 for example @samp{date -d 1may '+%B %d'} will print @samp{May 01}.
13311 To print a date without the leading zero for one-digit days
13312 of the month, you can use the (@acronym{GNU} extension)
13313 @samp{-} flag to suppress
13314 the padding altogether:
13317 date -d 1may '+%B %-d
13321 To print the current date and time in the format required by many
13322 non-@acronym{GNU} versions of @command{date} when setting the system clock:
13325 date +%m%d%H%M%Y.%S
13329 To set the system clock forward by two minutes:
13332 date --set='+2 minutes'
13336 To print the date in @acronym{RFC} 2822 format,
13337 use @samp{date --rfc-2822}. Here is some example output:
13340 Fri, 09 Sep 2005 13:51:39 -0700
13343 @anchor{%s-examples}
13345 To convert a date string to the number of seconds since the epoch
13346 (which is 1970-01-01 00:00:00 UTC), use the @option{--date} option with
13347 the @samp{%s} format. That can be useful in sorting and/or graphing
13348 and/or comparing data by date. The following command outputs the
13349 number of the seconds since the epoch for the time two minutes after the
13353 date --date='1970-01-01 00:02:00 +0000' +%s
13357 If you do not specify time zone information in the date string,
13358 @command{date} uses your computer's idea of the time zone when
13359 interpreting the string. For example, if your computer's time zone is
13360 that of Cambridge, Massachusetts, which was then 5 hours (i.e., 18,000
13361 seconds) behind UTC:
13364 # local time zone used
13365 date --date='1970-01-01 00:02:00' +%s
13370 If you're sorting or graphing dated data, your raw date values may be
13371 represented as seconds since the epoch. But few people can look at
13372 the date @samp{946684800} and casually note ``Oh, that's the first second
13373 of the year 2000 in Greenwich, England.''
13376 date --date='2000-01-01 UTC' +%s
13380 An alternative is to use the @option{--utc} (@option{-u}) option.
13381 Then you may omit @samp{UTC} from the date string. Although this
13382 produces the same result for @samp{%s} and many other format sequences,
13383 with a time zone offset different from zero, it would give a different
13384 result for zone-dependent formats like @samp{%z}.
13387 date -u --date=2000-01-01 +%s
13391 To convert such an unwieldy number of seconds back to
13392 a more readable form, use a command like this:
13395 # local time zone used
13396 date -d '1970-01-01 UTC 946684800 seconds' +"%Y-%m-%d %T %z"
13397 1999-12-31 19:00:00 -0500
13400 Or if you do not mind depending on the @samp{@@} feature present since
13401 coreutils 5.3.0, you could shorten this to:
13404 date -d @@946684800 +"%F %T %z"
13405 1999-12-31 19:00:00 -0500
13408 Often it is better to output UTC-relative date and time:
13411 date -u -d '1970-01-01 946684800 seconds' +"%Y-%m-%d %T %z"
13412 2000-01-01 00:00:00 +0000
13418 @node arch invocation
13419 @section @command{arch}: Print machine hardware name
13422 @cindex print machine hardware name
13423 @cindex system information, printing
13425 @command{arch} prints the machine hardware name,
13426 and is equivalent to @samp{uname -m}.
13430 arch [@var{option}]
13433 The program accepts the @ref{Common options} only.
13438 @node uname invocation
13439 @section @command{uname}: Print system information
13442 @cindex print system information
13443 @cindex system information, printing
13445 @command{uname} prints information about the machine and operating system
13446 it is run on. If no options are given, @command{uname} acts as if the
13447 @option{-s} option were given. Synopsis:
13450 uname [@var{option}]@dots{}
13453 If multiple options or @option{-a} are given, the selected information is
13454 printed in this order:
13457 @var{kernel-name} @var{nodename} @var{kernel-release} @var{kernel-version}
13458 @var{machine} @var{processor} @var{hardware-platform} @var{operating-system}
13461 The information may contain internal spaces, so such output cannot be
13462 parsed reliably. In the following example, @var{release} is
13463 @samp{2.2.18ss.e820-bda652a #4 SMP Tue Jun 5 11:24:08 PDT 2001}:
13467 @result{} Linux dum 2.2.18 #4 SMP Tue Jun 5 11:24:08 PDT 2001 i686 unknown unknown GNU/Linux
13471 The program accepts the following options. Also see @ref{Common options}.
13479 Print all of the below information, except omit the processor type
13480 and the hardware platform name if they are unknown.
13483 @itemx --hardware-platform
13485 @opindex --hardware-platform
13486 @cindex implementation, hardware
13487 @cindex hardware platform
13488 @cindex platform, hardware
13489 Print the hardware platform name
13490 (sometimes called the hardware implementation).
13491 Print @samp{unknown} if the kernel does not make this information
13492 easily available, as is the case with Linux kernels.
13498 @cindex machine type
13499 @cindex hardware class
13500 @cindex hardware type
13501 Print the machine hardware name (sometimes called the hardware class
13507 @opindex --nodename
13510 @cindex network node name
13511 Print the network node hostname.
13516 @opindex --processor
13517 @cindex host processor type
13518 Print the processor type (sometimes called the instruction set
13519 architecture or ISA).
13520 Print @samp{unknown} if the kernel does not make this information
13521 easily available, as is the case with Linux kernels.
13524 @itemx --operating-system
13526 @opindex --operating-system
13527 @cindex operating system name
13528 Print the name of the operating system.
13531 @itemx --kernel-release
13533 @opindex --kernel-release
13534 @cindex kernel release
13535 @cindex release of kernel
13536 Print the kernel release.
13539 @itemx --kernel-name
13541 @opindex --kernel-name
13542 @cindex kernel name
13543 @cindex name of kernel
13544 Print the kernel name.
13545 @acronym{POSIX} 1003.1-2001 (@pxref{Standards conformance}) calls this
13546 ``the implementation of the operating system'', because the
13547 @acronym{POSIX} specification itself has no notion of ``kernel''.
13548 The kernel name might be the same as the operating system name printed
13549 by the @option{-o} or @option{--operating-system} option, but it might
13550 differ. Some operating systems (e.g., FreeBSD, HP-UX) have the same
13551 name as their underlying kernels; others (e.g., GNU/Linux, Solaris)
13555 @itemx --kernel-version
13557 @opindex --kernel-version
13558 @cindex kernel version
13559 @cindex version of kernel
13560 Print the kernel version.
13567 @node hostname invocation
13568 @section @command{hostname}: Print or set system name
13571 @cindex setting the hostname
13572 @cindex printing the hostname
13573 @cindex system name, printing
13574 @cindex appropriate privileges
13576 With no arguments, @command{hostname} prints the name of the current host
13577 system. With one argument, it sets the current host name to the
13578 specified string. You must have appropriate privileges to set the host
13582 hostname [@var{name}]
13585 The only options are @option{--help} and @option{--version}. @xref{Common
13591 @node hostid invocation
13592 @section @command{hostid}: Print numeric host identifier.
13595 @cindex printing the host identifier
13597 @command{hostid} prints the numeric identifier of the current host
13598 in hexadecimal. This command accepts no arguments.
13599 The only options are @option{--help} and @option{--version}.
13600 @xref{Common options}.
13602 For example, here's what it prints on one system I use:
13609 On that system, the 32-bit quantity happens to be closely
13610 related to the system's Internet address, but that isn't always
13616 @node Modified command invocation
13617 @chapter Modified command invocation
13619 @cindex modified command invocation
13620 @cindex invocation of commands, modified
13621 @cindex commands for invoking other commands
13623 This section describes commands that run other commands in some context
13624 different than the current one: a modified environment, as a different
13628 * chroot invocation:: Modify the root directory.
13629 * env invocation:: Modify environment variables.
13630 * nice invocation:: Modify niceness.
13631 * nohup invocation:: Immunize to hangups.
13632 * su invocation:: Modify user and group ID.
13633 * timeout invocation:: Run with time limit.
13637 @node chroot invocation
13638 @section @command{chroot}: Run a command with a different root directory
13641 @cindex running a program in a specified root directory
13642 @cindex root directory, running a program in a specified
13644 @command{chroot} runs a command with a specified root directory.
13645 On many systems, only the super-user can do this.@footnote{However,
13646 some systems (e.g., FreeBSD) can be configured to allow certain regular
13647 users to use the @code{chroot} system call, and hence to run this program.
13648 Also, on Cygwin, anyone can run the @command{chroot} command, because the
13649 underlying function is non-privileged due to lack of support in MS-Windows.}
13653 chroot @var{newroot} [@var{command} [@var{args}]@dots{}]
13654 chroot @var{option}
13657 Ordinarily, file names are looked up starting at the root of the
13658 directory structure, i.e., @file{/}. @command{chroot} changes the root to
13659 the directory @var{newroot} (which must exist) and then runs
13660 @var{command} with optional @var{args}. If @var{command} is not
13661 specified, the default is the value of the @env{SHELL} environment
13662 variable or @command{/bin/sh} if not set, invoked with the @option{-i} option.
13663 @var{command} must not be a special built-in utility
13664 (@pxref{Special built-in utilities}).
13666 The only options are @option{--help} and @option{--version}. @xref{Common
13667 options}. Options must precede operands.
13669 Here are a few tips to help avoid common problems in using chroot.
13670 To start with a simple example, make @var{command} refer to a statically
13671 linked binary. If you were to use a dynamically linked executable, then
13672 you'd have to arrange to have the shared libraries in the right place under
13673 your new root directory.
13675 For example, if you create a statically linked @command{ls} executable,
13676 and put it in @file{/tmp/empty}, you can run this command as root:
13679 $ chroot /tmp/empty /ls -Rl /
13682 Then you'll see output like this:
13687 -rwxr-xr-x 1 0 0 1041745 Aug 16 11:17 ls
13690 If you want to use a dynamically linked executable, say @command{bash},
13691 then first run @samp{ldd bash} to see what shared objects it needs.
13692 Then, in addition to copying the actual binary, also copy the listed
13693 files to the required positions under your intended new root directory.
13694 Finally, if the executable requires any other files (e.g., data, state,
13695 device files), copy them into place, too.
13697 @cindex exit status of @command{chroot}
13701 1 if @command{chroot} itself fails
13702 126 if @var{command} is found but cannot be invoked
13703 127 if @var{command} cannot be found
13704 the exit status of @var{command} otherwise
13708 @node env invocation
13709 @section @command{env}: Run a command in a modified environment
13712 @cindex environment, running a program in a modified
13713 @cindex modified environment, running a program in a
13714 @cindex running a program in a modified environment
13716 @command{env} runs a command with a modified environment. Synopses:
13719 env [@var{option}]@dots{} [@var{name}=@var{value}]@dots{} @c
13720 [@var{command} [@var{args}]@dots{}]
13724 Operands of the form @samp{@var{variable}=@var{value}} set
13725 the environment variable @var{variable} to value @var{value}.
13726 @var{value} may be empty (@samp{@var{variable}=}). Setting a variable
13727 to an empty value is different from unsetting it.
13728 These operands are evaluated left-to-right, so if two operands
13729 mention the same variable the earlier is ignored.
13731 Environment variable names can be empty, and can contain any
13732 characters other than @samp{=} and the null character (@acronym{ASCII}
13733 @sc{nul}). However, it is wise to limit yourself to names that
13734 consist solely of underscores, digits, and @acronym{ASCII} letters,
13735 and that begin with a non-digit, as applications like the shell do not
13736 work well with other names.
13739 The first operand that does not contain the character @samp{=}
13740 specifies the program to invoke; it is
13741 searched for according to the @env{PATH} environment variable. Any
13742 remaining arguments are passed as arguments to that program.
13743 The program should not be a special built-in utility
13744 (@pxref{Special built-in utilities}).
13746 @cindex environment, printing
13748 If no command name is specified following the environment
13749 specifications, the resulting environment is printed. This is like
13750 specifying the @command{printenv} program.
13752 The program accepts the following options. Also see @ref{Common options}.
13753 Options must precede operands.
13757 @item -u @var{name}
13758 @itemx --unset=@var{name}
13761 Remove variable @var{name} from the environment, if it was in the
13766 @itemx --ignore-environment
13769 @opindex --ignore-environment
13770 Start with an empty environment, ignoring the inherited environment.
13774 @cindex exit status of @command{env}
13778 0 if no @var{command} is specified and the environment is output
13779 1 if @command{env} itself fails
13780 126 if @var{command} is found but cannot be invoked
13781 127 if @var{command} cannot be found
13782 the exit status of @var{command} otherwise
13786 @node nice invocation
13787 @section @command{nice}: Run a command with modified niceness
13791 @cindex scheduling, affecting
13792 @cindex appropriate privileges
13794 @command{nice} prints or modifies a process's @dfn{niceness},
13795 a parameter that affects whether the process is scheduled favorably.
13799 nice [@var{option}]@dots{} [@var{command} [@var{arg}]@dots{}]
13802 If no arguments are given, @command{nice} prints the current niceness.
13803 Otherwise, @command{nice} runs the given @var{command} with its
13804 niceness adjusted. By default, its niceness is incremented by 10.
13806 Niceness values range at least from @minus{}20 (process has high priority
13807 and gets more resources, thus slowing down other processes) through 19
13808 (process has lower priority and runs slowly itself, but has less impact
13809 on the speed of other running processes). Some systems
13810 may have a wider range of nicenesses; conversely, other systems may
13811 enforce more restrictive limits. An attempt to set the niceness
13812 outside the supported range is treated as an attempt to use the
13813 minimum or maximum supported value.
13815 A niceness should not be confused with a scheduling priority, which
13816 lets applications determine the order in which threads are scheduled
13817 to run. Unlike a priority, a niceness is merely advice to the
13818 scheduler, which the scheduler is free to ignore. Also, as a point of
13819 terminology, @acronym{POSIX} defines the behavior of @command{nice} in
13820 terms of a @dfn{nice value}, which is the nonnegative difference
13821 between a niceness and the minimum niceness. Though @command{nice}
13822 conforms to @acronym{POSIX}, its documentation and diagnostics use the
13823 term ``niceness'' for compatibility with historical practice.
13825 @var{command} must not be a special built-in utility (@pxref{Special
13826 built-in utilities}).
13828 @cindex conflicts with shell built-ins
13829 @cindex built-in shell commands, conflicts with
13830 Because many shells have a built-in @command{nice} command, using an
13831 unadorned @command{nice} in a script or interactively may get you
13832 different functionality than that described here.
13834 The program accepts the following option. Also see @ref{Common options}.
13835 Options must precede operands.
13838 @item -n @var{adjustment}
13839 @itemx --adjustment=@var{adjustment}
13841 @opindex --adjustment
13842 Add @var{adjustment} instead of 10 to the command's niceness. If
13843 @var{adjustment} is negative and you lack appropriate privileges,
13844 @command{nice} issues a warning but otherwise acts as if you specified
13847 For compatibility @command{nice} also supports an obsolete
13848 option syntax @option{-@var{adjustment}}. New scripts should use
13849 @option{-n @var{adjustment}} instead.
13853 @cindex exit status of @command{nice}
13857 0 if no @var{command} is specified and the niceness is output
13858 1 if @command{nice} itself fails
13859 126 if @var{command} is found but cannot be invoked
13860 127 if @var{command} cannot be found
13861 the exit status of @var{command} otherwise
13864 It is sometimes useful to run a non-interactive program with reduced niceness.
13867 $ nice factor 4611686018427387903
13870 Since @command{nice} prints the current niceness,
13871 you can invoke it through itself to demonstrate how it works.
13873 The default behavior is to increase the niceness by @samp{10}:
13884 The @var{adjustment} is relative to the current niceness. In the
13885 next example, the first @command{nice} invocation runs the second one
13886 with niceness 10, and it in turn runs the final one with a niceness
13890 $ nice nice -n 3 nice
13894 Specifying a niceness larger than the supported range
13895 is the same as specifying the maximum supported value:
13898 $ nice -n 10000000000 nice
13902 Only a privileged user may run a process with lower niceness:
13906 nice: cannot set niceness: Permission denied
13908 $ sudo nice -n -1 nice
13913 @node nohup invocation
13914 @section @command{nohup}: Run a command immune to hangups
13917 @cindex hangups, immunity to
13918 @cindex immunity to hangups
13919 @cindex logging out and continuing to run
13922 @command{nohup} runs the given @var{command} with hangup signals ignored,
13923 so that the command can continue running in the background after you log
13927 nohup @var{command} [@var{arg}]@dots{}
13930 If standard input is a terminal, it is redirected from
13931 @file{/dev/null} so that terminal sessions do not mistakenly consider
13932 the terminal to be used by the command. This is a @acronym{GNU}
13933 extension; programs intended to be portable to non-@acronym{GNU} hosts
13934 should use @samp{nohup @var{command} [@var{arg}]@dots{} </dev/null}
13938 If standard output is a terminal, the command's standard output is appended
13939 to the file @file{nohup.out}; if that cannot be written to, it is appended
13940 to the file @file{$HOME/nohup.out}; and if that cannot be written to, the
13941 command is not run.
13942 Any @file{nohup.out} or @file{$HOME/nohup.out} file created by
13943 @command{nohup} is made readable and writable only to the user,
13944 regardless of the current umask settings.
13946 If standard error is a terminal, it is normally redirected to the same file
13947 descriptor as the (possibly-redirected) standard output.
13948 However, if standard output is closed, standard error terminal output
13949 is instead appended to the file @file{nohup.out} or
13950 @file{$HOME/nohup.out} as above.
13952 To capture the command's output to a file other than @file{nohup.out}
13953 you can redirect it. For example, to capture the output of
13957 nohup make > make.log
13960 @command{nohup} does not automatically put the command it runs in the
13961 background; you must do that explicitly, by ending the command line
13962 with an @samp{&}. Also, @command{nohup} does not alter the
13963 niceness of @var{command}; use @command{nice} for that,
13964 e.g., @samp{nohup nice @var{command}}.
13966 @var{command} must not be a special built-in utility (@pxref{Special
13967 built-in utilities}).
13969 The only options are @option{--help} and @option{--version}. @xref{Common
13970 options}. Options must precede operands.
13972 @cindex exit status of @command{nohup}
13976 126 if @var{command} is found but cannot be invoked
13977 127 if @command{nohup} itself fails or if @var{command} cannot be found
13978 the exit status of @var{command} otherwise
13982 @node su invocation
13983 @section @command{su}: Run a command with substitute user and group ID
13986 @cindex substitute user and group IDs
13987 @cindex user ID, switching
13988 @cindex super-user, becoming
13989 @cindex root, becoming
13991 @command{su} allows one user to temporarily become another user. It runs a
13992 command (often an interactive shell) with the real and effective user
13993 ID, group ID, and supplemental groups of a given @var{user}. Synopsis:
13996 su [@var{option}]@dots{} [@var{user} [@var{arg}]@dots{}]
13999 @cindex passwd entry, and @command{su} shell
14001 @flindex /etc/passwd
14002 If no @var{user} is given, the default is @code{root}, the super-user.
14003 The shell to use is taken from @var{user}'s @code{passwd} entry, or
14004 @file{/bin/sh} if none is specified there. If @var{user} has a
14005 password, @command{su} prompts for the password unless run by a user with
14006 effective user ID of zero (the super-user).
14012 @cindex login shell
14013 By default, @command{su} does not change the current directory.
14014 It sets the environment variables @env{HOME} and @env{SHELL}
14015 from the password entry for @var{user}, and if @var{user} is not
14016 the super-user, sets @env{USER} and @env{LOGNAME} to @var{user}.
14017 By default, the shell is not a login shell.
14019 Any additional @var{arg}s are passed as additional arguments to the
14022 @cindex @option{-su}
14023 GNU @command{su} does not treat @file{/bin/sh} or any other shells specially
14024 (e.g., by setting @code{argv[0]} to @option{-su}, passing @option{-c} only
14025 to certain shells, etc.).
14028 @command{su} can optionally be compiled to use @code{syslog} to report
14029 failed, and optionally successful, @command{su} attempts. (If the system
14030 supports @code{syslog}.) However, GNU @command{su} does not check if the
14031 user is a member of the @code{wheel} group; see below.
14033 The program accepts the following options. Also see @ref{Common options}.
14036 @item -c @var{command}
14037 @itemx --command=@var{command}
14040 Pass @var{command}, a single command line to run, to the shell with
14041 a @option{-c} option instead of starting an interactive shell.
14048 @cindex file name pattern expansion, disabled
14049 @cindex globbing, disabled
14050 Pass the @option{-f} option to the shell. This probably only makes sense
14051 if the shell run is @command{csh} or @command{tcsh}, for which the @option{-f}
14052 option prevents reading the startup file (@file{.cshrc}). With
14053 Bourne-like shells, the @option{-f} option disables file name pattern
14054 expansion (globbing), which is not likely to be useful.
14062 @c other variables already indexed above
14065 @cindex login shell, creating
14066 Make the shell a login shell. This means the following. Unset all
14067 environment variables except @env{TERM}, @env{HOME}, and @env{SHELL}
14068 (which are set as described above), and @env{USER} and @env{LOGNAME}
14069 (which are set, even for the super-user, as described above), and set
14070 @env{PATH} to a compiled-in default value. Change to @var{user}'s home
14071 directory. Prepend @samp{-} to the shell's name, intended to make it
14072 read its login startup file(s).
14076 @itemx --preserve-environment
14079 @opindex --preserve-environment
14080 @cindex environment, preserving
14081 @flindex /etc/shells
14082 @cindex restricted shell
14083 Do not change the environment variables @env{HOME}, @env{USER},
14084 @env{LOGNAME}, or @env{SHELL}. Run the shell given in the environment
14085 variable @env{SHELL} instead of the shell from @var{user}'s passwd
14086 entry, unless the user running @command{su} is not the super-user and
14087 @var{user}'s shell is restricted. A @dfn{restricted shell} is one that
14088 is not listed in the file @file{/etc/shells}, or in a compiled-in list
14089 if that file does not exist. Parts of what this option does can be
14090 overridden by @option{--login} and @option{--shell}.
14092 @item -s @var{shell}
14093 @itemx --shell=@var{shell}
14096 Run @var{shell} instead of the shell from @var{user}'s passwd entry,
14097 unless the user running @command{su} is not the super-user and @var{user}'s
14098 shell is restricted (see @option{-m} just above).
14102 @cindex exit status of @command{su}
14106 1 if @command{su} itself fails
14107 126 if subshell is found but cannot be invoked
14108 127 if subshell cannot be found
14109 the exit status of the subshell otherwise
14112 @cindex wheel group, not supported
14113 @cindex group wheel, not supported
14115 @subsection Why GNU @command{su} does not support the @samp{wheel} group
14117 (This section is by Richard Stallman.)
14121 Sometimes a few of the users try to hold total power over all the
14122 rest. For example, in 1984, a few users at the MIT AI lab decided to
14123 seize power by changing the operator password on the Twenex system and
14124 keeping it secret from everyone else. (I was able to thwart this coup
14125 and give power back to the users by patching the kernel, but I
14126 wouldn't know how to do that in Unix.)
14128 However, occasionally the rulers do tell someone. Under the usual
14129 @command{su} mechanism, once someone learns the root password who
14130 sympathizes with the ordinary users, he or she can tell the rest. The
14131 ``wheel group'' feature would make this impossible, and thus cement the
14132 power of the rulers.
14134 I'm on the side of the masses, not that of the rulers. If you are
14135 used to supporting the bosses and sysadmins in whatever they do, you
14136 might find this idea strange at first.
14139 @node timeout invocation
14140 @section @command{timeout}: Run a command with a time limit
14144 @cindex run commands with bounded time
14146 @command{timeout} runs the given @var{command} and kills it if it is
14147 still running after the specified time interval. Synopsis:
14150 timeout [@var{option}] @var{number}[smhd] @var{command} [@var{arg}]@dots{}
14154 @var{number} is an integer followed by an optional unit; the default
14155 is seconds. The units are:
14168 @var{command} must not be a special built-in utility (@pxref{Special
14169 built-in utilities}).
14171 The program accepts the following option. Also see @ref{Common options}.
14172 Options must precede operands.
14175 @item -s @var{signal}
14176 @itemx --signal=@var{signal}
14179 Send this @var{signal} to @var{command} on timeout, rather than the
14180 default @samp{TERM} signal. @var{signal} may be a name like @samp{HUP}
14181 or a number. Also see @xref{Signal specifications}.
14185 @cindex exit status of @command{timeout}
14189 124 if @var{command} times out
14190 125 if @command{timeout} itself fails
14191 126 if @var{command} is found but cannot be invoked
14192 127 if @var{command} cannot be found
14193 the exit status of @var{command} otherwise
14197 @node Process control
14198 @chapter Process control
14200 @cindex processes, commands for controlling
14201 @cindex commands for controlling processes
14204 * kill invocation:: Sending a signal to processes.
14208 @node kill invocation
14209 @section @command{kill}: Send a signal to processes
14212 @cindex send a signal to processes
14214 The @command{kill} command sends a signal to processes, causing them
14215 to terminate or otherwise act upon receiving the signal in some way.
14216 Alternatively, it lists information about signals. Synopses:
14219 kill [-s @var{signal} | --signal @var{signal} | -@var{signal}] @var{pid}@dots{}
14220 kill [-l | --list | -t | --table] [@var{signal}]@dots{}
14223 The first form of the @command{kill} command sends a signal to all
14224 @var{pid} arguments. The default signal to send if none is specified
14225 is @samp{TERM}. The special signal number @samp{0} does not denote a
14226 valid signal, but can be used to test whether the @var{pid} arguments
14227 specify processes to which a signal could be sent.
14229 If @var{pid} is positive, the signal is sent to the process with the
14230 process ID @var{pid}. If @var{pid} is zero, the signal is sent to all
14231 processes in the process group of the current process. If @var{pid}
14232 is @minus{}1, the signal is sent to all processes for which the user has
14233 permission to send a signal. If @var{pid} is less than @minus{}1, the signal
14234 is sent to all processes in the process group that equals the absolute
14235 value of @var{pid}.
14237 If @var{pid} is not positive, a system-dependent set of system
14238 processes is excluded from the list of processes to which the signal
14241 If a negative @var{PID} argument is desired as the first one, it
14242 should be preceded by @option{--}. However, as a common extension to
14243 @acronym{POSIX}, @option{--} is not required with @samp{kill
14244 -@var{signal} -@var{pid}}. The following commands are equivalent:
14253 The first form of the @command{kill} command succeeds if every @var{pid}
14254 argument specifies at least one process that the signal was sent to.
14256 The second form of the @command{kill} command lists signal information.
14257 Either the @option{-l} or @option{--list} option, or the @option{-t}
14258 or @option{--table} option must be specified. Without any
14259 @var{signal} argument, all supported signals are listed. The output
14260 of @option{-l} or @option{--list} is a list of the signal names, one
14261 per line; if @var{signal} is already a name, the signal number is
14262 printed instead. The output of @option{-t} or @option{--table} is a
14263 table of signal numbers, names, and descriptions. This form of the
14264 @command{kill} command succeeds if all @var{signal} arguments are valid
14265 and if there is no output error.
14267 The @command{kill} command also supports the @option{--help} and
14268 @option{--version} options. @xref{Common options}.
14270 A @var{signal} may be a signal name like @samp{HUP}, or a signal
14271 number like @samp{1}, or an exit status of a process terminated by the
14272 signal. A signal name can be given in canonical form or prefixed by
14273 @samp{SIG}. The case of the letters is ignored, except for the
14274 @option{-@var{signal}} option which must use upper case to avoid
14275 ambiguity with lower case option letters. For a list of supported
14276 signal names and numbers see @xref{Signal specifications}.
14281 @cindex delaying commands
14282 @cindex commands for delaying
14284 @c Perhaps @command{wait} or other commands should be described here also?
14287 * sleep invocation:: Delay for a specified time.
14291 @node sleep invocation
14292 @section @command{sleep}: Delay for a specified time
14295 @cindex delay for a specified time
14297 @command{sleep} pauses for an amount of time specified by the sum of
14298 the values of the command line arguments.
14302 sleep @var{number}[smhd]@dots{}
14306 Each argument is a number followed by an optional unit; the default
14307 is seconds. The units are:
14320 Historical implementations of @command{sleep} have required that
14321 @var{number} be an integer, and only accepted a single argument
14322 without a suffix. However, GNU @command{sleep} accepts
14323 arbitrary floating point numbers (using a period before any fractional
14326 The only options are @option{--help} and @option{--version}. @xref{Common
14332 @node Numeric operations
14333 @chapter Numeric operations
14335 @cindex numeric operations
14336 These programs do numerically-related operations.
14339 * factor invocation:: Show factors of numbers.
14340 * seq invocation:: Print sequences of numbers.
14344 @node factor invocation
14345 @section @command{factor}: Print prime factors
14348 @cindex prime factors
14350 @command{factor} prints prime factors. Synopses:
14353 factor [@var{number}]@dots{}
14354 factor @var{option}
14357 If no @var{number} is specified on the command line, @command{factor} reads
14358 numbers from standard input, delimited by newlines, tabs, or spaces.
14360 The only options are @option{--help} and @option{--version}. @xref{Common
14363 The algorithm it uses is not very sophisticated, so for some inputs
14364 @command{factor} runs for a long time. The hardest numbers to factor are
14365 the products of large primes. Factoring the product of the two largest 32-bit
14366 prime numbers takes about 80 seconds of CPU time on a 1.6 GHz Athlon.
14369 $ p=`echo '4294967279 * 4294967291'|bc`
14371 18446743979220271189: 4294967279 4294967291
14374 Similarly, it takes about 80 seconds for GNU factor (from coreutils-5.1.2)
14375 to ``factor'' the largest 64-bit prime:
14378 $ factor 18446744073709551557
14379 18446744073709551557: 18446744073709551557
14382 In contrast, @command{factor} factors the largest 64-bit number in just
14383 over a tenth of a second:
14386 $ factor `echo '2^64-1'|bc`
14387 18446744073709551615: 3 5 17 257 641 65537 6700417
14393 @node seq invocation
14394 @section @command{seq}: Print numeric sequences
14397 @cindex numeric sequences
14398 @cindex sequence of numbers
14400 @command{seq} prints a sequence of numbers to standard output. Synopses:
14403 seq [@var{option}]@dots{} @var{last}
14404 seq [@var{option}]@dots{} @var{first} @var{last}
14405 seq [@var{option}]@dots{} @var{first} @var{increment} @var{last}
14408 @command{seq} prints the numbers from @var{first} to @var{last} by
14409 @var{increment}. By default, each number is printed on a separate line.
14410 When @var{increment} is not specified, it defaults to @samp{1},
14411 even when @var{first} is larger than @var{last}.
14412 @var{first} also defaults to @samp{1}. So @code{seq 1} prints
14413 @samp{1}, but @code{seq 0} and @code{seq 10 5} produce no output.
14414 Floating-point numbers
14415 may be specified (using a period before any fractional digits).
14417 The program accepts the following options. Also see @ref{Common options}.
14418 Options must precede operands.
14421 @item -f @var{format}
14422 @itemx --format=@var{format}
14423 @opindex -f @var{format}
14424 @opindex --format=@var{format}
14425 @cindex formatting of numbers in @command{seq}
14426 Print all numbers using @var{format}.
14427 @var{format} must contain exactly one of the @samp{printf}-style
14428 floating point conversion specifications @samp{%a}, @samp{%e},
14429 @samp{%f}, @samp{%g}, @samp{%A}, @samp{%E}, @samp{%F}, @samp{%G}.
14430 The @samp{%} may be followed by zero or more flags taken from the set
14431 @samp{-+#0 '}, then an optional width containing one or more digits,
14432 then an optional precision consisting of a @samp{.} followed by zero
14433 or more digits. @var{format} may also contain any number of @samp{%%}
14434 conversion specifications. All conversion specifications have the
14435 same meaning as with @samp{printf}.
14437 The default format is derived from @var{first}, @var{step}, and
14438 @var{last}. If these all use a fixed point decimal representation,
14439 the default format is @samp{%.@var{p}f}, where @var{p} is the minimum
14440 precision that can represent the output numbers exactly. Otherwise,
14441 the default format is @samp{%g}.
14443 @item -s @var{string}
14444 @itemx --separator=@var{string}
14445 @cindex separator for numbers in @command{seq}
14446 Separate numbers with @var{string}; default is a newline.
14447 The output always terminates with a newline.
14450 @itemx --equal-width
14451 Print all numbers with the same width, by padding with leading zeros.
14452 @var{first}, @var{step}, and @var{last} should all use a fixed point
14453 decimal representation.
14454 (To have other kinds of padding, use @option{--format}).
14458 You can get finer-grained control over output with @option{-f}:
14461 $ seq -f '(%9.2E)' -9e5 1.1e6 1.3e6
14467 If you want hexadecimal integer output, you can use @command{printf}
14468 to perform the conversion:
14471 $ printf '%x\n' `seq 1048575 1024 1050623`
14477 For very long lists of numbers, use xargs to avoid
14478 system limitations on the length of an argument list:
14481 $ seq 1000000 | xargs printf '%x\n' | tail -n 3
14487 To generate octal output, use the printf @code{%o} format instead
14490 On most systems, seq can produce whole-number output for values up to
14491 at least @math{2^{53}}. Larger integers are approximated. The details
14492 differ depending on your floating-point implementation, but a common
14493 case is that @command{seq} works with integers through @math{2^{64}},
14494 and larger integers may not be numerically correct:
14497 $ seq 18446744073709551616 1 18446744073709551618
14498 18446744073709551616
14499 18446744073709551616
14500 18446744073709551618
14503 Be careful when using @command{seq} with outlandish values: otherwise
14504 you may see surprising results, as @command{seq} uses floating point
14505 internally. For example, on the x86 platform, where the internal
14506 representation uses a 64-bit fraction, the command:
14509 seq 1 0.0000000000000000001 1.0000000000000000009
14512 outputs 1.0000000000000000007 twice and skips 1.0000000000000000008.
14517 @node File permissions
14518 @chapter File permissions
14521 @include getdate.texi
14525 @node Opening the software toolbox
14526 @chapter Opening the Software Toolbox
14528 An earlier version of this chapter appeared in
14529 @uref{http://www.linuxjournal.com/article.php?sid=2762, the
14530 @cite{What's GNU?} column of @cite{Linux Journal}, 2 (June, 1994)}.
14531 It was written by Arnold Robbins.
14534 * Toolbox introduction:: Toolbox introduction
14535 * I/O redirection:: I/O redirection
14536 * The who command:: The @command{who} command
14537 * The cut command:: The @command{cut} command
14538 * The sort command:: The @command{sort} command
14539 * The uniq command:: The @command{uniq} command
14540 * Putting the tools together:: Putting the tools together
14544 @node Toolbox introduction
14545 @unnumberedsec Toolbox Introduction
14547 This month's column is only peripherally related to the GNU Project, in
14548 that it describes a number of the GNU tools on your GNU/Linux system and how they
14549 might be used. What it's really about is the ``Software Tools'' philosophy
14550 of program development and usage.
14552 The software tools philosophy was an important and integral concept
14553 in the initial design and development of Unix (of which Linux and GNU are
14554 essentially clones). Unfortunately, in the modern day press of
14555 Internetworking and flashy GUIs, it seems to have fallen by the
14556 wayside. This is a shame, since it provides a powerful mental model
14557 for solving many kinds of problems.
14559 Many people carry a Swiss Army knife around in their pants pockets (or
14560 purse). A Swiss Army knife is a handy tool to have: it has several knife
14561 blades, a screwdriver, tweezers, toothpick, nail file, corkscrew, and perhaps
14562 a number of other things on it. For the everyday, small miscellaneous jobs
14563 where you need a simple, general purpose tool, it's just the thing.
14565 On the other hand, an experienced carpenter doesn't build a house using
14566 a Swiss Army knife. Instead, he has a toolbox chock full of specialized
14567 tools---a saw, a hammer, a screwdriver, a plane, and so on. And he knows
14568 exactly when and where to use each tool; you won't catch him hammering nails
14569 with the handle of his screwdriver.
14571 The Unix developers at Bell Labs were all professional programmers and trained
14572 computer scientists. They had found that while a one-size-fits-all program
14573 might appeal to a user because there's only one program to use, in practice
14578 difficult to write,
14581 difficult to maintain and
14585 difficult to extend to meet new situations.
14588 Instead, they felt that programs should be specialized tools. In short, each
14589 program ``should do one thing well.'' No more and no less. Such programs are
14590 simpler to design, write, and get right---they only do one thing.
14592 Furthermore, they found that with the right machinery for hooking programs
14593 together, that the whole was greater than the sum of the parts. By combining
14594 several special purpose programs, you could accomplish a specific task
14595 that none of the programs was designed for, and accomplish it much more
14596 quickly and easily than if you had to write a special purpose program.
14597 We will see some (classic) examples of this further on in the column.
14598 (An important additional point was that, if necessary, take a detour
14599 and build any software tools you may need first, if you don't already
14600 have something appropriate in the toolbox.)
14602 @node I/O redirection
14603 @unnumberedsec I/O Redirection
14605 Hopefully, you are familiar with the basics of I/O redirection in the
14606 shell, in particular the concepts of ``standard input,'' ``standard output,''
14607 and ``standard error''. Briefly, ``standard input'' is a data source, where
14608 data comes from. A program should not need to either know or care if the
14609 data source is a disk file, a keyboard, a magnetic tape, or even a punched
14610 card reader. Similarly, ``standard output'' is a data sink, where data goes
14611 to. The program should neither know nor care where this might be.
14612 Programs that only read their standard input, do something to the data,
14613 and then send it on, are called @dfn{filters}, by analogy to filters in a
14616 With the Unix shell, it's very easy to set up data pipelines:
14619 program_to_create_data | filter1 | ... | filterN > final.pretty.data
14622 We start out by creating the raw data; each filter applies some successive
14623 transformation to the data, until by the time it comes out of the pipeline,
14624 it is in the desired form.
14626 This is fine and good for standard input and standard output. Where does the
14627 standard error come in to play? Well, think about @command{filter1} in
14628 the pipeline above. What happens if it encounters an error in the data it
14629 sees? If it writes an error message to standard output, it will just
14630 disappear down the pipeline into @command{filter2}'s input, and the
14631 user will probably never see it. So programs need a place where they can send
14632 error messages so that the user will notice them. This is standard error,
14633 and it is usually connected to your console or window, even if you have
14634 redirected standard output of your program away from your screen.
14636 For filter programs to work together, the format of the data has to be
14637 agreed upon. The most straightforward and easiest format to use is simply
14638 lines of text. Unix data files are generally just streams of bytes, with
14639 lines delimited by the @acronym{ASCII} @sc{lf} (Line Feed) character,
14640 conventionally called a ``newline'' in the Unix literature. (This is
14641 @code{'\n'} if you're a C programmer.) This is the format used by all
14642 the traditional filtering programs. (Many earlier operating systems
14643 had elaborate facilities and special purpose programs for managing
14644 binary data. Unix has always shied away from such things, under the
14645 philosophy that it's easiest to simply be able to view and edit your
14646 data with a text editor.)
14648 OK, enough introduction. Let's take a look at some of the tools, and then
14649 we'll see how to hook them together in interesting ways. In the following
14650 discussion, we will only present those command line options that interest
14651 us. As you should always do, double check your system documentation
14652 for the full story.
14654 @node The who command
14655 @unnumberedsec The @command{who} Command
14657 The first program is the @command{who} command. By itself, it generates a
14658 list of the users who are currently logged in. Although I'm writing
14659 this on a single-user system, we'll pretend that several people are
14664 @print{} arnold console Jan 22 19:57
14665 @print{} miriam ttyp0 Jan 23 14:19(:0.0)
14666 @print{} bill ttyp1 Jan 21 09:32(:0.0)
14667 @print{} arnold ttyp2 Jan 23 20:48(:0.0)
14670 Here, the @samp{$} is the usual shell prompt, at which I typed @samp{who}.
14671 There are three people logged in, and I am logged in twice. On traditional
14672 Unix systems, user names are never more than eight characters long. This
14673 little bit of trivia will be useful later. The output of @command{who} is nice,
14674 but the data is not all that exciting.
14676 @node The cut command
14677 @unnumberedsec The @command{cut} Command
14679 The next program we'll look at is the @command{cut} command. This program
14680 cuts out columns or fields of input data. For example, we can tell it
14681 to print just the login name and full name from the @file{/etc/passwd}
14682 file. The @file{/etc/passwd} file has seven fields, separated by
14686 arnold:xyzzy:2076:10:Arnold D. Robbins:/home/arnold:/bin/bash
14689 To get the first and fifth fields, we would use @command{cut} like this:
14692 $ cut -d: -f1,5 /etc/passwd
14693 @print{} root:Operator
14695 @print{} arnold:Arnold D. Robbins
14696 @print{} miriam:Miriam A. Robbins
14700 With the @option{-c} option, @command{cut} will cut out specific characters
14701 (i.e., columns) in the input lines. This is useful for input data
14702 that has fixed width fields, and does not have a field separator. For
14703 example, list the Monday dates for the current month:
14705 @c Is using cal ok? Looked at gcal, but I don't like it.
14716 @node The sort command
14717 @unnumberedsec The @command{sort} Command
14719 Next we'll look at the @command{sort} command. This is one of the most
14720 powerful commands on a Unix-style system; one that you will often find
14721 yourself using when setting up fancy data plumbing.
14724 command reads and sorts each file named on the command line. It then
14725 merges the sorted data and writes it to standard output. It will read
14726 standard input if no files are given on the command line (thus
14727 making it into a filter). The sort is based on the character collating
14728 sequence or based on user-supplied ordering criteria.
14731 @node The uniq command
14732 @unnumberedsec The @command{uniq} Command
14734 Finally (at least for now), we'll look at the @command{uniq} program. When
14735 sorting data, you will often end up with duplicate lines, lines that
14736 are identical. Usually, all you need is one instance of each line.
14737 This is where @command{uniq} comes in. The @command{uniq} program reads its
14738 standard input. It prints only one
14739 copy of each repeated line. It does have several options. Later on,
14740 we'll use the @option{-c} option, which prints each unique line, preceded
14741 by a count of the number of times that line occurred in the input.
14744 @node Putting the tools together
14745 @unnumberedsec Putting the Tools Together
14747 Now, let's suppose this is a large ISP server system with dozens of users
14748 logged in. The management wants the system administrator to write a program that will
14749 generate a sorted list of logged in users. Furthermore, even if a user
14750 is logged in multiple times, his or her name should only show up in the
14753 The administrator could sit down with the system documentation and write a C
14754 program that did this. It would take perhaps a couple of hundred lines
14755 of code and about two hours to write it, test it, and debug it.
14756 However, knowing the software toolbox, the administrator can instead start out
14757 by generating just a list of logged on users:
14767 Next, sort the list:
14770 $ who | cut -c1-8 | sort
14777 Finally, run the sorted list through @command{uniq}, to weed out duplicates:
14780 $ who | cut -c1-8 | sort | uniq
14786 The @command{sort} command actually has a @option{-u} option that does what
14787 @command{uniq} does. However, @command{uniq} has other uses for which one
14788 cannot substitute @samp{sort -u}.
14790 The administrator puts this pipeline into a shell script, and makes it available for
14791 all the users on the system (@samp{#} is the system administrator,
14792 or @code{root}, prompt):
14795 # cat > /usr/local/bin/listusers
14796 who | cut -c1-8 | sort | uniq
14798 # chmod +x /usr/local/bin/listusers
14801 There are four major points to note here. First, with just four
14802 programs, on one command line, the administrator was able to save about two
14803 hours worth of work. Furthermore, the shell pipeline is just about as
14804 efficient as the C program would be, and it is much more efficient in
14805 terms of programmer time. People time is much more expensive than
14806 computer time, and in our modern ``there's never enough time to do
14807 everything'' society, saving two hours of programmer time is no mean
14810 Second, it is also important to emphasize that with the
14811 @emph{combination} of the tools, it is possible to do a special
14812 purpose job never imagined by the authors of the individual programs.
14814 Third, it is also valuable to build up your pipeline in stages, as we did here.
14815 This allows you to view the data at each stage in the pipeline, which helps
14816 you acquire the confidence that you are indeed using these tools correctly.
14818 Finally, by bundling the pipeline in a shell script, other users can use
14819 your command, without having to remember the fancy plumbing you set up for
14820 them. In terms of how you run them, shell scripts and compiled programs are
14823 After the previous warm-up exercise, we'll look at two additional, more
14824 complicated pipelines. For them, we need to introduce two more tools.
14826 The first is the @command{tr} command, which stands for ``transliterate.''
14827 The @command{tr} command works on a character-by-character basis, changing
14828 characters. Normally it is used for things like mapping upper case to
14832 $ echo ThIs ExAmPlE HaS MIXED case! | tr '[:upper:]' '[:lower:]'
14833 @print{} this example has mixed case!
14836 There are several options of interest:
14840 work on the complement of the listed characters, i.e.,
14841 operations apply to characters not in the given set
14844 delete characters in the first set from the output
14847 squeeze repeated characters in the output into just one character.
14850 We will be using all three options in a moment.
14852 The other command we'll look at is @command{comm}. The @command{comm}
14853 command takes two sorted input files as input data, and prints out the
14854 files' lines in three columns. The output columns are the data lines
14855 unique to the first file, the data lines unique to the second file, and
14856 the data lines that are common to both. The @option{-1}, @option{-2}, and
14857 @option{-3} command line options @emph{omit} the respective columns. (This is
14858 non-intuitive and takes a little getting used to.) For example:
14880 The file name @file{-} tells @command{comm} to read standard input
14881 instead of a regular file.
14883 Now we're ready to build a fancy pipeline. The first application is a word
14884 frequency counter. This helps an author determine if he or she is over-using
14887 The first step is to change the case of all the letters in our input file
14888 to one case. ``The'' and ``the'' are the same word when doing counting.
14891 $ tr '[:upper:]' '[:lower:]' < whats.gnu | ...
14894 The next step is to get rid of punctuation. Quoted words and unquoted words
14895 should be treated identically; it's easiest to just get the punctuation out of
14899 $ tr '[:upper:]' '[:lower:]' < whats.gnu | tr -cd '[:alnum:]_ \n' | ...
14902 The second @command{tr} command operates on the complement of the listed
14903 characters, which are all the letters, the digits, the underscore, and
14904 the blank. The @samp{\n} represents the newline character; it has to
14905 be left alone. (The @acronym{ASCII} tab character should also be included for
14906 good measure in a production script.)
14908 At this point, we have data consisting of words separated by blank space.
14909 The words only contain alphanumeric characters (and the underscore). The
14910 next step is break the data apart so that we have one word per line. This
14911 makes the counting operation much easier, as we will see shortly.
14914 $ tr '[:upper:]' '[:lower:]' < whats.gnu | tr -cd '[:alnum:]_ \n' |
14915 > tr -s ' ' '\n' | ...
14918 This command turns blanks into newlines. The @option{-s} option squeezes
14919 multiple newline characters in the output into just one. This helps us
14920 avoid blank lines. (The @samp{>} is the shell's ``secondary prompt.''
14921 This is what the shell prints when it notices you haven't finished
14922 typing in all of a command.)
14924 We now have data consisting of one word per line, no punctuation, all one
14925 case. We're ready to count each word:
14928 $ tr '[:upper:]' '[:lower:]' < whats.gnu | tr -cd '[:alnum:]_ \n' |
14929 > tr -s ' ' '\n' | sort | uniq -c | ...
14932 At this point, the data might look something like this:
14945 The output is sorted by word, not by count! What we want is the most
14946 frequently used words first. Fortunately, this is easy to accomplish,
14947 with the help of two more @command{sort} options:
14951 do a numeric sort, not a textual one
14954 reverse the order of the sort
14957 The final pipeline looks like this:
14960 $ tr '[:upper:]' '[:lower:]' < whats.gnu | tr -cd '[:alnum:]_ \n' |
14961 > tr -s ' ' '\n' | sort | uniq -c | sort -n -r
14970 Whew! That's a lot to digest. Yet, the same principles apply. With six
14971 commands, on two lines (really one long one split for convenience), we've
14972 created a program that does something interesting and useful, in much
14973 less time than we could have written a C program to do the same thing.
14975 A minor modification to the above pipeline can give us a simple spelling
14976 checker! To determine if you've spelled a word correctly, all you have to
14977 do is look it up in a dictionary. If it is not there, then chances are
14978 that your spelling is incorrect. So, we need a dictionary.
14979 The conventional location for a dictionary is @file{/usr/dict/words}.
14980 On my GNU/Linux system,@footnote{Redhat Linux 6.1, for the November 2000
14981 revision of this article.}
14982 this is a is a sorted, 45,402 word dictionary.
14984 Now, how to compare our file with the dictionary? As before, we generate
14985 a sorted list of words, one per line:
14988 $ tr '[:upper:]' '[:lower:]' < whats.gnu | tr -cd '[:alnum:]_ \n' |
14989 > tr -s ' ' '\n' | sort -u | ...
14992 Now, all we need is a list of words that are @emph{not} in the
14993 dictionary. Here is where the @command{comm} command comes in.
14996 $ tr '[:upper:]' '[:lower:]' < whats.gnu | tr -cd '[:alnum:]_ \n' |
14997 > tr -s ' ' '\n' | sort -u |
14998 > comm -23 - /usr/dict/words
15001 The @option{-2} and @option{-3} options eliminate lines that are only in the
15002 dictionary (the second file), and lines that are in both files. Lines
15003 only in the first file (standard input, our stream of words), are
15004 words that are not in the dictionary. These are likely candidates for
15005 spelling errors. This pipeline was the first cut at a production
15006 spelling checker on Unix.
15008 There are some other tools that deserve brief mention.
15012 search files for text that matches a regular expression
15015 count lines, words, characters
15018 a T-fitting for data pipes, copies data to files and to standard output
15021 the stream editor, an advanced tool
15024 a data manipulation language, another advanced tool
15027 The software tools philosophy also espoused the following bit of
15028 advice: ``Let someone else do the hard part.'' This means, take
15029 something that gives you most of what you need, and then massage it the
15030 rest of the way until it's in the form that you want.
15036 Each program should do one thing well. No more, no less.
15039 Combining programs with appropriate plumbing leads to results where
15040 the whole is greater than the sum of the parts. It also leads to novel
15041 uses of programs that the authors might never have imagined.
15044 Programs should never print extraneous header or trailer data, since these
15045 could get sent on down a pipeline. (A point we didn't mention earlier.)
15048 Let someone else do the hard part.
15051 Know your toolbox! Use each program appropriately. If you don't have an
15052 appropriate tool, build one.
15055 As of this writing, all the programs we've discussed are available via
15056 anonymous @command{ftp} from: @*
15057 @uref{ftp://gnudist.gnu.org/textutils/textutils-1.22.tar.gz}. (There may
15058 be more recent versions available now.)
15060 None of what I have presented in this column is new. The Software Tools
15061 philosophy was first introduced in the book @cite{Software Tools}, by
15062 Brian Kernighan and P.J. Plauger (Addison-Wesley, ISBN 0-201-03669-X).
15063 This book showed how to write and use software tools. It was written in
15064 1976, using a preprocessor for FORTRAN named @command{ratfor} (RATional
15065 FORtran). At the time, C was not as ubiquitous as it is now; FORTRAN
15066 was. The last chapter presented a @command{ratfor} to FORTRAN
15067 processor, written in @command{ratfor}. @command{ratfor} looks an awful
15068 lot like C; if you know C, you won't have any problem following the
15071 In 1981, the book was updated and made available as @cite{Software Tools
15072 in Pascal} (Addison-Wesley, ISBN 0-201-10342-7). Both books are
15073 still in print and are well worth
15074 reading if you're a programmer. They certainly made a major change in
15075 how I view programming.
15077 The programs in both books are available from
15078 @uref{http://cm.bell-labs.com/who/bwk, Brian Kernighan's home page}.
15079 For a number of years, there was an active
15080 Software Tools Users Group, whose members had ported the original
15081 @command{ratfor} programs to essentially every computer system with a
15082 FORTRAN compiler. The popularity of the group waned in the middle 1980s
15083 as Unix began to spread beyond universities.
15085 With the current proliferation of GNU code and other clones of Unix programs,
15086 these programs now receive little attention; modern C versions are
15087 much more efficient and do more than these programs do. Nevertheless, as
15088 exposition of good programming style, and evangelism for a still-valuable
15089 philosophy, these books are unparalleled, and I recommend them highly.
15091 Acknowledgment: I would like to express my gratitude to Brian Kernighan
15092 of Bell Labs, the original Software Toolsmith, for reviewing this column.
15094 @node GNU Free Documentation License
15095 @appendix GNU Free Documentation License
15099 @node Concept index
15108 @c Local variables:
15109 @c texinfo-column-for-description: 32